PROXY: Move Proxy Protocol support from Experimental to mainline.
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.86"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 Exim used to
1990 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991 withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057 .code
2058 FULLECHO='' make -e
2059 .endd
2060 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062 given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073 order:
2074 .display
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077 &_Local/Makefile_&
2078 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082 .endd
2083 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089 and are often not needed.
2090
2091 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106 default values are.
2107
2108
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121 containing the lines
2122 .code
2123 CC=cc
2124 CFLAGS=-std1
2125 .endd
2126 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144 .code
2145 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148 .endd
2149 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157 errors.
2158
2159 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169 syntax. For instance:
2170 .code
2171 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177 .endd
2178
2179 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182 .code
2183 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184 .endd
2185 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/X11R6
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201 .code
2202 X11=/usr/openwin
2203 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205 .endd
2206 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207 definition of all three of these variables into your
2208 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221 libraries.
2222
2223 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242 .cindex "building Eximon"
2243 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244 where the files that are involved are
2245 .display
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252 .endd
2253 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260 .ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264 .cindex "installing Exim"
2265 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284 alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286 .cindex "system aliases file"
2287 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293 and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306 over SMTP.
2307
2308 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310 command such as
2311 .code
2312 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313 .endd
2314 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318 but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338 command:
2339 .code
2340 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341 .endd
2342 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349 .endd
2350 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353 .ilist
2354 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356 .next
2357 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358 installed binary.
2359 .endlist
2360
2361 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362 .code
2363 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364 .endd
2365 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368 .code
2369 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370 .endd
2371
2372
2373
2374 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392 necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2399 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402 .code
2403 exim -bV
2404 .endd
2405 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410 example,
2411 .display
2412 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413 .endd
2414 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415 .display
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417 .endd
2418 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420 user agent. For example:
2421 .code
2422 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423 From: user@your.domain.example
2424 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427 This is a test message.
2428 ^D
2429 .endd
2430 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440 .display
2441 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442 .endd
2443 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450 .cindex "lock files"
2451 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469 incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475 production version.
2476
2477
2478 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498 as follows:
2499 .code
2500 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504 .endd
2505 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507 favourite user agent.
2508
2509 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526 configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534 .code
2535 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536 .endd
2537 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542 .code
2543 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544 .endd
2545 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571 were present before any other options.
2572 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573 standard output.
2574 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582 format.
2583
2584 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2590 .cindex "queue runner"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612 .ilist
2613 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2621 .cindex "envelope sender"
2622 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626 users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639 that are available to trusted users.
2640 .next
2641 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659 false.
2660 .endlist
2661
2662
2663 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683 . creates a man page for the options.
2684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686 .literal xml
2687 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688 .literal off
2689
2690
2691 .vlist
2692 .vitem &%--%&
2693 .oindex "--"
2694 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699 .vitem &%--help%&
2700 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2701 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703 no arguments.
2704
2705 .vitem &%--version%&
2706 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2707 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708 displayed.
2709
2710 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715 ignored by Exim.
2716
2717 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2719 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722 clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724 .vitem &%-bd%&
2725 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726 .cindex "daemon"
2727 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728 .cindex "queue runner"
2729 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743 When a listening daemon
2744 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750 running as root.
2751
2752 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756 The SIGHUP signal
2757 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2758 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764 because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2767 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-be%&
2772 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784 test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062 This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3069 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090 .vitem &%-bP%&
3091 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097 arguments, for example:
3098 .code
3099 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100 .endd
3101 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106 users, the output is as in this example:
3107 .code
3108 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109 .endd
3110 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3111 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3112
3113 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3115 backward compatibility.)
3116 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3117 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3118
3119 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3120 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3121 name will not be output.
3122
3123 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3124 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3125 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3126 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3127 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3128 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3129 written directly into the spool directory.
3130
3131 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3132 .code
3133 exim -bP +local_domains
3134 .endd
3135 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3136 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3137
3138 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3141 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3142 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3143 that driver are output. For example:
3144 .code
3145 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3146 .endd
3147 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3148 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3149 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3150 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3151 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3152 &%authenticators%&.
3153
3154 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3155 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3156 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3157 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3158 The output format is one item per line.
3159
3160 .vitem &%-bp%&
3161 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3162 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3163 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3164 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3165 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3166 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3167 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3168 to allow any user to see the queue.
3169
3170 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3171 .code
3172 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3173 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3174 <other addresses>
3175 .endd
3176 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3177 .cindex "size" "of message"
3178 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3179 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3180 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3181 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3182 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3183 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3184 before the sender address.
3185
3186 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3187 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3188 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3189
3190 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3191 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3192 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3193 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3194 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3195 complete.
3196
3197
3198 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3199 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3200 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3201 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3202 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3203 of just &"D"&.
3204
3205
3206 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3207 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3208 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3209 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3210 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3211 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3212
3213
3214 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3215 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3216 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3217 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3218 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3219 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3220
3221 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3222 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3223 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3224
3225 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3226 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3227 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3228
3229
3230 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3231 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3232 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3233 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3234 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3235 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3236
3237
3238 .vitem &%-brt%&
3239 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3240 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3241 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3242 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3243 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3244 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3245 .code
3246 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3247 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3248 .endd
3249 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3250 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3251 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3252 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3253 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3254 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3255 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3256 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3257 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3258 .code
3259 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3260 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3261 .endd
3262
3263 .vitem &%-brw%&
3264 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3265 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3266 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3267 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3268 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3269 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3270 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3271 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3272
3273 .vitem &%-bS%&
3274 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3275 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3276 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3277 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3278 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3279 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3280 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3281 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3282 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3283 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3284
3285 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3286 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3287 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3288
3289 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3290 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3291 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3292 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3293
3294 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3295 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3296 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3297
3298 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3299 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3300 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3301 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3302 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3303
3304 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3305 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3306
3307 .vitem &%-bs%&
3308 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3309 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3310 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3311 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3312 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3313 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3314 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3315 messages to the MTA.
3316
3317 In
3318 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3319 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3320 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3321 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3322 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3323 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3324 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3325
3326 .cindex "inetd"
3327 The
3328 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3329 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3330 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3331 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3332 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3333 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3334 the listening daemon.
3335
3336 .vitem &%-bt%&
3337 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3338 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3339 .cindex "address" "testing"
3340 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3341 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3342 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3343 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3344 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3345
3346 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3347 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3348
3349 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3350 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3351 security issues.
3352
3353 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3354 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3355 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3356 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3357 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3358 program.
3359
3360 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3361 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3362 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3363 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3364
3365 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3366 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3367 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3368 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3369 always shown.
3370
3371 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3372 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3373 message,
3374 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3375 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3376 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3377 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3378 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3379 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3380 doing such tests.
3381
3382 .vitem &%-bV%&
3383 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3384 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3385 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3386 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3387 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3388 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3389 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3390
3391 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3392 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3393 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3394 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3395 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3396 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3397 dynamic testing facilities.
3398
3399 .vitem &%-bv%&
3400 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3402 .cindex "address" "verification"
3403 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3404 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3405 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3406 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3407 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3408 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3409
3410 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3411 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3412 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3413
3414 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3415 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3416
3417 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3418 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3419 security issues.
3420
3421 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3422 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3423 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3424 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3425 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3426
3427 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3428 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3429 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3430 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3431 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3432 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3433 to succeed.
3434
3435 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3436 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3437 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3438
3439 The
3440 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3441 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3442 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3443 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3444
3445 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3446 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3447 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3448 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3449
3450 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3451 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3452 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3453 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3454 might happen.
3455
3456 .vitem &%-bw%&
3457 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3458 .cindex "daemon"
3459 .cindex "inetd"
3460 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3461 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3462 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3463 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3464
3465 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3466 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3467 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3468 each port only when the first connection is received.
3469
3470 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3471 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3472
3473 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3474 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3475 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3476 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3477 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3478 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3479 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3480 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3481 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3482 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3483 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3484
3485 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3486 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3487 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3488 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3489 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3490 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3491 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3492 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3493 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3494
3495 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3496 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3497 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3498 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3499 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3500 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3501 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3502
3503 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3504 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3505 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3506 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3507 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3508 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3509 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3510
3511 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3512 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3513 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3514 configuration file.
3515
3516 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3517 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3518 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3519 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3520 specified by this option.
3521
3522
3523 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3524 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3525 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3526 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3527 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3528 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3529 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3530 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3531
3532 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3533 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3534 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3535 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3536 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3537 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3538 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3539
3540 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3541 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3542 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3543 synonymous:
3544 .code
3545 exim -DABC ...
3546 exim -DABC= ...
3547 .endd
3548 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3549 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3550 example:
3551 .code
3552 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3553 .endd
3554 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3555 .new
3556 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3557 .wen
3558
3559
3560 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3561 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3562 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3563 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3564 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3565 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3566 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3567 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3568 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3569 return code.
3570
3571 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3572 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3573 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3574 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3575 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3576 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3577 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3578 are:
3579 .display
3580 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3581 &`auth `& authenticators
3582 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3583 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3584 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3585 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3586 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3587 &`filter `& filter handling
3588 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3589 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3590 &`ident `& ident lookup
3591 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3592 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3593 &`load `& system load checks
3594 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3595 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3596 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3597 &`memory `& memory handling
3598 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3599 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3600 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3601 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3602 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3603 &`retry `& retry handling
3604 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3605 &`route `& address routing
3606 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3607 &`tls `& TLS logic
3608 &`transport `& transports
3609 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3610 &`verify `& address verification logic
3611 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3612 .endd
3613 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3614 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3615 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3616 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3617 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3618 turn everything off.
3619
3620 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3621 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3622 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3623 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3624 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3625 rather than stderr.
3626
3627 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3628 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3629 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3630 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3631 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3632 run in parallel.
3633
3634 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3635 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3636 in processing.
3637
3638 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3639 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3640
3641 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3642 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3643 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3644 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3645 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3646 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3647
3648 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3649 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3650 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3651 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3652 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3653
3654 .vitem &%-E%&
3655 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3656 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3657 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3658 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3659 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3660 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3661 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3662 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3663 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3664
3665 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3666 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3667 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3668 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3669 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3670 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3671
3672 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3673 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3674 .cindex "sender" "name"
3675 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3676 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3677 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3678 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3679 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3680 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3681
3682 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3683 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3684 .cindex "sender" "address"
3685 .cindex "address" "sender"
3686 .cindex "trusted users"
3687 .cindex "envelope sender"
3688 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3689 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3690 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3691 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3692 users to use it.
3693
3694 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3695 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3696 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3697 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3698 domain.
3699
3700 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3701 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3702 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3703 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3704 examples of shell commands:
3705 .code
3706 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3707 exim -f "" user@domain
3708 .endd
3709 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3710 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3711 &%-bv%& options.
3712
3713 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3714 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3715 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3716 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3717
3718 White
3719 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3720 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3721 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3722 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3723 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3724 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3725
3726 .vitem &%-G%&
3727 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3728 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3729 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3730 .code
3731 control = suppress_local_fixups
3732 .endd
3733 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3734 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3735 in future.
3736
3737 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3738 this option.
3739
3740 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3741 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3742 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3743 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3744 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3745 headers.)
3746
3747 .vitem &%-i%&
3748 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3749 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3750 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3751 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3752 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3753 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3754 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3755
3756 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3757 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3758 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3759 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3760 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3761 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3762 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3763 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3764
3765 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3766
3767 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3768 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3769 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3770 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3771 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3772 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3773 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3774 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3775 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3776
3777 Retry
3778 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3779 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3780 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3781 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3782 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3783 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3784
3785 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3786 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3787 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3788 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3789
3790 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3791 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3792 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3793 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3794 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3795 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3796 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3797 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3798 can be used only by an admin user.
3799
3800 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3801 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3802 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3803 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3804 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3805 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3806 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3807 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3808 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3809 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3810 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3811
3812 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3813 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3814 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3815 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3816 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3817
3818 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3819 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3820 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3821 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3822 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3823
3824 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3825 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3826 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3827 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3828 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3829
3830 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3831 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3832 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3833 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3834 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3835 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3836 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3837 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3838
3839 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3840 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3841 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3842 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3843 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3844 connection.
3845
3846 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3847 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3848 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3849 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3850 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3851
3852 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3853 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3854 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3855 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3856 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3857 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3858 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3859 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3860 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3861 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3862 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3863 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3864 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3865 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3866 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3867
3868 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3869 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3870 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3871 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3872 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3873 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3874 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3875 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3876 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3877 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3878
3879 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3880 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3881 .cindex "freezing messages"
3882 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3883 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3884 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3885 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3886 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3887 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3888 user.
3889
3890 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3891 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3892 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3893 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3894 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3895 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3896 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3897 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3898 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3899 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3900 user.
3901
3902 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3904 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3905 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3906 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3907 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3908 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3909
3910 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3911 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3912 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3913 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3914 .cindex "removing recipients"
3915 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3916 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3917 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3918 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3919 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3920 can be used only by an admin user.
3921
3922 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3923 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3924 .cindex "removing messages"
3925 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3926 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3927 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3928 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3929 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3930 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3931 placed on the queue.
3932
3933 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3934 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3935 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3936 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3937 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3938 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3939 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3940 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3941 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3942 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3943 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3944
3945 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3946 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3947 .cindex "thawing messages"
3948 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3949 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3950 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3951 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3952 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3953 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3954 by an admin user.
3955
3956 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3958 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3959 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3960 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3961 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3962
3963 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3964 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3965 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3966 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3967 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3968 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3969 only by an admin user.
3970
3971 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3972 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3973 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3974 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3975 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3976 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3977 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3980 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3981 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3982 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3983 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3984 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986 .vitem &%-m%&
3987 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3988 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3989 treats it that way too.
3990
3991 .vitem &%-N%&
3992 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3993 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3994 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3995 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3996 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3997 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3998 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3999 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4000 than &"=>"&.
4001
4002 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4003 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4004 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4005 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4006 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4007 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4008 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4009 for that message.
4010
4011 .vitem &%-n%&
4012 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4013 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4014 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4015 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4016
4017 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4018 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4019 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4020 Exim.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4023 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4024 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4025 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4026 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4027 description above.
4028
4029 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4030 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4031 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4032 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4033 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4034 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4035 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4036 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4037
4038 .vitem &%-odb%&
4039 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4040 .cindex "background delivery"
4041 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4042 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4043 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4044 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4045 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4046 processes to finish.
4047
4048 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4049 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4050 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4051 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4052
4053 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4054 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4055 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4056 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4057
4058 .vitem &%-odf%&
4059 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4060 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4061 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4062 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4063 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4064 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4065 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4066
4067 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4068 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4069 during deliveries.
4070
4071 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4072 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4073
4074 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4075 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4076 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4077 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4078
4079
4080 .vitem &%-odi%&
4081 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4082 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4083 Sendmail.
4084
4085 .vitem &%-odq%&
4086 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4087 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4088 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4089 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4090 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4091 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4092 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4093 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4094 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4095 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4096 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4097 forces queueing.
4098
4099 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4100 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4101 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4102 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4103 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4104 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4105 configuration file is in effect.
4106
4107 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4108 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4109 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4110 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4111 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4112 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4113 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4114 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4115 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4116 &%-qq%& option.
4117
4118 .vitem &%-oee%&
4119 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4120 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4121 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4122 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4123 message.
4124
4125 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4126 Provided
4127 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4128 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4129 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4130 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4131
4132 .vitem &%-oem%&
4133 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4134 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4136 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4137 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4138 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4139
4140 .vitem &%-oep%&
4141 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4142 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4143 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4144 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4145 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4146 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4147
4148 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4149 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4150 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4151 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4152 effect as &%-oep%&.
4153
4154 .vitem &%-oew%&
4155 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4156 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4157 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4158 effect as &%-oem%&.
4159
4160 .vitem &%-oi%&
4161 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4162 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4163 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4164 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4165 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4166 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4167 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4168
4169 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4170 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4171 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4172
4173 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4174 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4175 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4176 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4177 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4178 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4179 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4180 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4181
4182 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4183 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4184 .code
4185 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4186 .endd
4187 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4188 followed by a colon and the port number:
4189 .code
4190 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4191 .endd
4192 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4193 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4194 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4195 whichever one is last.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4198 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4199 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4200 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4201 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4202 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4203 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4204 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4205
4206 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4207 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4208 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4209 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4210 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4211 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4212 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4213 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4214
4215 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4216 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4217 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4218 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4219 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4220 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4221 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4222 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4223 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4224 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4225
4226 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4227 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4228 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4229 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4230 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4231 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4232 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4233
4234 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4235 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4236 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4238 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4239 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4240 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4241 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4242 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4243
4244 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4245 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4246 is sending the bounce.
4247
4248 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4249 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4250 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4251 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4252 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4253 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4254 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4255 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4256 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4257 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4258 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4259 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4260
4261 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4262 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4263 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4264 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4265 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4266 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4267 uses the name it is given.
4268
4269 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4270 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4271 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4272 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4273 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4274 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4275 used, when there is no default.
4276
4277 .vitem &%-om%&
4278 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4279 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4280 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4281 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4282 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4283
4284 .vitem &%-oo%&
4285 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4286 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4287 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4288 whatever that means.
4289
4290 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4291 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4292 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4293 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4294 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4295 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4296 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4297 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4298 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4299
4300 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4301 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4302 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4303 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4304 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4305 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4306 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4309 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4310 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4311 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4312 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4313 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4314 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4315 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4316
4317 .vitem &%-ov%&
4318 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4319 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4320
4321 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4322 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4323 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4324 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4325 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4326 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4327 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4328 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4329 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4330 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4331
4332 .vitem &%-pd%&
4333 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4334 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4335 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4336 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4337 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4338 needed.
4339
4340 .vitem &%-ps%&
4341 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4342 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4343 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4344 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4345 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4346 started.
4347
4348 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4349 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4350 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4351 .display
4352 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4353 .endd
4354 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4355 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4356 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4357 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4358 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4359
4360 .vitem &%-q%&
4361 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4362 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4363 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4364 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4365 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4366 and &%-S%& options).
4367
4368 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4369 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4370 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4371 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4372 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4373 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4374
4375 If
4376 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4377 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4378 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4379 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4380 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4381 proceeding.
4382
4383 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4384 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4385 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4386 this to be repeated periodically.
4387
4388 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4389 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4390 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4391 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4392
4393 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4394 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4395 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4396
4397 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4398 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4399 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4400 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4401
4402 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4403 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4404 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4405 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4406 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4407 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4408 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4409 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4410 transports are run.
4411
4412 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4413 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4414 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4415 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4416 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4417 delivered down a single SMTP
4418 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4419 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4420 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4421 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4422 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4423 intermittently.
4424
4425 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4426 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4427 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4428 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4429 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4430 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4431 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4432
4433 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4434 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4435 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4436 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4437 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4438 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4439 their retry times are tried.
4440
4441 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4442 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4443 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4444 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4445 frozen or not.
4446
4447 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4448 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4449 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4450 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4451 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4452 for later delivery.
4453
4454 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4455 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4456 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4457 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4458 starting message id. For example:
4459 .code
4460 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4461 .endd
4462 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4463 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4464 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4465 .code
4466 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4467 .endd
4468 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4469 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4470 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4471 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4472 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4473 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4474
4475 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4476 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4477 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4478 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4479 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4480 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4481 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4482 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4483 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4484 .code
4485 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4486 .endd
4487 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4488 process every 30 minutes.
4489
4490 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4491 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4492
4493 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4494 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4495 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4496 compatibility.
4497
4498 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4499 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4500 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4501
4502 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4503 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4504 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4505 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4506 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4507 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4508 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4509 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4510 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4511
4512 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4513 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4514 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4515 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4516 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4517 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4518
4519 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4520 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4521 .code
4522 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4523 .endd
4524 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4525 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4526 applied to each queue run.
4527
4528 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4529 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4530 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4531 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4532 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4533 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4534 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4535 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4536 address will be skipped.
4537
4538 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4539 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4540 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4541 &'ff'& is present.
4542
4543 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4544 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4545 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4546 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4547 an arbitrary command instead.
4548
4549 .vitem &%-r%&
4550 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4551 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4552
4553 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4554 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4555 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4556 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4557 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4558 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4559 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4560 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4561
4562 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4563 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4564 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4565 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4566 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4567
4568 .vitem &%-t%&
4569 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4570 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4571 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4572 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4573 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4574 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4575 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4576 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4577 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4578 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4579
4580 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4581 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4582 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4583 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4584 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4585 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4586 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4587 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4588 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4589 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4590 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4591
4592 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4593 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4594 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4595 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4596 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4597 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4598
4599 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4600 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4601 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4602 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4603 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4604 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4605 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4606 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4607 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4608
4609 .vitem &%-ti%&
4610 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4611 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4612 compatibility with Sendmail.
4613
4614 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4615 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4616 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4617 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4618 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4619 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4620 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4621 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4622
4623
4624 .vitem &%-U%&
4625 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4626 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4627 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4628 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4629 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4630 set. Exim ignores this option.
4631
4632 .vitem &%-v%&
4633 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4634 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4635 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4636 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4637 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4638 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4639 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4640 unconditional.
4641
4642 .vitem &%-x%&
4643 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4644 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4645 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4646 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4647 this option.
4648
4649 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4650 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4651 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4652 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4653
4654 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4655 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4656 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4657 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4658 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4659 under most shells.
4660 .endlist
4661
4662 .ecindex IIDclo1
4663 .ecindex IIDclo2
4664
4665
4666 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4667 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4668 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4669 . creates a man page for the options.
4670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4671
4672 .literal xml
4673 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4674 .literal off
4675
4676
4677
4678
4679
4680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4682
4683
4684 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4685 "The runtime configuration file"
4686
4687 .cindex "run time configuration"
4688 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4689 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4690 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4691 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4692 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4693 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4694 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4695 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4696 control.
4697
4698 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4699 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4700 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4701 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4702 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4703 actually alter the string.
4704
4705 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4706 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4707 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4708 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4709 existing file in the list.
4710
4711 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4712 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4713 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4714 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4715 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4716 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4717 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4718 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4719 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4720 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4721 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4722
4723 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4724 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4725 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4726 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4727 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4728
4729 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4730 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4731 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4732 compromise the Exim user account.
4733
4734 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4735 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4736 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4737 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4738 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4739 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4740 configuration.
4741
4742
4743
4744 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4745 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4746 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4747 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4748 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4749 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4750 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4751 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4752 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4753 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4754 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4755
4756 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4757 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4758 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4759 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4760 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4761 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4762 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4763 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4764 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4765 &%-M%&).
4766
4767 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4768 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4769 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4770 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4771 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4772
4773 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4774 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4775 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4776 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4777 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4778 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4779
4780 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4781 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4782 necessarily be discarded.
4783 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4784 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4785 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4786 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4787 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4788 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4789
4790 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4791 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4792 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4793 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4794 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4795 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4796 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4797
4798 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4799 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4800 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4801
4802
4803
4804 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4805 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4806 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4807 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4808 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4809 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4810 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4811 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4812
4813 .ilist
4814 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4815 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4816 .next
4817 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4818 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4819 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4820 .next
4821 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4822 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4823 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4824 .next
4825 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4826 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4827 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4828 .next
4829 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4830 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4831 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4832 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4833 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4834 .next
4835 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4836 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4837 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4838 .next
4839 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4840 want to use this feature, you must set
4841 .code
4842 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4843 .endd
4844 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4845 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4846 .endlist
4847
4848 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4849 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4850 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4851 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4852
4853 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4854 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4855 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4856 and does not introduce a comment.
4857
4858 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4859 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4860 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4861 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4862 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4863
4864 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4865 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4866 change settings as required.
4867
4868 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4869 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4870 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4871 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4872 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4873 described.
4874
4875
4876
4877 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4878 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4879 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4880 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4881 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4882 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4883 using this syntax:
4884 .display
4885 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4886 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4887 .endd
4888 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4889 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4890 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4891 name is required.
4892
4893 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4894 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4895 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4896 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4897
4898 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4899 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4900 for example:
4901 .code
4902 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4903 .include /some/file
4904 .endd
4905 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4906 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4907 inclusion appears.
4908
4909
4910
4911 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4912 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4913 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4914 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4915 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4916 definition, and must be of the form
4917 .display
4918 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4919 .endd
4920 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4921 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4922 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4923 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4924 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4925
4926 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4927 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4928 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4929
4930 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4931 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4932 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4933 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4934 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4935 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4936 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4937 define
4938 .display
4939 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4940 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4941 .endd
4942 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4943 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4944 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4945 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4946 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4947 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4948
4949
4950 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4951 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4952 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4953 &'='&. For example:
4954 .code
4955 MAC = initial value
4956 ...
4957 MAC == updated value
4958 .endd
4959 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4960 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4961 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4962 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4963 .code
4964 MAC = initial value
4965 ...
4966 MAC == MAC and something added
4967 .endd
4968 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4969 from a number of other files.
4970
4971 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4972 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4973 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4974 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4975 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4976 file to be ignored.
4977
4978
4979
4980 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4981 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4982 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4983 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4984 .code
4985 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4986 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4987 .endd
4988 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4989 .code
4990 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4991 .endd
4992 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4993 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4994 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4995
4996
4997 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4998 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4999 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5000 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5001 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5002 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5003 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5004
5005 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5006 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5007 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5008 line. Thus:
5009 .code
5010 .ifdef AAA
5011 message_size_limit = 50M
5012 .else
5013 message_size_limit = 100M
5014 .endif
5015 .endd
5016 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5017 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5018 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5019 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5020 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5021
5022 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5023 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5024 in this line"& will always be true.
5025
5026 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5027 to clarify complicated nestings.
5028
5029
5030
5031 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5032 .cindex "common option syntax"
5033 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5034 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5035 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5036 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5037 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5038 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5039 space) and then the value. For example:
5040 .code
5041 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5042 .endd
5043 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5044 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5045 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5046 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5047 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5048 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5049 word &"hide"&. For example:
5050 .code
5051 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5052 .endd
5053 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5054 .code
5055 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5056 .endd
5057 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5058 all instances of the same driver.
5059
5060 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5061 that are found in option settings.
5062
5063
5064 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5065 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5066 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5067 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5068 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5069 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5070 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5071 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5072 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5073 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5074 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5075 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5076 .code
5077 queue_only
5078 queue_only = true
5079 .endd
5080 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5081 .code
5082 no_queue_only
5083 queue_only = false
5084 .endd
5085 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5086
5087
5088
5089
5090 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5091 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5092 .cindex "format" "integer"
5093 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5094 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5095 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5096 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5097 hexadecimal number.
5098
5099 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5100 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5101 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5102 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5103 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5104 used.
5105
5106
5107 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5108 .cindex "integer format"
5109 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5110 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5111 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5112 Such options are always output in octal.
5113
5114
5115 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5116 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5117 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5118 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5119 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5120
5121
5122
5123 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5124 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5125 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5126 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5127 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5128
5129 .table2 30pt
5130 .irow &%s%& seconds
5131 .irow &%m%& minutes
5132 .irow &%h%& hours
5133 .irow &%d%& days
5134 .irow &%w%& weeks
5135 .endtable
5136
5137 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5138 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5139 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5140
5141
5142
5143 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5144 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5145 .cindex "format" "string"
5146 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5147 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5148 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5149 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5150 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5151 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5152 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5153 therefore equivalent:
5154 .code
5155 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5156 trusted_users = uucp:\
5157 # This comment line is ignored
5158 mail
5159 .endd
5160 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5161 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5162 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5163 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5164 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5165
5166 .table2 100pt
5167 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5168 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5169 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5170 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5171 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5172 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5173 character"
5174 .endtable
5175
5176 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5177 character, that character replaces the pair.
5178
5179 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5180 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5181 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5182 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5183 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5184 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5185
5186
5187 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5188 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5189 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5190 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5191 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5192 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5193 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5194 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5195 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5196 within a quoted configuration string.
5197
5198
5199 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5200 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5201 .cindex "format" "user name"
5202 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5203 .cindex "format" "group name"
5204 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5205 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5206 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5207 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5208
5209
5210 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5211 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5212 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5213 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5214 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5215 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5216 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5217 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5218 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5219 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5220 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5221
5222 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5223 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5224 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5225 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5226 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5227 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5228 example, the list
5229 .code
5230 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5231 .endd
5232 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5233
5234 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5235 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5236 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5237 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5238
5239 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5240 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5241 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5242 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5243 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5244 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5245 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5246 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5247 .code
5248 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5249 .endd
5250 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5251 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5252 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5253
5254 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5255 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5256 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5257 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5258 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5259 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5260 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5261 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5262 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5263 .code
5264 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5265 .endd
5266 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5267 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5268 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5269 the value in quotes. For example:
5270 .code
5271 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5272 .endd
5273 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5274 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5275 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5276 enclosing an empty list item.
5277
5278
5279
5280 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5281 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5282 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5283 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5284 .code
5285 senders = user@domain :
5286 .endd
5287 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5288 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5289 items, the second of which is empty:
5290 .code
5291 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5292 .endd
5293 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5294 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5295 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5296 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5297 .code
5298 senders = :
5299 .endd
5300 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5301 is at the end of the list.
5302
5303
5304
5305
5306 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5307 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5308 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5309 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5310 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5311 a sequence of lines like this:
5312 .display
5313 <&'instance name'&>:
5314 <&'option'&>
5315 ...
5316 <&'option'&>
5317 .endd
5318 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5319 followed by three options settings:
5320 .code
5321 localuser:
5322 driver = accept
5323 check_local_user
5324 transport = local_delivery
5325 .endd
5326 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5327 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5328 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5329 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5330 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5331 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5332
5333 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5334 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5335
5336 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5337 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5338 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5339 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5340 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5341 server.
5342
5343 .cindex "generic options"
5344 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5345 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5346 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5347 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5348 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5349 .cindex "private options"
5350 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5351 they all have default values.
5352
5353 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5354 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5355 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5356
5357 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5358 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5359 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5360 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5361 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5362 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5363 configuration lines:
5364 .code
5365 remote_smtp:
5366 driver = smtp
5367 .endd
5368 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5369 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5370 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5371 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5372 thus:
5373 .code
5374 special_smtp:
5375 driver = smtp
5376 port = 1234
5377 command_timeout = 10s
5378 .endd
5379 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5380 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5381 lines.
5382
5383 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5384 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5385 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5386 option.
5387
5388
5389
5390
5391
5392
5393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5395
5396 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5397 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5398 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5399 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5400 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5401 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5402 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5403 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5404 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5405 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5406 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5407
5408
5409
5410 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5411 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5412 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5413 the line
5414 .code
5415 # primary_hostname =
5416 .endd
5417 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5418 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5419 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5420 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5421
5422 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5423 .code
5424 domainlist local_domains = @
5425 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5426 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5427 .endd
5428 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5429 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5430 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5431 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5432
5433 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5434 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5435 on the local host.
5436
5437 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5438 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5439 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5440 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5441 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5442 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5443
5444 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5445 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5446 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5447 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5448 domain is permitted.
5449
5450 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5451 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5452 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5453 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5454 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5455 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5456
5457 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5458 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5459 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5460
5461 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5462 .code
5463 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5464 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5465 .endd
5466 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5467 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5468 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5469 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5470 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5471 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5472 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5473 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5474 contents of a message to be checked.
5475
5476 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5477 .code
5478 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5479 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5480 .endd
5481 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5482 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5483 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5484 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5485
5486 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5487 .code
5488 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5489 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5490 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5491 .endd
5492 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5493 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5494 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5495 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5496 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5497 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5498 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5499
5500 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5501 .code
5502 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5503 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5504 .endd
5505 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5506 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5507 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5508 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5509 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5510 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5511 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5512 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5513 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5514 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5515 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5516 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5517 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5518 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5519 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5520 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5521
5522 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5523 .code
5524 # qualify_domain =
5525 # qualify_recipient =
5526 .endd
5527 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5528 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5529 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5530 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5531 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5532 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5533
5534 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5535 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5536 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5537 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5538 .code
5539 # allow_domain_literals
5540 .endd
5541 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5542 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5543 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5544 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5545 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5546 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5547
5548 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5549 .code
5550 never_users = root
5551 .endd
5552 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5553 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5554 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5555 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5556 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5557 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5558 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5559 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5560
5561 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5562 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5563 line,
5564 .code
5565 host_lookup = *
5566 .endd
5567 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5568 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5569 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5570 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5571 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5572 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5573 unreachable.
5574
5575 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5576 1413 (hence their names):
5577 .code
5578 rfc1413_hosts = *
5579 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5580 .endd
5581 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5582 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5583 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5584 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5585 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5586 information, you can change this.
5587
5588 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5589 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5590 .code
5591 prdr_enable = true
5592 .endd
5593
5594 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5595 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5596 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5597 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5598 .code
5599 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5600 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5601 .endd
5602 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5603 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5604
5605 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5606 over the default:
5607 .code
5608 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5609 +tls_certificate_verified
5610 .endd
5611
5612 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5613 .code
5614 # percent_hack_domains =
5615 .endd
5616 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5617 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5618 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5619
5620 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5621 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5622 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5623 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5624 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5625 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5626 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5627 always bounce messages.
5628 .code
5629 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5630 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5631 .endd
5632 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5633 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5634 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5635 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5636 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5637
5638
5639
5640 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5641 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5642 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5643 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5644 It starts with the line
5645 .code
5646 begin acl
5647 .endd
5648 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5649 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5650 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5651
5652 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5653 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5654 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5655 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5656 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5657 result of the ACL processing.
5658 .code
5659 acl_check_rcpt:
5660 .endd
5661 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5662 ACL, and names it.
5663 .code
5664 accept hosts = :
5665 .endd
5666 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5667 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5668 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5669 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5670 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5671 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5672
5673 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5674 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5675 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5676 manner.
5677 .code
5678 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5679 domains = +local_domains
5680 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5681
5682 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5683 domains = !+local_domains
5684 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5685 .endd
5686 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5687 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5688 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5689 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5690 in Internet mail addresses.
5691
5692 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5693 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5694 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5695 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5696 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5697 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5698 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5699 policy of being as safe as possible.
5700
5701 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5702 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5703 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5704 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5705 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5706 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5707
5708 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5709 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5710 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5711 have to modify this rule.
5712
5713 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5714 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5715 common convention of local parts constructed as
5716 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5717 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5718 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5719 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5720 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5721 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5722
5723 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5724 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5725 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5726 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5727 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5728 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5729 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5730 .code
5731 accept local_parts = postmaster
5732 domains = +local_domains
5733 .endd
5734 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5735 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5736 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5737 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5738 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5739
5740 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5741 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5742 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5743 .code
5744 require verify = sender
5745 .endd
5746 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5747 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5748 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5749 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5750 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5751 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5752 discusses the details of address verification.
5753 .code
5754 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5755 control = submission
5756 .endd
5757 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5758 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5759 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5760 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5761 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5762 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5763 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5764 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5765 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5766 .code
5767 accept authenticated = *
5768 control = submission
5769 .endd
5770 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5771 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5772 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5773 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5774 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5775 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5776 .code
5777 require message = relay not permitted
5778 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5779 .endd
5780 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5781 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5782 .code
5783 require verify = recipient
5784 .endd
5785 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5786 fails, the address is rejected.
5787 .code
5788 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5789 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5790 # $dnslist_text
5791 # dnslists = black.list.example
5792 #
5793 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5794 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5795 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5796 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5797 .endd
5798 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5799 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5800 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5801 line.
5802 .code
5803 # require verify = csa
5804 .endd
5805 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5806 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5807 records.
5808 .code
5809 accept
5810 .endd
5811 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5812 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5813 .code
5814 acl_check_data:
5815 .endd
5816 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5817 of this ACL are commented out:
5818 .code
5819 # deny malware = *
5820 # message = This message contains a virus \
5821 # ($malware_name).
5822 .endd
5823 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5824 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5825 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5826 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5827 .code
5828 # warn spam = nobody
5829 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5830 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5831 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5832 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5833 .endd
5834 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5835 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5836 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5837 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5838 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5839 whatever the spam score.
5840 .code
5841 accept
5842 .endd
5843 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5844
5845
5846 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5847 .cindex "default" "routers"
5848 .cindex "routers" "default"
5849 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5850 by the line
5851 .code
5852 begin routers
5853 .endd
5854 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5855 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5856 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5857 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5858 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5859 .code
5860 # domain_literal:
5861 # driver = ipliteral
5862 # domains = !+local_domains
5863 # transport = remote_smtp
5864 .endd
5865 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5866 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5867 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5868 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5869 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5870 .code
5871 dnslookup:
5872 driver = dnslookup
5873 domains = ! +local_domains
5874 transport = remote_smtp
5875 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5876 no_more
5877 .endd
5878 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5879 domains. This is specified by the line
5880 .code
5881 domains = ! +local_domains
5882 .endd
5883 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5884 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5885 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5886 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5887 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5888 passed on to the following routers.
5889
5890 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5891 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5892 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5893 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5894 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5895
5896 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5897 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5898 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5899 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5900 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5901 the address fails and is bounced.
5902
5903 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5904 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5905 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5906 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5907 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5908 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5909 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5910 out.
5911 .code
5912 system_aliases:
5913 driver = redirect
5914 allow_fail
5915 allow_defer
5916 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5917 # user = exim
5918 file_transport = address_file
5919 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5920 .endd
5921 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5922 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5923 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5924 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5925 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5926 the next router.
5927
5928 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5929 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5930 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5931 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5932 .code
5933 userforward:
5934 driver = redirect
5935 check_local_user
5936 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5937 # local_part_suffix_optional
5938 file = $home/.forward
5939 # allow_filter
5940 no_verify
5941 no_expn
5942 check_ancestor
5943 file_transport = address_file
5944 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5945 reply_transport = address_reply
5946 .endd
5947 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5948 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5949 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5950 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5951 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5952 namely:
5953 .code
5954 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5955 # local_part_suffix_optional
5956 .endd
5957 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5958 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5959 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5960 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5961 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5962 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5963 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5964
5965 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5966 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5967 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5968 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5969
5970 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5971 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5972 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5973 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5974 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5975 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5976 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5977
5978 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5979 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5980 There are two reasons for doing this:
5981
5982 .olist
5983 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5984 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5985 unnecessary work.
5986 .next
5987 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5988 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5989 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5990 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5991 this time.
5992 .endlist
5993
5994 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5995 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5996 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5997 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5998
5999 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6000 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6001 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6002 .code
6003 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6004 .endd
6005 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6006 transport.
6007 .code
6008 localuser:
6009 driver = accept
6010 check_local_user
6011 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6012 # local_part_suffix_optional
6013 transport = local_delivery
6014 .endd
6015 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6016 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6017 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6018 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6019 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6020
6021
6022 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6023 .cindex "default" "transports"
6024 .cindex "transports" "default"
6025 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6026 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6027 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6028 .code
6029 begin transports
6030 .endd
6031 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6032 .code
6033 remote_smtp:
6034 driver = smtp
6035 hosts_try_prdr = *
6036 .endd
6037 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6038 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6039 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6040 It is negotiated between client and server
6041 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6042 All other options are defaulted.
6043 .code
6044 local_delivery:
6045 driver = appendfile
6046 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6047 delivery_date_add
6048 envelope_to_add
6049 return_path_add
6050 # group = mail
6051 # mode = 0660
6052 .endd
6053 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6054 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6055 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6056 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6057 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6058 show how this can be done.
6059
6060 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6061 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6062 similarly-named options above.
6063 .code
6064 address_pipe:
6065 driver = pipe
6066 return_output
6067 .endd
6068 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6069 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6070 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6071 be returned to the sender.
6072 .code
6073 address_file:
6074 driver = appendfile
6075 delivery_date_add
6076 envelope_to_add
6077 return_path_add
6078 .endd
6079 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6080 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6081 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6082 .code
6083 address_reply:
6084 driver = autoreply
6085 .endd
6086 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6087 filter files.
6088
6089
6090
6091 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6092 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6093 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6094 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6095 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6096 introduced by the line
6097 .code
6098 begin retry
6099 .endd
6100 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6101 errors:
6102 .code
6103 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6104 .endd
6105 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6106 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6107 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6108 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6109
6110 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6111 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6112 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6113
6114
6115 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6116 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6117 .code
6118 begin rewrite
6119 .endd
6120 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6121 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6122
6123
6124
6125 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6126 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6127 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6128 .code
6129 begin authenticators
6130 .endd
6131 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6132 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6133 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6134 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6135 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6136 to support most MUA software.
6137
6138 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6139 .code
6140 #PLAIN:
6141 # driver = plaintext
6142 # server_set_id = $auth2
6143 # server_prompts = :
6144 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6145 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6146 .endd
6147 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6148 .code
6149 #LOGIN:
6150 # driver = plaintext
6151 # server_set_id = $auth1
6152 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6153 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6154 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6155 .endd
6156
6157 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6158 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6159 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6160 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6161 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6162 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6163 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6164 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6165
6166 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6167 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6168 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6169 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6170
6171 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6172 usercode and password are in different positions.
6173 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6174
6175 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6176
6177
6178
6179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6181
6182 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6183
6184 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6185 .cindex "PCRE"
6186 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6187 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6188 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6189 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6190 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6191 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6192
6193 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6194 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6195 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6196 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6197 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6198 case-insensitive.
6199
6200 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6201 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6202 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6203 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6204 .code
6205 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6206 .endd
6207 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6208 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6209 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6210 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6211 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6212 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6213 matched.
6214
6215 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6216 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6217 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6218 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6219 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6220 match anywhere in the subject string.
6221
6222 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6223 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6224 .code
6225 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6226 .endd
6227 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6228 You need to use:
6229 .code
6230 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6231 .endd
6232 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6233 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6234
6235
6236
6237 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6238 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6239
6240 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6241 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6242 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6243 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6244 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6245 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6246
6247 .olist
6248 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6249 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6250 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6251 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6252 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6253 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6254 .next
6255 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6256 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6257 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6258 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6259 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6260 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6261 .endlist
6262
6263 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6264 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6265 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6266 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6267 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6268 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6269
6270 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6271 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6272 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6273 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6274 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6275 .code
6276 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6277 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6278 .endd
6279 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6280 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6281 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6282 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6283 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6284 .code
6285 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6286 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6287 .endd
6288 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6289 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6290
6291 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6292 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6293 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6294 .code
6295 domain1:
6296 domain2:
6297 .endd
6298 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6299 matches the list item.
6300
6301 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6302 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6303 .code
6304 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6305 .endd
6306 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6307 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6308 causes a second lookup to occur.
6309
6310 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6311 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6312 lookup is permitted.
6313
6314
6315 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6316 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6317 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6318 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6319
6320 .ilist
6321 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6322 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6323 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6324 .next
6325 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6326 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6327 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6328 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6329 .endlist
6330
6331 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6332 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6333 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6334 .code
6335 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6336 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6337 .endd
6338 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6339 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6340 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6341
6342
6343
6344
6345 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6346 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6347 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6348 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6349
6350 .ilist
6351 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6352 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6353 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6354 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6355 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6356 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6357 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6358 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6359 be found in several places:
6360 .display
6361 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6362 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6363 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6364 .endd
6365 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6366 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6367 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6368 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6369 .next
6370 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6371 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6372 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6373 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6374 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6375 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6376 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6377
6378 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6379 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6380 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6381 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6382 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6383 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6384 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6385 .next
6386 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6387 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6388 .cindex "sasldb2"
6389 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6390 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6391 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6392 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6393 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6394 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6395 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6396 .next
6397 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6398 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6399 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6400 .cindex "Courier"
6401 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6402 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6403 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6404 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6405 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6406 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6407 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6408 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6409 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6410 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6411 .next
6412 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6413 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6414 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6415 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6416 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6417 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6418 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6419 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6420 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6421 .next
6422 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6423 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6424 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6425 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6426 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6427 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6428 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6429 .code
6430 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6431 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6432 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6433 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6434 .endd
6435 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6436 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6437 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6438 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6439 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6440
6441 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6442 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6443 lookup types support only literal keys.
6444
6445 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6446 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6447 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6448 .next
6449 .cindex "linear search"
6450 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6451 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6452 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6453 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6454 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6455 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6456 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6457 in the file is used.
6458
6459 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6460 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6461 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6462 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6463 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6464 colon, for example:
6465 .code
6466 baduser: :fail:
6467 .endd
6468 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6469 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6470 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6471 wildcarding of any kind.
6472
6473 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6474 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6475 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6476 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6477 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6478 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6479 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6480 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6481 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6482
6483 .next
6484 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6485 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6486 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6487 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6488 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6489 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6490 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6491 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6492
6493 .next
6494 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6495 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6496 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6497 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6498 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6499 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6500 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6501 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6502 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6503
6504 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6505 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6506 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6507 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6508
6509 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6510 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6511
6512 .olist
6513 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6514 .code
6515 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6516 *fish data for anythingfish
6517 .endd
6518 .next
6519 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6520 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6521 .code
6522 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6523 .endd
6524 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6525 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6526 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6527 .code
6528 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6529 .endd
6530 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6531 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6532 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6533 .code
6534 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6535 .endd
6536
6537 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6538 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6539 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6540 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6541 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6542
6543 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6544 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6545 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6546 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6547 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6548
6549 .next
6550 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6551 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6552 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6553 example:
6554 .code
6555 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6556 .endd
6557 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6558 .endlist olist
6559
6560 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6561 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6562 be followed by optional colons.
6563
6564 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6565 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6566 lookup types support only literal keys.
6567 .endlist ilist
6568
6569
6570 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6571 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6572 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6573 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6574 many of them are given in later sections.
6575
6576 .ilist
6577 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6578 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6579 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6580 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6581 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6582 .next
6583 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6584 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6585 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6586 .next
6587 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6588 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6589 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6590 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6591 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6592 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6593 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6594 .next
6595 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6596 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6597 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6598 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6599 .next
6600 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6601 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6602 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6603 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6604 .next
6605 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6606 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6607 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6608 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6609 .next
6610 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6611 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6612 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6613 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6614 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6615 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6616 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6617 password value. For example:
6618 .code
6619 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6620 .endd
6621 .next
6622 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6623 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6624 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6625 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6626
6627 .next
6628 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6629 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6630 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6631 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6632
6633 .next
6634 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6635 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6636 .next
6637 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6638 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6639 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6640 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6641 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6642 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6643 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6644 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6645 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6646 .code
6647 require condition = \
6648 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6649 .endd
6650 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6651 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6652 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6653 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6654 .endlist
6655
6656
6657
6658 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6659 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6660 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6661 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6662 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6663 options such as a list of local domains.
6664
6665 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6666 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6667 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6668 or may give up altogether.
6669
6670
6671
6672 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6673 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6674 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6675 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6676 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6677 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6678 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6679 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6680
6681 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6682 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6683 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6684
6685 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6686 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6687 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6688
6689 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6690 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6691 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6692 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6693 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6694 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6695 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6696 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6697 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6698 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6699 .code
6700 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6701 .endd
6702 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6703 looks up these keys, in this order:
6704 .code
6705 jane@eyre.example
6706 *@eyre.example
6707 *
6708 .endd
6709 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6710 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6711 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6712 Exim move on to try the next key.
6713
6714
6715
6716 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6717 .cindex "partial matching"
6718 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6719 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6720 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6721 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6722 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6723 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6724 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6725 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6726 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6727 a key in a DBM file is
6728 .code
6729 *.dates.fict.example
6730 .endd
6731 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6732 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6733 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6734 file.
6735
6736 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6737 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6738 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6739
6740 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6741 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6742 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6743 partial matching keys
6744 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6745 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6746 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6747
6748 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6749 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6750 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6751 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6752 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6753 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6754 remains.
6755
6756 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6757 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6758 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6759 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6760 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6761 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6762 .code
6763 2250.dates.fict.example
6764 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6765 *.dates.fict.example
6766 *.fict.example
6767 .endd
6768 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6769 finishes.
6770
6771 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6772 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6773 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6774 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6775 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6776 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6777 .code
6778 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6779 .endd
6780 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6781 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6782 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6783 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6784 .code
6785 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6786 .endd
6787 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6788 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6789
6790 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6791 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6792 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6793
6794 .ilist
6795 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6796 .next
6797 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6798 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6799 .next
6800 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6801 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6802 for &"*"& on its own.
6803 .next
6804 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6805 .endlist
6806
6807
6808 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6809 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6810 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6811 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6812 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6813 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6814 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6815
6816 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6817 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6818 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6819 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6820 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6821
6822
6823
6824
6825 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6826 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6827 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6828 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6829 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6830 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6831 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6832
6833 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6834 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6835 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6836 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6837 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6838 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6839
6840 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6841 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6842 complete.
6843
6844
6845
6846
6847 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6848 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6849 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6850 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6851 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6852 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6853 .code
6854 [name=$local_part]
6855 .endd
6856 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6857 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6858 .code
6859 [name="$local_part"]
6860 .endd
6861 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6862 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6863 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6864 of the following form is provided:
6865 .code
6866 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6867 .endd
6868 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6869 .code
6870 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6871 .endd
6872 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6873 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6874 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6875
6876
6877
6878
6879 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6880 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6881 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6882 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6883 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6884 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6885 an expansion string could contain:
6886 .code
6887 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6888 .endd
6889 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6890 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6891 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6892 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6893
6894 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6895 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6896 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6897
6898 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6899 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6900 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6901 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6902 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6903 .code
6904 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6905 .endd
6906 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6907 white space is ignored.
6908 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6909 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6910 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6911
6912 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6913 When the type is PTR,
6914 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6915 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6916 .code
6917 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6918 .endd
6919 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6920 altered and nothing is added.
6921
6922 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6923 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6924 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6925 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6926 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6927 The field separator can be modified as above.
6928
6929 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6930 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6931 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6932 unless a field separator is specified.
6933 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6934 For SPF records the
6935 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6936 .code
6937 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6938 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6939 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6940 .endd
6941 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6942 white space is ignored.
6943
6944 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6945 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6946 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6947 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6948 specified.
6949 .code
6950 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6951 .endd
6952
6953 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6954 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6955 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6956 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6957 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6958 each followed by a comma,
6959 that may appear before the record type.
6960
6961 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6962 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6963 a defer-option modifier.
6964 The possible keywords are
6965 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6966 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6967 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6968 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6969 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6970 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6971 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6972 .code
6973 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6974 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6975 .endd
6976 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6977 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6978
6979 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6980 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6981 The possible keywords are
6982 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6983 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6984 with the lookup.
6985 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6986 is not labelled as authenticated data
6987 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6988 The default is &"never"&.
6989
6990 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6991
6992 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6993 .cindex "DNS" timeout
6994 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6995 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
6996 (e.g. &"5s"&).
6997 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
6998
6999 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7000 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7001 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7002
7003 .new
7004 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
7005 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7006 .cindex DNS TTL
7007 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7008 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7009 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7010 .wen
7011
7012
7013 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7014 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7015 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7016 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7017 the pseudo-type MXH:
7018 .code
7019 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7020 .endd
7021 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7022 returned.
7023
7024 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7025 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7026 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7027 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7028 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7029 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7030 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7031 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7032 .code
7033 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7034 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7035 .endd
7036 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7037 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7038 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7039
7040 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7041 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7042 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7043 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7044 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7045 such a list.
7046
7047 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7048 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7049 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7050 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7051 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7052 result of a successful lookup such as:
7053 .code
7054 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7055 .endd
7056 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7057 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7058 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7059
7060 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7061 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7062 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7063 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7064 .code
7065 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7066 .endd
7067
7068
7069 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7070 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7071 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7072 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7073 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7074 .code
7075 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7076 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7077 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7078 .endd
7079 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7080 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7081 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7082 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7083
7084 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7085 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7086 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7087
7088
7089
7090
7091 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7092 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7093 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7094 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7095 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7096 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7097 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7098 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7099 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7100 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7101 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7102 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7103 .code
7104 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7105 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7106 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7107 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7108 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7109 .endd
7110 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7111 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7112
7113 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7114 the way they handle the results of a query:
7115
7116 .ilist
7117 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7118 gives an error.
7119 .next
7120 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7121 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7122 .next
7123 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7124 from all of them are returned.
7125 .endlist
7126
7127
7128 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7129 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7130 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7131 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7132
7133
7134 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7135 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7136 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7137 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7138 .code
7139 data = ${lookup ldap \
7140 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7141 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7142 .endd
7143 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7144 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7145 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7146 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7147
7148 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7149 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7150 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7151
7152 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7153 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7154 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7155 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7156 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7157 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7158 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7159 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7160 &_exim.conf_&.
7161
7162
7163 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7164 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7165 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7166 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7167 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7168 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7169
7170 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7171 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7172 the string:
7173 .code
7174 * => \2A
7175 ( => \28
7176 ) => \29
7177 \ => \5C
7178 .endd
7179 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7180 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7181 .code
7182 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7183 .endd
7184 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7185 .code
7186 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7187 .endd
7188 yields
7189 .code
7190 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7191 .endd
7192 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7193 .code
7194 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7195 .endd
7196 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7197 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7198 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7199 .code
7200 , + " \ < > ;
7201 .endd
7202 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7203 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7204 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7205 .code
7206 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7207 .endd
7208 yields
7209 .code
7210 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7211 .endd
7212 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7213 .code
7214 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7215 .endd
7216 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7217 authentication below.
7218
7219
7220 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7221 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7222 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7223 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7224 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7225 by starting it with
7226 .code
7227 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7228 .endd
7229 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7230 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7231 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7232 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7233 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7234 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7235 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7236 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7237 failures, and timeouts.
7238
7239 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7240 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7241 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7242 doubled. For example
7243 .code
7244 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7245 .endd
7246 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7247 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7248 the local host) is used.
7249
7250 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7251 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7252 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7253 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7254 not available.
7255
7256 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7257 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7258 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7259 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7260 .code
7261 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7262 .endd
7263 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7264 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7265 .code
7266 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7267 .endd
7268 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7269 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7270 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7271 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7272 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7273 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7274 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7275 backup host.
7276
7277 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7278 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7279 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7280
7281 .ilist
7282 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7283 interface.
7284 .next
7285 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7286 .endlist
7287
7288
7289 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7290 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7291
7292
7293
7294 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7295 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7296 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7297 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7298 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7299 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7300 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7301 them. The following names are recognized:
7302 .display
7303 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7304 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7305 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7306 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7307 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7308 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7309 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7310 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7311 .endd
7312 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7313 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7314 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7315 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7316
7317 .cindex LDAP timeout
7318 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7319 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7320 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7321 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7322 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7323 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7324 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7325 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7326 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7327 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7328
7329 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7330 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7331
7332 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7333 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7334 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7335 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7336 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7337 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7338 alternate list (colon-separated).
7339
7340 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7341 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7342 .code
7343 ${lookup ldap
7344 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7345 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7346 {$value}fail}
7347 .endd
7348 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7349 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7350 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7351 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7352
7353 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7354 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7355 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7356
7357 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7358 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7359 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7360 quoting has two advantages:
7361
7362 .ilist
7363 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7364 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7365 .next
7366 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7367 .endlist
7368
7369 For example, a setting such as
7370 .code
7371 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7372 .endd
7373 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7374
7375 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7376 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7377 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7378 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7379 .code
7380 PASS=${quote:$3}
7381 .endd
7382 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7383 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7384 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7385
7386
7387
7388 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7389 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7390 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7391 as a sequence of values, for example
7392 .code
7393 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7394 .endd
7395 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7396 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7397 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7398 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7399 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7400 directory.
7401
7402 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7403 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7404 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7405 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7406
7407 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7408 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7409 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7410 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7411 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7412 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7413 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7414 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7415 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7416
7417 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7418 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7419 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7420 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7421 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7422
7423 .code
7424 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7425 value1.1,value1,,2
7426
7427 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7428 value two
7429
7430 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7431 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7432
7433 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7434 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7435
7436 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7437 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7438 .endd
7439 You can
7440 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7441 results of LDAP lookups.
7442 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7443 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7444 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7445 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7446 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7447 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7448
7449
7450
7451
7452 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7453 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7454 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7455 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7456 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7457 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7458 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7459 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7460 .code
7461 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7462 .endd
7463 might return the string
7464 .code
7465 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7466 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7467 .endd
7468 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7469 .code
7470 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7471 .endd
7472 would just return
7473 .code
7474 Martin Guerre
7475 .endd
7476 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7477 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7478 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7479
7480
7481
7482 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7483 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7484 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7485 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7486 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7487 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7488 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7489 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7490 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7491 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7492 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7493 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7494 might be
7495 .code
7496 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7497 {$value}fail}
7498 .endd
7499 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7500 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7501 .code
7502 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7503 {$value}}
7504 .endd
7505 might be
7506 .code
7507 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7508 .endd
7509 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7510 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7511 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7512 .code
7513 Mister X
7514 .endd
7515 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7516 with a newline between the data for each row.
7517
7518
7519 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7520 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7521 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7522 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7523 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7524 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7525 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7526 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7527 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7528 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7529 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7530 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7531 information.
7532 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7533 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7534 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7535 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7536 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7537 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7538 .code
7539 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7540 .endd
7541 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7542 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7543 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7544 .code
7545 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7546 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7547 .endd
7548 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7549 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7550 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7551 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7552 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7553 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7554
7555 .new
7556 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7557 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7558 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7559 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7560 .wen
7561
7562 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7563 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7564 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7565 done by starting the query with
7566 .display
7567 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7568 .endd
7569 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7570 .olist
7571 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7572 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7573 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7574 taken from there.
7575 .next
7576 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7577 .endlist
7578 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7579 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7580 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7581
7582 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7583 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7584 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7585 like this:
7586 .code
7587 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7588 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7589 master/db/name/pw
7590 .endd
7591 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7592 .code
7593 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7594 .endd
7595 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7596 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7597 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7598 .code
7599 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7600 .endd
7601
7602
7603 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7604 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7605 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7606 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7607 .new
7608 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7609 the default value is &"exim"&.
7610 .wen
7611 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7612 .display
7613 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7614 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7615 .endd
7616 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7617 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7618
7619 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7620 the queries.
7621
7622 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7623 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7624
7625 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7626 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7627 is zero because no rows are affected.
7628
7629
7630 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7631 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7632 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7633 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7634 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7635 looks like this:
7636 .code
7637 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7638 .endd
7639 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7640 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7641 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7642
7643 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7644 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7645 affected.
7646
7647 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7648 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7649 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7650 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7651 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7652 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7653 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7654 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7655 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7656 .code
7657 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7658 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7659 .endd
7660 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7661 .code
7662 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7663 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7664 .endd
7665 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7666 quote, which it doubles.
7667
7668 .cindex timeout SQLite
7669 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7670 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7671 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7672 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7673 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7674 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7675 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7676 option.
7677 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7678 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7679
7680
7681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7683
7684 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7685 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7686 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7687 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7688 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7689 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7690 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7691 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7692 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7693
7694 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7695 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7696 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7697 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7698
7699 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7700 support all the complexity available in
7701 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7702
7703
7704
7705 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7706 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7707 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7708 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7709 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7710 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7711 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7712 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7713
7714
7715 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7716 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7717 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7718
7719 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7720 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7721 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7722 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7723 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7724 .code
7725 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7726 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7727 .endd
7728 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7729 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7730 senders based on the receiving domain.
7731
7732
7733
7734
7735 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7736 .cindex "list" "negation"
7737 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7738 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7739 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7740 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7741 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7742 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7743
7744 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7745 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7746 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7747 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7748 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7749 .code
7750 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7751 .endd
7752 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7753 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7754 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7755 .code
7756 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7757 .endd
7758 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7759 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7760 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7761
7762 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7763 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7764 item.
7765
7766
7767
7768 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7769 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7770 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7771 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7772 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7773 file names are not allowed,
7774 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7775 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7776 lines:
7777
7778 .ilist
7779 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7780 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7781 .next
7782 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7783 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7784 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7785 .code
7786 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7787 .endd
7788 .endlist
7789
7790 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7791 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7792 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7793 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7794
7795 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7796 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7797 .code
7798 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7799 .endd
7800 and the file contains the lines
7801 .code
7802 !a.b.c
7803 *.b.c
7804 .endd
7805 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7806 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7807
7808
7809
7810 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7811 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7812 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7813 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7814 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7815 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7816 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7817 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7818
7819 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7820 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7821 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7822 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7823
7824
7825
7826
7827 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7828 .cindex "named lists"
7829 .cindex "list" "named"
7830 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7831 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7832 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7833 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7834 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7835 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7836 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7837 .code
7838 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7839 .endd
7840 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7841 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7842 configured with the line
7843 .code
7844 domains = +local_domains
7845 .endd
7846 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7847 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7848 .code
7849 dnslookup:
7850 driver = dnslookup
7851 domains = ! +local_domains
7852 transport = remote_smtp
7853 no_more
7854 .endd
7855 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7856 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7857 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7858 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7859 .code
7860 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7861 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7862 .endd
7863 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7864 .code
7865 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7866 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7867 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7868 .endd
7869 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7870 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7871 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7872 .code
7873 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7874 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7875 .endd
7876 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7877 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7878 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7879 .code
7880 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7881 .endd
7882 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7883 referenced lists if you can.
7884
7885 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7886 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7887 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7888 .code
7889 domains = +local_domains
7890 .endd
7891 on several of your routers
7892 or in several ACL statements,
7893 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7894 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7895 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7896 the same each time they are referenced.
7897
7898 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7899 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7900 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7901 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7902
7903
7904
7905 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7906 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7907 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7908 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7909 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7910 write
7911 .code
7912 ALIST = host1 : host2
7913 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7914 .endd
7915 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7916 .code
7917 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7918 .endd
7919 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7920 list, and write
7921 .code
7922 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7923 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7924 .endd
7925 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7926 .code
7927 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7928 .endd
7929
7930
7931 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7932 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7933 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7934 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7935 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7936 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7937 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7938 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7939 message. For example:
7940 .code
7941 domainlist special_domains = \
7942 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7943 .endd
7944 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7945 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7946 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7947 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7948 same list each time.
7949
7950 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7951 cache the result anyway. For example:
7952 .code
7953 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7954 .endd
7955 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7956 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7957
7958
7959
7960 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7961 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7962 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7963 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7964 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7965
7966 .ilist
7967 .cindex "primary host name"
7968 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7969 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7970 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7971 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7972 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7973 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7974 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7975 differ only in their names.
7976 .next
7977 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7978 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7979 .cindex "domain literal"
7980 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7981 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7982 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7983 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7984 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7985 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7986 .next
7987 .cindex "@mx_any"
7988 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7989 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7990 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7991 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7992 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7993 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7994 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7995 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7996 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7997 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7998 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7999
8000 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8001 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8002 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8003 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8004 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8005
8006 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8007 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8008 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8009 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8010 on a router). For example:
8011 .code
8012 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8013 .endd
8014 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8015 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8016
8017 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8018 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8019 contain negative items.
8020
8021 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8022 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8023 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8024 .code
8025 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8026 an.other.domain : ...
8027 .endd
8028 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8029 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8030 .code
8031 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8032 an.other.domain ? ...
8033 .endd
8034 .next
8035 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8036 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8037 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8038 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8039 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8040 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8041 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8042 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8043 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8044 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8045
8046 .next
8047 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8048 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8049 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8050 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8051 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8052 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8053 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8054 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8055 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8056
8057 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8058 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8059 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8060 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8061 expression by expansion, of course).
8062 .next
8063 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8064 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8065 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8066 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8067 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8068 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8069 .code
8070 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8071 .endd
8072 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8073 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8074 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8075 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8076 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8077 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8078 other statements in the same ACL.
8079
8080 .next
8081 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8082 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8083 .code
8084 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8085 .endd
8086 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8087 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8088
8089 .next
8090 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8091 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8092 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8093 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8094 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8095 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8096 expansion variable.
8097 .next
8098 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8099 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8100 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8101 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8102 .code
8103 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8104 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8105 .endd
8106 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8107 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8108 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8109 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8110 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8111 .next
8112 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8113 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8114 between the pattern and the domain.
8115 .endlist
8116
8117 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8118 .code
8119 domainlist funny_domains = \
8120 @ : \
8121 lib.unseen.edu : \
8122 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8123 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8124 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8125 nis;domains.byname : \
8126 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8127 .endd
8128 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8129 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8130 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8131 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8132 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8133 patterns earlier.
8134
8135
8136
8137 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8138 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8139 .cindex "list" "host list"
8140 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8141 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8142 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8143 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8144 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8145 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8146 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8147
8148
8149 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8150 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8151 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8152 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8153 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8154 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8155 not used.
8156
8157 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8158 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8159 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8160
8161
8162
8163 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8164 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8165 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8166 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8167 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8168 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8169 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8170 concerns.)
8171
8172 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8173 inspecting its IP address:
8174
8175 .ilist
8176 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8177 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8178 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8179 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8180 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8181 with the IP address of the subject host.
8182
8183 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8184 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8185 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8186 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8187 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8188
8189 .next
8190 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8191 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8192 domain name, as just described.
8193
8194 .next
8195 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8196 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8197 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8198 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8199 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8200 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8201 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8202 that can never match a client host.
8203
8204 .next
8205 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8206 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8207 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8208 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8209 .code
8210 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8211 accept hosts = @[]
8212 .endd
8213 .next
8214 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8215 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8216 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8217 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8218 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8219 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8220 significant end of the address.
8221
8222 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8223 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8224 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8225 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8226 .code
8227 192.168.23.236/31
8228 .endd
8229 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8230 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8231 matches.
8232
8233 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8234 .code
8235 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8236 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8237 .endd
8238 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8239 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8240 For example:
8241 .code
8242 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8243 .endd
8244 could make use of a file containing
8245 .code
8246 172.16.0.0/12
8247 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8248 .endd
8249 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8250 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8251 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8252 .code
8253 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8254 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8255 .endd
8256 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8257 list.
8258 .endlist
8259
8260
8261
8262 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8263 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8264 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8265 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8266 address, the pattern takes this form:
8267 .display
8268 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8269 .endd
8270 For example:
8271 .code
8272 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8273 .endd
8274 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8275 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8276 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8277 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8278 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8279 returned by the lookup is not used.
8280
8281 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8282 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8283 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8284 patterns of this form:
8285 .display
8286 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8287 .endd
8288 For example:
8289 .code
8290 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8291 .endd
8292 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8293 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8294 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8295 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8296 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8297
8298 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8299 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8300 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8301 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8302 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8303 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8304 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8305 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8306 addresses are always used.
8307
8308 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8309 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8310 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8311 configurations.
8312
8313 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8314 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8315 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8316 case the IP address is used on its own.
8317
8318
8319
8320 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8321 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8322 .cindex "unknown host name"
8323 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8324 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8325 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8326 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8327 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8328 above.)
8329
8330 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8331 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8332 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8333 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8334 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8335 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8336 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8337
8338 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8339 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8340
8341 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8342 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8343 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8344 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8345 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8346 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8347 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8348 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8349 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8350
8351 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8352 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8353
8354 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8355 .cindex "alias for host"
8356 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8357 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8358
8359 .ilist
8360 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8361 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8362 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8363 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8364 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8365 expression.
8366 .next
8367 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8368 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8369 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8370 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8371 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8372 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8373 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8374 example,
8375 .code
8376 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8377 .endd
8378 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8379 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8380 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8381 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8382 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8383 .code
8384 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8385 .endd
8386 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8387 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8388 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8389 required.
8390 .endlist
8391
8392
8393
8394
8395 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8396 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8397 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8398 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8399 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8400 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8401
8402 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8403 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8404
8405 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8406 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8407 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8408 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8409 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8410 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8411 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8412 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8413 not recognized in an indirected file).
8414
8415 .ilist
8416 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8417 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8418 .code
8419 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8420 .endd
8421 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8422 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8423
8424 .next
8425 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8426 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8427 example:
8428 .code
8429 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8430 192.168.4.5
8431 .endd
8432 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8433 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8434 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8435 .endlist
8436
8437 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8438 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8439 list.
8440
8441 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8442 "SECTmixwilhos"
8443 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8444
8445 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8446 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8447 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8448
8449 .ilist
8450 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8451 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8452 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8453 .code
8454 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8455 .endd
8456 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8457 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8458 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8459 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8460 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8461 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8462 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8463
8464 .next
8465 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8466 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8467 .code
8468 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8469 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8470 .endd
8471 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8472 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8473 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8474 this section.
8475 .endlist
8476
8477
8478 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8479 "SECTtemdnserr"
8480 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8481 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8482 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8483 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8484 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8485 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8486 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8487 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8488 host lists such as whitelists.
8489
8490
8491
8492 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8493 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8494 .cindex "unknown host name"
8495 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8496 If a pattern is of the form
8497 .display
8498 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8499 .endd
8500 for example
8501 .code
8502 dbm;/host/accept/list
8503 .endd
8504 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8505 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8506 is not used.
8507
8508 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8509 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8510 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8511 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8512 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8513 lookup, both using the same file.
8514
8515
8516
8517 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8518 If a pattern is of the form
8519 .display
8520 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8521 .endd
8522 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8523 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8524 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8525 .code
8526 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8527 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8528 .endd
8529 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8530 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8531 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8532 operator.
8533
8534 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8535 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8536 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8537
8538 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8539 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8540 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8541 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8542 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8543 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8544
8545
8546
8547
8548
8549 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8550 .cindex "list" "address list"
8551 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8552 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8553 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8554 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8555 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8556 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8557 using this option setting:
8558 .code
8559 senders = :
8560 .endd
8561 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8562 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8563 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8564 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8565
8566 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8567 example:
8568 .code
8569 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8570 .endd
8571 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8572 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8573 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8574 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8575 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8576 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8577 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8578 .code
8579 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8580 *@+hostile_domains:\
8581 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8582 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8583 .endd
8584 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8585 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8586 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8587 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8588 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8589
8590 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8591 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8592 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8593 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8594 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8595 .code
8596 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8597 .endd
8598
8599 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8600 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8601 senders:
8602
8603 .ilist
8604 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8605 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8606 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8607 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8608 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8609 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8610 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8611 .code
8612 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8613 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8614 .endd
8615 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8616 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8617
8618 .next
8619 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8620 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8621 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8622 example:
8623 .code
8624 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8625 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8626 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8627 .endd
8628 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8629 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8630 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8631 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8632
8633 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8634 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8635 panic log.
8636 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8637 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8638 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8639 default. For example, with this lookup:
8640 .code
8641 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8642 .endd
8643 the file could contains lines like this:
8644 .code
8645 user1@domain1.example
8646 *@domain2.example
8647 .endd
8648 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8649 that are tried is:
8650 .code
8651 nimrod@jaeger.example
8652 *@jaeger.example
8653 *
8654 .endd
8655 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8656 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8657
8658 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8659 .code
8660 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8661 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8662 .endd
8663 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8664 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8665 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8666 .endlist
8667
8668
8669 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8670 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8671 always fails.
8672
8673
8674 .ilist
8675 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8676 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8677 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8678 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8679 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8680 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8681 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8682 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8683 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8684
8685 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8686 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8687 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8688 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8689 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8690 with
8691 .code
8692 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8693 .endd
8694 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8695 .code
8696 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8697 .endd
8698 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8699
8700 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8701 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8702 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8703 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8704 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8705 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8706 .code
8707 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8708 spammer3 : spammer4
8709 .endd
8710 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8711 doubling.
8712
8713 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8714 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8715 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8716 might have entries like
8717 .code
8718 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8719 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8720 *: ^\d{8}$
8721 .endd
8722 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8723 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8724 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8725 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8726
8727 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8728 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8729 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8730
8731 .next
8732 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8733 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8734 can only return a single list of local parts.
8735 .endlist
8736
8737 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8738 in these two examples:
8739 .code
8740 senders = +my_list
8741 senders = *@+my_list
8742 .endd
8743 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8744 example it is a named domain list.
8745
8746
8747
8748
8749 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8750 .cindex "case of local parts"
8751 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8752 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8753 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8754 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8755 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8756 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8757 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8758 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8759 default.
8760
8761 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8762 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8763 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8764 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8765 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8766 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8767 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8768 case-independent.
8769
8770 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8771 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8772 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8773 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8774 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8775 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8776 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8777 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8778
8779
8780
8781 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8782 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8783 .cindex "local part" "list"
8784 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8785 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8786 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8787 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8788 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8789 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8790 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8791 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8792
8793 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8794 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8795 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8796 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8797 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8798 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8799 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8800 types.
8801 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8802
8803
8804
8805
8806 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8808
8809 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8810 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8811 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8812 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8813
8814 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8815 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8816 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8817 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8818 escape character, as described in the following section.
8819
8820 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8821 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8822 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8823 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8824 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8825 reasons.
8826
8827
8828
8829 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8830 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8831 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8832 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8833 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8834 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8835 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8836 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8837
8838 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8839 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8840 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8841 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8842 .code
8843 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8844 .endd
8845 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8846 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8847 string.
8848
8849
8850
8851 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8852 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8853 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8854 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8855 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8856 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8857 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8858 encoding.
8859
8860 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8861 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8862 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8863
8864
8865 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8866 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8867 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8868 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8869 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8870 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8871 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8872 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8873 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8874 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8875 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8876 and &%nhash%&.
8877
8878 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8879 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8880 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8881
8882 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8883 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8884 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8885 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8886 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8887 .code
8888 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8889 .endd
8890 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8891 Exim message identifier. For example:
8892 .code
8893 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8894 .endd
8895 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8896 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8897
8898
8899 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8900 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8901 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8902 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8903 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8904 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8905 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8906 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8907 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8908 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8909 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8910 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8911 being expanded.
8912
8913
8914
8915
8916 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8917 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8918 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8919 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8920 white space is significant.
8921
8922 .vlist
8923 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8924 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8925 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8926 .code
8927 $local_part
8928 ${domain}
8929 .endd
8930 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8931 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8932 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8933 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8934 given, the expansion fails.
8935
8936 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8937 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8938 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8939 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8940 .code
8941 ${lc:$local_part}
8942 .endd
8943 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8944 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8945 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8946 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8947 string easier to understand.
8948
8949 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8950 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8951 expansion item below.
8952
8953
8954 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8955 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8956 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8957 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8958 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8959 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8960 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8961 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8962 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8963 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8964 the result of the expansion.
8965 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8966 the expansion result is an empty string.
8967 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8968
8969
8970 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8971 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8972 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8973 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8974 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8975 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8976 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
8977 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8978 .display
8979 &`version `&
8980 &`serial_number `&
8981 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8982 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8983 &`notbefore `& time
8984 &`notafter `& time
8985 &`sig_algorithm `&
8986 &`signature `&
8987 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8988 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8989 &`crl_uri `& list
8990 .endd
8991 If the field is found,
8992 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8993 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8994 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8995 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8996
8997 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8998 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8999 extracted is used.
9000
9001 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9002
9003 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9004 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9005 not quite
9006 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9007 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9008 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9009 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9010 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9011 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9012 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9013 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9014
9015 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9016 take an optional modifier of "int"
9017 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9018 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9019 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9020
9021 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9022 newline-separated by default,
9023 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9024 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9025 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9026
9027 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9028 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9029 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9030 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9031 if so the element tags are omitted.
9032
9033 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9034
9035 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9036 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9037 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9038 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9039 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9040 .code
9041 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9042 .endd
9043 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9044 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9045 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9046
9047 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9048 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9049 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9050 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9051 must have the following type:
9052 .code
9053 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9054 .endd
9055 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9056 function should return one of the following values:
9057
9058 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9059 into the expanded string that is being built.
9060
9061 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9062 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9063
9064 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9065 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9066
9067 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9068
9069 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9070 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9071 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9072
9073
9074 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9075 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9076 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9077 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9078 removed.
9079 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9080 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9081 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9082
9083 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9084 appear, for example:
9085 .code
9086 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9087 .endd
9088 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9089 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9090
9091 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9092 search failure.
9093 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9094 search success.
9095
9096
9097 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9098 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9099 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9100 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9101 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9102 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9103 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9104 form:
9105 .display
9106 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9107 .endd
9108 .vindex "&$value$&"
9109 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9110 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9111 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9112 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9113 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9114 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9115 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9116 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9117 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9118
9119 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9120 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9121 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9122 yield &"2001"&:
9123 .code
9124 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9125 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9126 .endd
9127 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9128 appear, for example:
9129 .code
9130 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9131 .endd
9132 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9133 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9134
9135
9136 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9137 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9138 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9139 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9140 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9141 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9142 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9143 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9144 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9145 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9146 <&'string3'&> as before.
9147
9148 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9149 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9150 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9151 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9152 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9153 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9154 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9155 provided. For example:
9156 .code
9157 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9158 .endd
9159 yields &"42"&, and
9160 .code
9161 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9162 .endd
9163 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9164 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9165
9166
9167 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9168 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9169 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9170 .vindex "&$item$&"
9171 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9172 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9173 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9174 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9175 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9176 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9177 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9178 .code
9179 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9180 .endd
9181 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9182 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9183
9184
9185 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9186 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9187 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9188 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9189 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9190 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9191
9192 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9193 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9194 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9195 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9196 .code
9197 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9198 .endd
9199 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9200 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9201 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9202 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9203 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9204 .code
9205 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9206 .endd
9207 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9208 letters appear. For example:
9209 .display
9210 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9211 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9212 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9213 .endd
9214
9215 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9216 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9217 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9218 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9219 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9220 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9221 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9222 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9223 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9224 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9225 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9226 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9227 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9228 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9229 .code
9230 $header_reply-to:
9231 .endd
9232 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9233 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9234 lines) may be present.
9235
9236 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9237 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9238
9239 .ilist
9240 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9241 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9242 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9243
9244 .next
9245 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9246 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9247 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9248 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9249 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9250 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9251 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9252 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9253
9254 .next
9255 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9256 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9257 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9258 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9259 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9260 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9261 .endlist ilist
9262
9263 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9264 command of the following form:
9265 .code
9266 headers charset "UTF-8"
9267 .endd
9268 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9269 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9270 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9271 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9272 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9273 ISO-8859-1.
9274
9275 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9276 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9277 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9278 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9279
9280 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9281 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9282 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9283 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9284 router or transport are not accessible.
9285
9286 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9287 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9288 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9289 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9290 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9291 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9292
9293 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9294 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9295 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9296 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9297 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9298 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9299 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9300 header.)
9301
9302 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9303 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9304 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9305 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9306 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9307 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9308 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9309 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9310
9311
9312 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9313 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9314 .cindex &%hmac%&
9315 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9316 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9317 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9318 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9319 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9320 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9321 present. For example:
9322 .code
9323 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9324 .endd
9325 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9326 produces:
9327 .code
9328 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9329 .endd
9330 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9331 an Exim configuration:
9332 .code
9333 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9334 .endd
9335 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9336 .code
9337 headers_add = \
9338 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9339 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9340 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9341 .endd
9342 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9343 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9344 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9345 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9346 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9347 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9348
9349
9350 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9351 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9352 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9353 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9354 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9355 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9356 .code
9357 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9358 .endd
9359 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9360 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9361 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9362 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9363 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9364
9365 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9366 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9367 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9368 .code
9369 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9370 .endd
9371 you can use
9372 .code
9373 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9374 .endd
9375
9376 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9377 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9378 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9379 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9380 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9381 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9382 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9383 some of the braces:
9384 .code
9385 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9386 .endd
9387 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9388 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9389 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9390
9391
9392 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9393 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9394 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9395 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9396 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9397 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9398 apart from an optional leading minus,
9399 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9400
9401 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9402 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9403
9404 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9405 If the number is negative, the fields are
9406 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9407 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9408 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9409
9410 If the modulus of the
9411 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9412 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9413
9414 For example:
9415 .code
9416 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9417 .endd
9418 yields &"42"&, and
9419 .code
9420 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9421 .endd
9422 yields &"result: 42"&.
9423
9424 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9425 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9426 extracted is used.
9427 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9428
9429
9430 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9431 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9432 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9433 described in the next item.
9434
9435 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9436 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9437 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9438 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9439 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9440 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9441 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9442 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9443 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9444
9445 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9446 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9447 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9448 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9449 out by the system administrator.
9450
9451 .vindex "&$value$&"
9452 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9453 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9454 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9455 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9456 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9457 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9458 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9459 original lookup fails.
9460
9461 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9462 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9463 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9464 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9465 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9466 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9467 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9468 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9469
9470 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9471 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9472 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9473 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9474
9475 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9476 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9477 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9478 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9479
9480 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9481 .code
9482 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9483 .endd
9484 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9485 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9486 .code
9487 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9488 {$value}fail}
9489 .endd
9490
9491
9492 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9493 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9494 .vindex "&$item$&"
9495 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9496 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9497 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9498 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9499 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9500 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9501 .code
9502 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9503 .endd
9504 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9505 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9506 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9507
9508 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9509 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9510 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9511 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9512 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9513 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9514 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9515 .code
9516 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9517 .endd
9518 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9519 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9520 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9521 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9522 example,
9523 .code
9524 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9525 .endd
9526 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9527
9528
9529
9530 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9531 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9532 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9533 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9534 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9535 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9536 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9537 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9538
9539 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9540 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9541 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9542 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9543 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9544 not its contents.
9545
9546 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9547 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9548 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9549
9550 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9551 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9552
9553
9554 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9555 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9556 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9557 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9558 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9559 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9560 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9561 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9562
9563 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9564 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9565 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9566 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9567 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9568 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9569 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9570 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9571 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9572 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9573
9574 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9575 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9576 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9577 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9578
9579 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9580 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9581 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9582 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9583 is the expansion of the third argument.
9584
9585 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9586 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9587 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9588
9589 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9590 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9591 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9592 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9593 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9594 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9595 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9596 newlines are left in the string.
9597 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9598 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9599 the string expansion fails.
9600
9601 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9602 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9603
9604
9605
9606 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9607 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9608 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9609 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9610 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9611 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9612 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9613 examples:
9614 .code
9615 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9616 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9617 .endd
9618 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9619 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9620 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9621 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9622 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9623 example:
9624 .code
9625 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9626 .endd
9627 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9628 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9629 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9630 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9631 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9632 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9633 .code
9634 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9635 .endd
9636 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9637 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9638 turns them into spaces:
9639 .code
9640 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9641 .endd
9642 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9643 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9644 addition, the following errors can occur:
9645
9646 .ilist
9647 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9648 .next
9649 Failure to connect the socket;
9650 .next
9651 Failure to write the request string;
9652 .next
9653 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9654 .endlist
9655
9656 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9657 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9658 errors occurs. For example:
9659 .code
9660 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9661 {socket failure}}
9662 .endd
9663 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9664 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9665 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9666 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9667 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9668
9669 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9670 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9671
9672
9673 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9674 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9675 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9676 .vindex "&$value$&"
9677 .vindex "&$item$&"
9678 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9679 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9680 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9681 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9682 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9683 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9684 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9685 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9686 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9687 .code
9688 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9689 .endd
9690 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9691 can be found:
9692 .code
9693 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9694 .endd
9695 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9696 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9697 expansion items.
9698
9699 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9700 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9701 expansion item above.
9702
9703 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9704 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9705 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9706 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9707 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9708 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9709 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9710 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9711 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9712
9713 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9714 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9715 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9716 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9717 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9718 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9719 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9720 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9721 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9722 character.
9723
9724 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9725 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9726 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9727 .vindex "&$value$&"
9728 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9729 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9730 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9731 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9732 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9733 &$value$&.
9734
9735 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9736 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9737 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9738 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9739
9740 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9741 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9742 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9743 troubleshoot:
9744 .code
9745 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9746 log_message = Output of id: $value
9747 .endd
9748 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9749 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9750 .code
9751 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9752 .endd
9753
9754 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9755 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9756 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9757 .code
9758 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9759 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9760 ...
9761 endif
9762 .endd
9763 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9764 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9765 commands.
9766
9767 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9768 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9769 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9770 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9771
9772 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9773 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9774
9775
9776 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9777 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9778 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9779 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9780 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9781 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9782 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9783 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9784 .code
9785 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9786 .endd
9787 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9788 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9789 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9790 .code
9791 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9792 .endd
9793 yields &"defabc"&, and
9794 .code
9795 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9796 .endd
9797 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9798 the regular expression from string expansion.
9799
9800
9801
9802 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9803 .cindex sorting "a list"
9804 .cindex list sorting
9805 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9806 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9807 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9808 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9809 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9810 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9811 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9812 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9813 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9814 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9815 to give values for comparison.
9816
9817 The item result is a sorted list,
9818 with the original list separator,
9819 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9820
9821 Examples:
9822 .code
9823 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9824 .endd
9825 sorts a list of numbers, and
9826 .code
9827 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9828 .endd
9829 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9830
9831
9832 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9833 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9834 .cindex "substring extraction"
9835 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9836 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9837 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9838 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9839 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9840 .code
9841 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9842 .endd
9843 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9844 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9845 omitted.
9846
9847 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9848 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9849 length required. For example
9850 .code
9851 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9852 .endd
9853 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9854 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9855 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9856 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9857
9858 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9859 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9860 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9861 .code
9862 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9863 .endd
9864 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9865 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9866 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9867 .code
9868 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9869 .endd
9870 yields an empty string, but
9871 .code
9872 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9873 .endd
9874 yields &"1"&.
9875
9876 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9877 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9878 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9879 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9880 .code
9881 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9882 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9883 .endd
9884 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9885
9886
9887
9888 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9889 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9890 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9891 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9892 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9893 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9894 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9895 replacement list. For example
9896 .code
9897 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9898 .endd
9899 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9900 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9901 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9902 place.
9903 .endlist
9904
9905
9906
9907 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9908 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9909 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9910 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9911 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9912 following operations can be performed:
9913
9914 .vlist
9915 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9916 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9917 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9918 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9919 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9920 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9921
9922
9923 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9924 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9925 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9926 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9927 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9928 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9929 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9930 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9931 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9932
9933 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9934 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9935 character. For example:
9936 .code
9937 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9938 .endd
9939 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9940 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9941 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9942 processing lists.
9943
9944 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9945 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9946 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9947 email address separator. For the example header line:
9948 .code
9949 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9950 .endd
9951 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9952 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9953 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9954 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9955 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9956 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9957 quoted.
9958 .code
9959 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9960 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9961 user@example.com
9962 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9963 Last:user@example.com
9964 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9965 user@example.com
9966 .endd
9967
9968 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9969 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9970 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9971 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9972 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9973 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9974 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9975 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9976 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9977
9978 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9979 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9980 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9981 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9982 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9983 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9984 string.
9985
9986
9987 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9988 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9989 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9990 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9991 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9992
9993
9994 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9995 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9996 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9997 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9998 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9999 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10000 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10001
10002
10003 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10004 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10005 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10006 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10007 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10008 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10009 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10010 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10011 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10012 C programming language):
10013 .table2 70pt 300pt
10014 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10015 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10016 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10017 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10018 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10019 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10020 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10021 .endtable
10022 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10023 space is permitted before or after operators.
10024
10025 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10026 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10027 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10028 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10029 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10030
10031 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10032 or 1024*1024*1024,
10033 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10034 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10035
10036 .display
10037 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10038 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10039 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10040 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10041 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10042 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10043 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10044 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10045 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10046 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10047 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10048 .endd
10049
10050 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10051 .code
10052 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10053 condition = \
10054 ${if and { \
10055 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10056 { \
10057 < \
10058 {$recipients_count} \
10059 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10060 } \
10061 }{yes}{no}}
10062 .endd
10063 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10064 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10065
10066
10067 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10068 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10069 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10070 example,
10071 .code
10072 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10073 .endd
10074 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10075 and then re-expands what it has found.
10076
10077
10078 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10079 .cindex "Unicode"
10080 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10081 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10082 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10083 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10084 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10085 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10086 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10087 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10088 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10089
10090 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10091 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10092 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10093 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10094 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10095 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10096 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10097
10098
10099 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10100 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10101 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10102 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10103 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10104 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10105 .code
10106 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10107 .endd
10108 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10109 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10110
10111
10112
10113 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10114 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10115 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10116 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10117 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10118 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10119
10120
10121
10122 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10123 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10124 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10125 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10126 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10127 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10128 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10129
10130
10131 .new
10132 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10133 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10134 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10135 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10136 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10137 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10138 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10139
10140 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10141 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10142 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10143 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10144 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10145 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10146 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10147 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10148 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10149 .wen
10150
10151
10152 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10153 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10154 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10155 .cindex "lower casing"
10156 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10157 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10158 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10159 .code
10160 ${lc:$local_part}
10161 .endd
10162
10163 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10164 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10165 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10166 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10167 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10168 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10169 .code
10170 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10171 .endd
10172 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10173 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10174 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10175
10176
10177 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10178 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10179 .cindex "list" "item count"
10180 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10181 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10182 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10183
10184
10185 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10186 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10187 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10188 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10189 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10190 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10191 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10192 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10193 matching list is returned.
10194
10195
10196 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10197 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10198 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10199 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10200 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10201 empty.
10202
10203
10204 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10205 .cindex "masked IP address"
10206 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10207 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10208 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10209 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10210 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10211 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10212 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10213 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10214 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10215 .code
10216 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10217 .endd
10218 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10219 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10220 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10221 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10222 .code
10223 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10224 .endd
10225 returns the string
10226 .code
10227 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10228 .endd
10229 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10230
10231
10232 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10233 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10234 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10235 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10236 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10237 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10238 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10239
10240
10241 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10242 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10243 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10244 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10245 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10246 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10247 .code
10248 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10249 .endd
10250 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10251
10252
10253 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10254 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10255 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10256 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10257 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10258 is an empty string or
10259 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10260 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10261 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10262 respectively For example,
10263 .code
10264 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10265 .endd
10266 becomes
10267 .code
10268 "ab\"*\"cd"
10269 .endd
10270 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10271 variable or a message header.
10272
10273 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10274 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10275 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10276 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10277 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10278 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10279 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10280
10281
10282 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10283 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10284 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10285 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10286 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10287 .code
10288 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10289 .endd
10290 returns
10291 .code
10292 two%20%5C2A%20two
10293 .endd
10294 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10295 yields an unchanged string.
10296
10297
10298 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10299 .cindex "random number"
10300 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10301 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10302 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10303 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10304 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10305 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10306 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10307 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10308 random().
10309
10310
10311 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10312 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10313 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10314 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10315 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10316 for DNS. For example,
10317 .code
10318 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10319 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10320 .endd
10321 returns
10322 .code
10323 4.2.0.192
10324 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10325 .endd
10326
10327
10328 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10329 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10330 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10331 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10332 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10333 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10334 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10335 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10336 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10337 characters
10338 .code
10339 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10340 .endd
10341 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10342 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10343 characters.
10344
10345
10346 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10347 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10348 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10349 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10350 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10351 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10352 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10353 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10354
10355 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10356 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10357 to use this operator as well.
10358
10359
10360
10361 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10362 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10363 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10364 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10365 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10366 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10367 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10368
10369
10370 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10371 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10372 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10373 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10374 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10375 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10376 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10377
10378
10379 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10380 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10381 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10382 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10383 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10384 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10385 certificate,
10386 and returns
10387 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10388 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10389
10390
10391 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10392 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10393 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10394 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10395 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10396 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10397 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10398 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10399 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10400 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10401 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10402 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10403 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10404
10405 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10406 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10407 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10408
10409 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10410 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10411 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10412 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10413 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10414
10415
10416
10417 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10418 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10419 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10420 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10421 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10422 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10423
10424
10425 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10426 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10427 .cindex "substring extraction"
10428 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10429 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10430 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10431 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10432 .code
10433 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10434 .endd
10435 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10436 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10437
10438 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10439 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10440 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10441 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10442 seconds.
10443
10444 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10445 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10446 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10447 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10448 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10449 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10450 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10451
10452 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10453 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10454 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10455 .cindex "upper casing"
10456 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10457 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10458 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10459
10460 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10461 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10462 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10463 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10464 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10465 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10466 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10467 .endlist
10468
10469
10470
10471
10472
10473
10474 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10475 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10476 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10477 while expanding strings:
10478
10479 .vlist
10480 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10481 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10482 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10483 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10484 condition.
10485
10486 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10487 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10488 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10489 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10490 are:
10491 .display
10492 &`= `& equal
10493 &`== `& equal
10494 &`> `& greater
10495 &`>= `& greater or equal
10496 &`< `& less
10497 &`<= `& less or equal
10498 .endd
10499 For example:
10500 .code
10501 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10502 .endd
10503 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10504 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10505 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10506 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10507 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10508 zero.
10509
10510 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10511 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10512 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10513
10514
10515 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10516 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10517 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10518 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10519 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10520 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10521 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10522 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10523 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10524 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10525 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10526 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10527 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10528 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10529
10530 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10531 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10532 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10533 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10534 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10535 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10536 false if zero.
10537 An empty string is treated as false.
10538 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10539 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10540 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10541
10542 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10543 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10544 For example:
10545 .code
10546 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10547 .endd
10548
10549
10550 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10551 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10552 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10553 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10554 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10555 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10556 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10557 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10558
10559 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10560
10561 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10562 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10563 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10564 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10565 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10566 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10567 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10568 included in the binary.
10569
10570 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10571 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10572 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10573 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10574 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10575 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10576 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10577 string in LDAP form is:
10578 .code
10579 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10580 .endd
10581 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10582 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10583 .code
10584 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10585 .endd
10586 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10587 supported:
10588
10589 .ilist
10590 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10591 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10592 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10593 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10594 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10595 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10596 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10597 comparison fails.
10598
10599 .next
10600 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10601 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10602 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10603 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10604 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10605 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10606
10607 .next
10608 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10609 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10610 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10611 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10612 whatever its length.
10613
10614 .next
10615 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10616 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10617 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10618 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10619 .endlist
10620 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10621 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10622 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10623 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10624 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10625 support &[crypt16()]&.
10626
10627 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10628 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10629 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10630 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10631 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10632
10633 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10634 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10635 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10636
10637 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10638 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10639 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10640 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10641 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10642
10643 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10644 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10645 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10646 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10647 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10648 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10649 .code
10650 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10651 .endd
10652 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10653 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10654
10655 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10656 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10657 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10658 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10659 exists in the message. For example,
10660 .code
10661 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10662 .endd
10663 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10664 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10665
10666 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10667 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10668 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10669 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10670 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10671 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10672 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10673 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10674 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10675
10676 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10677 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10678 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10679 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10680 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10681 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10682 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10683 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10684
10685 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10686 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10687 .cindex "first delivery"
10688 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10689 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10690 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10691 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10692
10693
10694 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10695 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10696 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10697 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10698 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10699 .vindex "&$item$&"
10700 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10701 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10702 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10703 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10704 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10705 .ilist
10706 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10707 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10708 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10709 .next
10710 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10711 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10712 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10713 .endlist
10714 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10715 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10716 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10717 list separator is changed to a comma:
10718 .code
10719 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10720 .endd
10721 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10722 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10723
10724 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10725
10726
10727 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10728 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10729 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10730 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10731 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10732 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10733 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10734 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10735 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10736 case-independent.
10737
10738 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10739 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10740 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10741 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10742 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10743 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10744 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10745 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10746 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10747 case-independent.
10748
10749 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10750 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10751 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10752 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10753 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10754 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10755 is true.
10756
10757 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10758 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10759 .code
10760 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10761 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10762 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10763 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10764 .endd
10765
10766 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10767 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10768 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10769 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10770 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10771 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10772 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10773 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10774 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10775 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10776 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10777
10778 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10779 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10780 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10781 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10782 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10783
10784 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10785 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10786 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10787 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10788 .code
10789 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10790 .endd
10791 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10792
10793 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10794 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10795 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10796 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10797 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10798 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10799 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10800 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10801 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10802 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10803 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10804 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10805 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10806 this can be used.
10807
10808
10809 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10810 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10811 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10812 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10813 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10814 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10815 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10816 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10817 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10818 case-independent.
10819
10820 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10821 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10822 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10823 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10824 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10825 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10826 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10827 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10828 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10829 case-independent.
10830
10831
10832 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10833 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10834 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10835 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10836 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10837 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10838 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10839 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10840 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10841 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10842 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10843 For example,
10844 .code
10845 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10846 .endd
10847 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10848 backslashes is also required.
10849
10850 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10851 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10852 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10853 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10854 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10855 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10856
10857 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10858 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10859 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10860 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10861 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10862 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10863 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10864 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10865
10866 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10867 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10868 See &*match_local_part*&.
10869
10870 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10871 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10872 See &*match_local_part*&.
10873
10874 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10875 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10876 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10877 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10878 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10879 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10880 .code
10881 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10882 .endd
10883 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10884
10885 .ilist
10886 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10887 .next
10888 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10889 .next
10890 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10891 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10892 in a single test such as
10893 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10894 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10895 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10896 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10897 .code
10898 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10899 .endd
10900 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10901 .next
10902 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10903 .next
10904 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10905 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10906 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10907 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10908 masks. For example:
10909 .code
10910 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10911 .endd
10912 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10913 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10914 address mask, for example:
10915 .code
10916 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10917 .endd
10918 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10919 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10920 .code
10921 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10922 .endd
10923 .endlist ilist
10924
10925 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10926 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10927
10928 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10929
10930 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10931 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10932 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10933 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10934 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10935 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10936 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10937 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10938 example is:
10939 .code
10940 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10941 .endd
10942 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10943 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10944 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10945 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10946 .code
10947 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10948 .endd
10949 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10950 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10951 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10952 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10953 caselessly.
10954
10955 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10956 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10957
10958 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10959 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10960 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10961 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10962
10963 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10964 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10965 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10966 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10967 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10968 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10969 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10970 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10971 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10972 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10973 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10974 .code
10975 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10976 .endd
10977 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10978 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10979
10980 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10981 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10982 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10983 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10984 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10985 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10986 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10987
10988 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10989 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10990 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10991 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10992 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10993 .code
10994 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10995 .endd
10996 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10997 .code
10998 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10999 .endd
11000 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11001 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11002 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11003 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11004 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11005 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11006 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11007 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11008
11009
11010 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11011 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11012 .cindex "Cyrus"
11013 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11014 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11015 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11016 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11017 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11018 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11019
11020 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11021 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11022 building Exim. For example:
11023 .code
11024 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11025 .endd
11026 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11027 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11028 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11029 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11030
11031 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11032 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11033 configuration, you might have this:
11034 .code
11035 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11036 .endd
11037 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11038 .code
11039 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11040 .endd
11041 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11042 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11043 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11044 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11045 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11046 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11047
11048
11049 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11050 .cindex "Radius"
11051 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11052 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11053 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11054 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11055 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11056 support.
11057
11058 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11059 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11060 this library, you need to set
11061 .code
11062 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11063 .endd
11064 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11065 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11066 .code
11067 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11068 .endd
11069 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11070 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11071 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11072
11073 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11074 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11075 the authentication is successful. For example:
11076 .code
11077 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11078 .endd
11079
11080
11081 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11082 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11083 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11084 .cindex "Cyrus"
11085 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11086 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11087 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11088 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11089 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11090 by a process that is not running as root.
11091
11092 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11093 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11094 building Exim. For example:
11095 .code
11096 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11097 .endd
11098 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11099 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11100 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11101
11102 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11103 two are mandatory. For example:
11104 .code
11105 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11106 .endd
11107 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11108 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11109 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11110 .endlist vlist
11111
11112
11113
11114 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11115 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11116 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11117 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11118 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11119 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11120 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11121
11122
11123 .vlist
11124 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11125 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11126 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11127 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11128 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11129 For example,
11130 .code
11131 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11132 .endd
11133 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11134 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11135 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11136
11137 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11138 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11139 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11140 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11141 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11142 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11143 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11144 parsed but not evaluated.
11145 .endlist
11146 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11147
11148
11149
11150
11151 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11152 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11153 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11154 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11155 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11156
11157 .vlist
11158 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11159 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11160 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11161 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11162 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11163 In the expansion condition case
11164 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11165 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11166 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11167 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11168 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11169 matching condition.
11170
11171 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11172 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11173 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11174 any unused variables being made empty.
11175
11176 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11177 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11178 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11179 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11180 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11181 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11182 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11183 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11184 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11185 during subsequent delivery.
11186
11187 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11188 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11189 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11190 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11191 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11192 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11193 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11194 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11195 delivery.
11196
11197 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11198 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11199 this variable has the number of arguments.
11200
11201 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11202 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11203 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11204 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11205 be preserved by coding like this:
11206 .code
11207 warn !verify = sender
11208 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11209 .endd
11210 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11211 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11212 failure.
11213
11214 .vitem &$address_data$&
11215 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11216 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11217 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11218 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11219 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11220 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11221 user filter files.
11222
11223 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11224 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11225 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11226 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11227 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11228 from the child's routing.
11229
11230 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11231 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11232 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11233 address.
11234
11235 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11236 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11237 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11238
11239 .vitem &$address_file$&
11240 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11241 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11242 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11243 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11244 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11245 .code
11246 /home/r2d2/savemail
11247 .endd
11248 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11249 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11250 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11251 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11252 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11253 to the relevant file.
11254
11255 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11256 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11257 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11258 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11259
11260 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11261 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11262 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11263 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11264
11265 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11266 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11267 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11268 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11269 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11270 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11271 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11272 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11273 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11274 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11275 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11276 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11277 command line option.
11278
11279 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11280 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11281 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11282 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11283 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11284 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11285 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11286 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11287 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11288 the ACL's as well.
11289
11290
11291 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11292 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11293 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11294 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11295 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11296 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11297 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11298 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11299 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11300 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11301 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11302
11303 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11304 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11305 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11306 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11307 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11308
11309
11310 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11311 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11312 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11313 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11314 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11315 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11316 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11317 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11318 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11319 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11320 an undefined mechanism.
11321
11322 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11323 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11324 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11325 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11326 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11327 the ACL malware condition.
11328
11329 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11330 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11331 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11332 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11333 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11334 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11335
11336 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11337 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11338 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11339 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11340 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11341 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11342 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11343
11344 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11345 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11346 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11347 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11348 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11349
11350 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11351 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11352 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11353 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11354 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11355
11356 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11357 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11358 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11359 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11360 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11361 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11362 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11363
11364 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11365 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11366 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11367 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11368 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11369 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11370 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11371
11372 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11373 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11374 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11375 address that was connected to.
11376
11377 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11378 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11379 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11380 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11381 compilations of the same version of the program.
11382
11383 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11384 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11385 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11386 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11387 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11388 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11389
11390 .vitem &$config_file$&
11391 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11392 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11393
11394 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11395 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11396 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11397 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11398 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11399
11400 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11401 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11402 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11403 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11404 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11405
11406 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11407 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11408 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11409 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11410 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11411 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11412 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11413 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11414 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11415 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11416 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11417 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11418 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11419 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11420 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11421 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11422 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11423 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11424 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11425 &$dkim_key_length$&
11426 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11427 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11428
11429 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11430 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11431 When a message has been received this variable contains
11432 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11433 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11434
11435 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11436 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11437 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11438 &$dnslist_value$&
11439 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11440 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11441 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11442 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11443 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11444 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11445 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11446 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11447 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11448
11449 .vitem &$domain$&
11450 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11451 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11452 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11453 case for &$domain$&.
11454
11455 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11456 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11457 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11458 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11459
11460 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11461 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11462 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11463 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11464 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11465 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11466
11467 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11468 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11469 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11470
11471 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11472
11473 .ilist
11474 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11475 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11476 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11477 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11478 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11479 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11480 the &(smtp)& transport.
11481
11482 .next
11483 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11484 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11485 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11486 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11487
11488 .next
11489 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11490 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11491 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11492 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11493 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11494 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11495
11496 .next
11497 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11498 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11499 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11500 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11501 .endlist
11502
11503
11504 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11505 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11506 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11507 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11508 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11509 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11510 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11511 used.
11512
11513 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11514 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11515 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11516 to nothing.
11517
11518 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11519 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11520 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11521
11522 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11523 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11524 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11525
11526 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11527 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11528 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11529
11530 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11531 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11532 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11533 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11534 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11535 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11536
11537 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11538 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11539 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11540 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11541 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11542
11543 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11544 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11545 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11546 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11547 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11548
11549 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11550 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11551 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11552 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11553 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11554
11555 .vitem &$home$&
11556 .vindex "&$home$&"
11557 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11558 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11559 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11560 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11561 by a setting on the transport itself.
11562
11563 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11564 of the environment variable HOME.
11565
11566 .vitem &$host$&
11567 .vindex "&$host$&"
11568 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11569 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11570 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11571 to local and remote transports.
11572
11573 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11574 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11575 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11576 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11577 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11578 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11579 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11580 is connected.
11581
11582 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11583 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11584 client is connected.
11585
11586
11587 .vitem &$host_address$&
11588 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11589 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11590 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11591 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11592
11593 .vitem &$host_data$&
11594 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11595 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11596 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11597 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11598 .code
11599 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11600 message = $host_data
11601 .endd
11602 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11603 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11604 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11605 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11606 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11607 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11608 variables is set to &"1"&.
11609
11610 .ilist
11611 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11612 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11613
11614 .next
11615 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11616 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11617 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11618 .endlist ilist
11619
11620 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11621 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11622 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11623 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11624 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11625 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11626 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11627 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11628 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11629 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11630
11631 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11632 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11633 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11634
11635 .vitem &$host_port$&
11636 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11637 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11638 for an outbound connection.
11639
11640
11641 .vitem &$inode$&
11642 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11643 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11644 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11645 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11646 a unique name for the file.
11647
11648 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11649 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11650 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11651
11652 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11653 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11654 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11655
11656 .vitem &$item$&
11657 .vindex "&$item$&"
11658 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11659 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11660 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11661 empty.
11662
11663 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11664 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11665 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11666 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11667 lookup.
11668
11669 .vitem &$load_average$&
11670 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11671 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11672 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11673 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11674
11675 .vitem &$local_part$&
11676 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11677 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11678 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11679 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11680 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11681
11682 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11683 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11684 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11685 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11686 once.
11687
11688 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11689 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11690 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11691 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11692 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11693 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11694
11695 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11696 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11697 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11698 &$address_pipe$&).
11699
11700 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11701 local part of the recipient address.
11702
11703 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11704 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11705 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11706
11707 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11708 the addresses
11709 .code
11710 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11711 abc\:xyz@test.example
11712 .endd
11713 the value of &$local_part$& is
11714 .code
11715 abc:xyz
11716 .endd
11717 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11718 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11719 have:
11720 .code
11721 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11722 .endd
11723 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11724 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11725 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11726
11727 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11728 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11729 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11730 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11731 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11732 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11733 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11734
11735 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11736 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11737 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11738 variable expands to nothing.
11739
11740 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11741 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11742 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11743 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11744 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11745
11746 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11747 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11748 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11749 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11750 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11751
11752 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11753 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11754 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11755 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11756
11757 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11758 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11759 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11760
11761 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11762 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11763 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11764 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11765 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11766 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11767 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11768 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11769
11770 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11771 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11772 This contains the expanded value of the
11773 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11774 been read.
11775
11776 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11777 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11778 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11779 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11780 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11781 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11782
11783 .vitem &$log_space$&
11784 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11785 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11786 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11787 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11788 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11789 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11790
11791
11792 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11793 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11794 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11795 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11796 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11797 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11798 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11799 and &"yes"& if it was.
11800 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11801 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11802 as authenticated data.
11803
11804 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11805 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11806 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11807 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11808 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11809 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11810 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11811 variable is empty.
11812
11813 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11814 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11815 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11816 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11817 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11818
11819 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11820 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11821 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11822 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11823 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11824 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11825 character(s).
11826
11827 .vitem &$message_age$&
11828 .cindex "message" "age of"
11829 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11830 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11831 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11832 delivery attempt.
11833
11834 .vitem &$message_body$&
11835 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11836 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11837 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11838 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11839 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11840 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11841 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11842 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11843 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11844
11845 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11846 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11847 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11848 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11849 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11850
11851 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11852 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11853 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11854 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11855 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11856 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11857 &$message_body$&.
11858
11859 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11860 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11861 .cindex "message body" "size"
11862 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11863 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11864 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11865 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11866 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11867
11868 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11869 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11870 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11871 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11872 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11873 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11874 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11875 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11876
11877 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11878 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11879 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11880 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11881 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11882 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11883
11884 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11885 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11886 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11887 contents of header lines is done.
11888
11889 .vitem &$message_id$&
11890 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11891
11892 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11893 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11894 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11895 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11896 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11897 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11898 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11899 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11900 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11901 from the body is not counted.
11902
11903 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11904 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11905 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11906 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11907 header and the body).
11908
11909 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11910 .code
11911 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11912 condition = \
11913 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11914 .endd
11915 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11916 message has not yet been received.
11917
11918 .vitem &$message_size$&
11919 .cindex "size" "of message"
11920 .cindex "message" "size"
11921 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11922 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11923 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11924 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11925 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11926 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11927 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11928 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11929 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11930
11931 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11932 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11933 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11934 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11935
11936 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11937 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11938 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11939 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11940
11941 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11942 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11943 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11944
11945 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11946 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11947 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11948 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11949 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11950 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11951 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11952 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11953 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11954 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11955
11956 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11957 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11958 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11959
11960 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11961 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11962 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11963 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11964 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11965 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11966 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11967 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11968 the original address.
11969
11970 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11971 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11972 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11973 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11974 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11975
11976 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11977 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11978 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11979
11980 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11981 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11982 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11983 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11984 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11985 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11986 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11987 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11988 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11989
11990 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11991 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11992 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11993 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11994 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11995 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11996 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11997 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11998 user.
11999
12000 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12001 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12002 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12003 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12004
12005 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12006 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12007 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12008 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12009
12010 .vitem &$pid$&
12011 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12012 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12013 This variable contains the current process id.
12014
12015 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12016 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12017 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12018 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12019 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12020 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12021 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12022 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12023 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12024 variable"& error if encountered.
12025
12026 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12027 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12028 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12029 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12030 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12031 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12032 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12033
12034
12035 .new
12036 .vitem &$proxy_host_address$& &&&
12037 &$proxy_host_port$& &&&
12038 &$proxy_target_address$& &&&
12039 &$proxy_target_port$& &&&
12040 &$proxy_session$&
12041 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol support
12042 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12043 .wen
12044
12045 .new
12046 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12047 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12048 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12049 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12050 .wen
12051
12052 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12053 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12054 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12055 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12056
12057 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12058 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12059 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12060 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12061
12062 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12063 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12064 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12065 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12066
12067 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12068 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12069 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12070
12071 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12072 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12073 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12074 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12075
12076 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12077 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12078 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12079 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12080 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12081
12082 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12083 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12084 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12085 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12086 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12087 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12088
12089 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12090 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12091 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12092 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12093 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12094
12095 .vitem &$received_count$&
12096 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12097 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12098 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12099 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12100 delivering.
12101
12102 .vitem &$received_for$&
12103 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12104 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12105 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12106 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12107 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12108
12109 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12110 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12111 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12112 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12113 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12114 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12115 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12116 option.
12117
12118 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12119 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12120 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12121 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12122 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12123 time.
12124 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12125
12126 .vitem &$received_port$&
12127 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12128 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12129
12130 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12131 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12132 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12133 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12134 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12135 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12136 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12137 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12138 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12139
12140 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12141 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12142 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12143 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12144 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12145 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12146
12147 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12148 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12149 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12150
12151 .vitem &$received_time$&
12152 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12153 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12154 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12155
12156 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12157 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12158 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12159 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12160 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12161 .display
12162 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12163 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12164 .endd
12165 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12166 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12167 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12168 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12169
12170 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12171 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12172 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12173 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12174
12175 .ilist
12176 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12177 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12178
12179 .next
12180 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12181
12182 .next
12183 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12184 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12185 MAIL).
12186
12187 .next
12188 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12189 .next
12190
12191 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12192 .endlist
12193
12194 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12195 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12196
12197 .vitem &$recipients$&
12198 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12199 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12200 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12201 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12202 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12203 cases:
12204
12205 .olist
12206 In a system filter file.
12207 .next
12208 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12209 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12210 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12211 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12212 .next
12213 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12214 .endlist
12215
12216
12217 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12218 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12219 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12220 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12221 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12222 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12223
12224
12225 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12226 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12227 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12228 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12229
12230 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12231 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12232 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12233 these variables contain the
12234 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12235
12236
12237 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12238 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12239 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12240 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12241 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12242 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12243 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12244
12245 .vitem &$return_path$&
12246 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12247 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12248 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12249 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12250 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12251 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12252 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12253 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12254 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12255 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12256 envelope sender.
12257
12258 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12259 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12260 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12261
12262 .vitem &$router_name$&
12263 .cindex "router" "name"
12264 .cindex "name" "of router"
12265 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12266 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12267
12268 .vitem &$runrc$&
12269 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12270 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12271 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12272 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12273 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12274 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12275 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12276 another.
12277
12278 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12279 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12280 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12281 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12282 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12283 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12284 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12285 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12286
12287 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12288 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12289 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12290 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12291 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12292 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12293
12294 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12295 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12296 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12297 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12298 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12299 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12300 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12301 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12302
12303 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12304 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12305 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12306
12307 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12308 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12309 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12310
12311 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12312 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12313 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12314 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12315 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12316 this:
12317 .display
12318 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12319 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12320 .endd
12321 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12322 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12323 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12324 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12325
12326 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12327 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12328 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12329 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12330 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12331 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12332 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12333 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12334 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12335 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12336 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12337 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12338 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12339
12340 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12341 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12342 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12343 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12344 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12345
12346 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12347 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12348 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12349 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12350 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12351 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12352
12353 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12354 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12355 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12356 this variable contains that
12357 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12358
12359 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12360 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12361 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12362 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12363 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12364 &$authenticated_id$&.
12365
12366 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12367 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12368 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12369 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12370 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12371 resolver library states that both
12372 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12373 other times, this variable is false.
12374
12375 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12376 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12377 library, by setting:
12378 .code
12379 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12380 .endd
12381
12382 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12383 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12384
12385 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12386 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12387
12388
12389 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12390 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12391 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12392 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12393 other means, this variable is empty.
12394
12395 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12396 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12397 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12398 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12399 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12400 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12401 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12402
12403 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12404 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12405 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12406 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12407
12408 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12409 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12410 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12411 is set to &"1"&.
12412
12413 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12414 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12415 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12416 following are true:
12417
12418 .ilist
12419 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12420 .next
12421 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12422 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12423 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12424 .next
12425 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12426 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12427 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12428 .next
12429 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12430 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12431 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12432 .next
12433 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12434 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12435 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12436 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12437 .code
12438 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12439 .endd
12440 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12441 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12442 .endlist
12443
12444
12445 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12446 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12447 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12448 number that was used on the remote host.
12449
12450 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12451 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12452 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12453 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12454 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12455 called Exim.
12456
12457 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12458 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12459 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12460 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12461
12462 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12463 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12464 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12465 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12466 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12467 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12468 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12469 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12470 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12471 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12472 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12473 the parentheses.
12474
12475 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12476 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12477 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12478 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12479 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12480
12481 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12482 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12483 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12484 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12485 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12486
12487 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12488 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12489 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12490 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12491 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12492 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12493 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12494
12495 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12496 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12497 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12498 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12499 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12500
12501 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12502 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12503 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12504 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12505 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12506 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12507
12508 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12509 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12510 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12511 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12512 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12513 .code
12514 MAIL FROM:<>
12515 MAIL FROM: <>
12516 .endd
12517 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12518 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12519 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12520 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12521
12522 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12523 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12524 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12525 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12526 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12527 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12528 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12529
12530 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12531 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12532 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12533 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12534 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12535 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12536 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12537 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12538 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12539 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12540 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12541
12542 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12543 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12544 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12545 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12546 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12547 message is junk mail.
12548
12549 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12550 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12551 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12552 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12553
12554
12555 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12556 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12557 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12558
12559 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12560 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12561 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12562 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12563 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12564 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12565
12566 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12567 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12568 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12569 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12570 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12571 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12572 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12573 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12574 .code
12575 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12576 .endd
12577 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12578
12579
12580 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12581 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12582 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12583 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12584 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12585 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12586
12587 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12588 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12589 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12590 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12591 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12592 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12593 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12594 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12595
12596 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12597 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12598 the outbound.
12599
12600 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12601 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12602 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12603 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12604 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12605 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12606
12607 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12608 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12609 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12610 inbound connection when the message was received.
12611 It is only useful as the argument of a
12612 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12613 or a &%def%& condition.
12614
12615 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12616 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12617 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12618 inbound connection when the message was received.
12619 It is only useful as the argument of a
12620 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12621 or a &%def%& condition.
12622 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12623 which is not the leaf.
12624
12625 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12626 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12627 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12628 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12629 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12630 or a &%def%& condition.
12631
12632 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12633 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12634 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12635 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12636 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12637 or a &%def%& condition.
12638 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12639 which is not the leaf.
12640
12641 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12642 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12643 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12644 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12645
12646 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12647 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12648 the outbound.
12649
12650 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12651 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12652 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12653 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12654 and &"0"& otherwise.
12655
12656 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12657 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12658 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12659 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12660 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12661 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12662 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12663 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12664 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12665
12666 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12667 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12668 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12669
12670 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12671 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12672 This variable is
12673 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12674 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12675 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12676 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12677
12678 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12679 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12680 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12681 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12682 .code
12683 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12684 1 No response to request
12685 2 Response not verified
12686 3 Verification failed
12687 4 Verification succeeded
12688 .endd
12689
12690 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12691 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12692 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12693 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12694 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12695
12696 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12697 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12698 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12699 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12700 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12701 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12702 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12703 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12704 which is not the leaf.
12705
12706 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12707 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12708 the outbound.
12709
12710 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12711 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12712 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12713 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12714 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12715 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12716 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12717 which is not the leaf.
12718
12719 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12720 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12721 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12722 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12723 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12724 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12725 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12726 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12727 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12728 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12729 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12730
12731 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12732 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12733 the outbound.
12734
12735 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12736 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12737 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12738 During outbound
12739 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12740 the transport.
12741
12742 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12743 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12744 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12745 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12746
12747 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12748 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12749 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12750
12751 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12752 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12753 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12754
12755 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12756 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12757 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12758 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12759 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12760 values for those that are behind (west).
12761
12762 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12763 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12764 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12765 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12766
12767 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12768 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12769 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12770 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12771 flag.
12772
12773 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12774 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12775 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12776 -0500.
12777
12778 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12779 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12780 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12781 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12782
12783 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12784 .cindex "transport" "name"
12785 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12786 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12787 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12788
12789 .vitem &$value$&
12790 .vindex "&$value$&"
12791 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12792 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12793 &*reduce*& expansion.
12794
12795 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12796 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12797 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12798 or for cutthrough delivery,
12799 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12800 Otherwise, empty.
12801
12802 .vitem &$version_number$&
12803 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12804 The version number of Exim.
12805
12806 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12807 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12808 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12809 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12810
12811 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12812 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12813 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12814 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12815 .endlist
12816 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12817
12818
12819
12820 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12821 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12822
12823 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12824 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12825 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12826 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12827 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12828 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12829 the line
12830 .code
12831 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12832 .endd
12833 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12834
12835
12836 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12837 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12838 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12839 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12840 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12841 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12842 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12843 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12844 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12845
12846 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12847 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12848 should usually be something like
12849 .code
12850 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12851 .endd
12852 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12853 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12854 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12855 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12856 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12857 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12858 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12859 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12860 two ways:
12861
12862 .ilist
12863 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12864 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12865 a startup when Exim is entered.
12866 .next
12867 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12868 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12869 .endlist
12870
12871 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12872 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12873
12874
12875 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12876 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12877 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12878 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12879 forms:
12880 .code
12881 ${perl{foo}}
12882 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12883 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12884 .endd
12885 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12886 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12887 with an error message of the form
12888 .code
12889 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12890 .endd
12891 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12892 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12893 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12894 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12895 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12896 that was passed to &%die%&.
12897
12898
12899 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12900 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12901 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12902 the Perl code
12903 .code
12904 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12905 .endd
12906 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12907 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12908 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12909
12910 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12911 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12912 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12913 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12914
12915 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12916 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12917 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12918 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12919 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12920 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12921 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12922
12923
12924 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12925 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12926 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12927 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12928 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12929 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12930 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12931 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12932 avoided, but the output is lost.
12933
12934 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12935 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12936 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12937 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12938 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12939 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12940 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12941 .code
12942 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12943 .endd
12944 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12945 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12946 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12947 as the first subroutine argument.
12948 .ecindex IIDperl
12949
12950
12951 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12952 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12953
12954 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12955 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12956 "Starting the daemon"
12957 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12958 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12959 .cindex "network interface"
12960 .cindex "interface" "network"
12961 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12962 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12963 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12964 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12965 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12966 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12967 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12968 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12969 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12970 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12971 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12972
12973 .olist
12974 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12975 and ports to listen on.
12976 .next
12977 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12978 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12979 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12980 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12981 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12982 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12983 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12984 as an error situation.
12985 .next
12986 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12987 for the outgoing connection.
12988 .endlist
12989
12990
12991 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12992 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12993 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12994 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12995 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12996
12997 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12998 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12999 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13000 chapter describes how they operate.
13001
13002 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13003 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13004
13005
13006
13007 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13008 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13009 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13010 following options:
13011
13012 .ilist
13013 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13014 or service names.
13015 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13016 .next
13017 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13018 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13019 .endlist
13020
13021 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13022 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13023 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13024 colons. For example:
13025 .code
13026 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13027 192.168.23.65 ; \
13028 ::1 ; \
13029 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13030 .endd
13031 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13032 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13033
13034 .olist
13035 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13036 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13037 .code
13038 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13039 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13040 .endd
13041 .next
13042 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13043 with a colon separator, for example:
13044 .code
13045 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13046 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13047 .endd
13048 .endlist
13049
13050 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13051 default setting contains just one port:
13052 .code
13053 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13054 .endd
13055 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13056 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13057 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13058 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13059 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13060
13061
13062
13063 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13064 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13065 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13066 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13067 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13068 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13069 .code
13070 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13071 .endd
13072 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13073 .code
13074 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13075 .endd
13076 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13077
13078
13079
13080 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13081 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13082 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13083 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13084 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13085 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13086 exim.
13087
13088 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13089 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13090 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13091 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13092 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13093 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13094 .code
13095 -oX 1225
13096 .endd
13097 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13098 whereas
13099 .code
13100 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13101 .endd
13102 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13103 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13104 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13105
13106
13107
13108 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13109 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13110 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13111 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13112 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13113 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13114 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13115 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13116 list of port numbers or service names,
13117 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13118 common use of this option is expected to be
13119 .code
13120 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13121 .endd
13122 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13123 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13124 this way when a daemon is started.
13125
13126 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13127 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13128 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13129 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13130 connections via the daemon.)
13131
13132
13133
13134
13135 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13136 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13137 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13138 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13139 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13140 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13141 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13142 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13143 .code
13144 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13145 .endd
13146 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13147 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13148 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13149 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13150 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13151 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13152 .code
13153 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13154 .endd
13155 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13156 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13157 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13158 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13159 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13160
13161 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13162 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13163 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13164 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13165 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13166 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13167 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13168 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13169 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13170 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13171 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13172 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13173
13174 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13175 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13176 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13177 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13178 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13179
13180
13181
13182 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13183 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13184 .code
13185 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13186 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13187 .endd
13188 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13189 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13190 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13191 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13192
13193 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13194 .code
13195 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13196 .endd
13197 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13198 .code
13199 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13200 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13201 .endd
13202 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13203 IPv4 loopback address only:
13204 .code
13205 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13206 .endd
13207 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13208 .code
13209 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13210 .endd
13211 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13212
13213
13214
13215 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13216 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13217 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13218 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13219 treated as local.
13220
13221 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13222 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13223 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13224 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13225
13226 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13227 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13228 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13229 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13230 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13231 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13232 used for listening. Consider this example:
13233 .code
13234 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13235 192.168.53.235 ; \
13236 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13237
13238 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13239 .endd
13240 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13241 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13242 Exim is routing.
13243
13244 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13245 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13246 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13247 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13248 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13249 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13250 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13251 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13252
13253
13254
13255 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13256 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13257 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13258 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13259 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13260 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13261 details.
13262
13263
13264
13265
13266 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13268
13269 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13270 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13271 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13272 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13273
13274 .ilist
13275 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13276 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13277 .next
13278 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13279 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13280 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13281 .next
13282 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13283 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13284 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13285 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13286 settings.
13287 .endlist
13288
13289 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13290 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13291 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13292 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13293 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13294 listed in more than one group.
13295
13296 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13297 .table2
13298 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13299 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13300 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13301 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13302 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13303 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13304 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13305 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13306 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13307 .endtable
13308
13309
13310 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13311 .table2
13312 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13313 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13314 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13315 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13316 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13317 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13318 .endtable
13319
13320
13321
13322 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13323 .table2
13324 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13325 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13326 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13327 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13328 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13329 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13330 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13331 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13332 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13333 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13334 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13335 .endtable
13336
13337
13338
13339 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13340 .table2
13341 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13342 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13343 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13344 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13345 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13346 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13347 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13348 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13349 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13350 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13351 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13352 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13353 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13354 .endtable
13355
13356
13357
13358 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13359 .table2
13360 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13361 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13362 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13363 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13364 .endtable
13365
13366
13367
13368 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13369 .table2
13370 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13371 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13372 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13373 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13374 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13375 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13376 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13377 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13378 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13379 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13380 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13381 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13382 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13383 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13384 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13385 .endtable
13386
13387
13388
13389 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13390 .table2
13391 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13392 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13393 .endtable
13394
13395
13396
13397 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13398 .table2
13399 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13400 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13401 .endtable
13402
13403
13404
13405 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13406 .table2
13407 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13408 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13409 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13410 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13411 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13412 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13413 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13414 .endtable
13415
13416
13417
13418 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13419 .table2
13420 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13421 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13422 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13423 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13424 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13425 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13426 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13427 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13428 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13429 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13430 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13431 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13432 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13433 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13434 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13435 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13436 connection"
13437 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13438 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13439 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13440 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13441 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13442 .endtable
13443
13444
13445
13446 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13447 .table2
13448 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13449 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13450 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13451 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13452 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13453 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13454 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13455 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13456 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13457 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13458 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13459 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13460 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13461 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13462 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13463 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13464 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13465 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13466 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13467 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13468 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13469 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13470 words""&"
13471 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13472 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13473 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13474 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13475 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13476 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13477 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13478 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13479 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13480 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13481 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13482 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13483 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13484 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13485 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13486 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13487 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13488 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13489 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13490 .endtable
13491
13492
13493
13494 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13495 .table2
13496 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13497 item"
13498 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13499 item"
13500 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13501 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13502 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13503 .endtable
13504
13505
13506
13507 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13508 .table2
13509 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13510 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13511 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13512 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13513 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13514 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13515 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13516 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13517 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13518 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13519 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13520 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13521 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13522 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13523 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13524 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13525 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13526 .endtable
13527
13528
13529
13530 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13531 .table2
13532 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13533 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13534 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13535 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13536 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13537 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13538 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13539 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13540 .endtable
13541
13542
13543
13544 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13545 .table2
13546 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13547 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13548 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13549 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13550 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13551 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13552 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13553 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13554 .endtable
13555
13556
13557
13558
13559 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13560 .table2
13561 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13562 .endtable
13563
13564
13565
13566
13567
13568 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13569 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13570
13571 .table2
13572 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13573 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13574 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13575 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13576 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13577 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13578 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13579 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13580 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13581 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13582 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13583 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13584 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13585 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13586 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13587 connection"
13588 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13589 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13590 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13591 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13592 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13593 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13594 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13595 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13596 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13597 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13598 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13599 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13600 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13601 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13602 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13603 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13604 .endtable
13605
13606
13607
13608 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13609 .table2
13610 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13611 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13612 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13613 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13614 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13615 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13616 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13617 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13618 .endtable
13619
13620
13621
13622 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13623 .table2
13624 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13625 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13626 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13627 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13628 words""&"
13629 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13630 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13631 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13632 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13633 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13634 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13635 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13636 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13637 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13638 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13639 .endtable
13640
13641
13642
13643 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13644 .table2
13645 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13646 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13647 directory"
13648 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13649 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13650 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13651 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13652 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13653 .endtable
13654
13655
13656
13657 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13658 .table2
13659 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13660 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13661 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13662 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13663 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13664 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13665 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13666 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13667 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13668 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13669 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13670 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13671 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13672 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13673 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13674 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13675 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13676 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13677 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13678 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13679 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13680 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13681 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13682 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13683 .endtable
13684
13685
13686
13687 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13688 .table2
13689 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13690 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13691 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13692 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13693 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13694 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13695 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13696 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13697 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13698 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13699 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13700 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13701 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13702 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13703 .endtable
13704
13705
13706
13707 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13708 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13709 &dagger;.
13710
13711 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13712 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13713 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13714 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13715 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13716 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13717 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13718 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13719 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13720
13721 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13722 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13723 It now defaults to true.
13724 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13725 .display
13726 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13727 .endd
13728
13729 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13730 .code
13731 log_selector = +8bitmime
13732 .endd
13733
13734 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13735 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13736 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13737 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13738 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13739 further details.
13740
13741 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13742 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13743 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13744 SMTP messages.
13745
13746 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13747 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13748 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13749 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13750 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13751
13752 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13753 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13754 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13755 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13756 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13757
13758 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13759 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13760 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13761 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13762
13763 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13764 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13765 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13766 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13767 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13768
13769 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13770 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13771 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13772 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13773 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13774 This option defines the ACL that,
13775 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13776 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13777 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13778 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13779
13780 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13781 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13782 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13783 of a received message.
13784 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13785
13786 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13787 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13788 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13789 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13790
13791 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13792 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13793 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13794 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13795
13796 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13797 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13798 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13799 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13800 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13801
13802
13803 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13804 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13805 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13806 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13807
13808 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13809 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13810 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13811 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13812 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13813
13814 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13815 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13816 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13817 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13818 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13819
13820 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13821 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13822 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13823 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13824 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13825
13826 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13827 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13828 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13829 further details.
13830
13831 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13832 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13833 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13834 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13835
13836 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13837 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13838 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13839 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13840
13841 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13842 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13843 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13844 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13845
13846 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13847 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13848 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13849 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13850
13851 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13852 .cindex "admin user"
13853 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13854 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13855 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13856 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13857 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13858 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13859 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13860
13861 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13862 .cindex "domain literal"
13863 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13864 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13865 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13866 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13867
13868 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13869 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13870 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13871 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13872 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13873 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13874 the local host's IP addresses.
13875
13876
13877 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13878 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13879 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13880 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13881 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13882 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13883 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13884 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13885 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13886
13887 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13888 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13889 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13890 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13891 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13892 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13893 experiment if they wish.
13894
13895 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13896 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13897 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13898 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13899 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13900 suitable setting is:
13901 .code
13902 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13903 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13904 .endd
13905 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13906 .code
13907 dns_check_names_pattern =
13908 .endd
13909 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13910
13911
13912 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13913 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13914 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13915 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13916 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13917 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13918 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13919 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13920 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13921 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13922 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13923
13924 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13925 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13926 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13927 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13928 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13929 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13930
13931 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13932 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13933 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13934 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13935 .code
13936 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13937 .endd
13938 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13939 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13940 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13941 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13942
13943
13944 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13945 .cindex "thawing messages"
13946 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13947 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13948 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13949 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13950 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13951 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13952
13953 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13954 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13955 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13956
13957
13958 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13959 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13960 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13961 .code
13962 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13963 .endd
13964 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13965 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13966
13967
13968 .option bi_command main string unset
13969 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13970 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13971 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13972 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13973 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13974
13975
13976 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13977 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13978 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13979 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13980 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13981 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13982
13983
13984 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13985 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13986 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13987 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13988
13989 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13990 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13991 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13992 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13993 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13994 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13995 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13996 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13997 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13998 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13999
14000 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14001 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14002 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14003 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14004
14005
14006 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14007 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14008 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14009 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14010 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14011 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14012 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14013 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14014 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14015
14016 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14017 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14018 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14019 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14020 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14021 messages.
14022
14023 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14024 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14025 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14026 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14027 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14028 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14029 connection. A typical setting might be:
14030 .code
14031 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14032 .endd
14033 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14034 .code
14035 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14036 .endd
14037 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14038 address.
14039
14040 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14041 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14042 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14043 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14044 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14045 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14046
14047
14048 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14049 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14050 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14051 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14052
14053
14054 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14055 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14056 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14057 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14058
14059
14060 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14061 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14062 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14063 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14064
14065
14066 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14067 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14068 callout verification. The default value is
14069 .code
14070 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14071 .endd
14072 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14073
14074
14075 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14076 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14077
14078
14079 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14080 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14081
14082 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14083 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14084 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14085 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14086 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14087 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14088 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14089 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14090 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14091 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14092
14093
14094 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14095 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14096
14097
14098 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14099 .cindex "checking disk space"
14100 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14101 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14102 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14103 message is accepted.
14104
14105 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14106 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14107 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14108 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14109 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14110 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14111 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14112 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14113
14114
14115 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14116 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14117 .code
14118 check_spool_space = 10M
14119 check_spool_inodes = 100
14120 .endd
14121 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14122 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14123 transit.
14124
14125 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14126 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14127 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14128
14129 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14130 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14131 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14132 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14133 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14134 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14135
14136 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14137 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14138
14139 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14140 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14141 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14142
14143 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14144 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14145 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14146 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14147 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14148 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14149
14150 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14151 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14152 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14153 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14154 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14155 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14156 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14157
14158 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14159 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14160
14161 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14162 .cindex "warning of delay"
14163 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14164 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14165 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14166 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14167 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14168 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14169 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14170 with
14171 .code
14172 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14173 .endd
14174 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14175 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14176 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14177 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14178 .code
14179 delay_warning = 6h
14180 .endd
14181 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14182 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14183 .code
14184 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14185 .endd
14186 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14187 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14188 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14189
14190 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14191 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14192 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14193 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14194 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14195 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14196 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14197 not sent. The default is:
14198 .code
14199 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14200 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14201 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14202 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14203 } {no}{yes}}
14204 .endd
14205 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14206 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14207 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14208 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14209
14210 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14211 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14212 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14213 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14214 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14215 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14216 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14217 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14218
14219 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14220 .cindex "load average"
14221 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14222 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14223 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14224 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14225 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14226
14227
14228 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14229 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14230 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14231 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14232 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14233 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14234 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14235 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14236
14237 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14238 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14239 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14240 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14241 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14242 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14243 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14244 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14245
14246 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14247 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14248 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14249 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14250
14251
14252 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14253 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14254 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14255 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14256 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14257 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14258 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14259
14260
14261 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14262 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14263 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14264 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14265 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14266 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14267
14268
14269 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14270 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14271 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14272 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14273 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14274 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14275 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14276 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14277 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14278 by a setting such as this:
14279 .code
14280 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14281 .endd
14282 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14283 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14284 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14285 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14286 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14287 options are applied after this global option.
14288
14289 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14290 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14291 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14292 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14293 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14294 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14295 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14296 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14297 value of this option. The default pattern is
14298 .code
14299 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14300 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14301 .endd
14302 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14303 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14304 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14305 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14306 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14307 empty string.
14308
14309 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14310 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14311 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14312
14313 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14314 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14315 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14316 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14317
14318
14319 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14320 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14321 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14322 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14323 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14324 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14325
14326 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14327
14328
14329 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14330 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14331 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14332 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14333 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14334 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14335 domain matches this list.
14336
14337 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14338 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14339 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14340
14341
14342 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14343 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14344 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14345 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14346 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14347 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14348 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14349 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14350 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14351 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14352 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14353 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14354 to set in them.
14355 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14356
14357
14358 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14359 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14360
14361
14362 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14363 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14364 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14365 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14366 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14367 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14368 match with this expanded domain list.
14369
14370 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14371 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14372 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14373 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14374 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14375 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14376
14377 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14378 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14379 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14380
14381 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14382 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14383 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14384 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14385 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14386
14387 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14388 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14389 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14390 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14391 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14392 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14393 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14394 on.
14395
14396 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14397
14398
14399 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14400 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14401 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14402 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14403
14404 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14405 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14406 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14407 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14408 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14409 and accepted from, these hosts.
14410 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14411 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14412 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14413 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14414 are sent.
14415
14416 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14417 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14418 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14419 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14420 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14421 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14422 .code
14423 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14424 .endd
14425 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14426 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14427
14428 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14429 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14430 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14431 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14432 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14433 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14434 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14435 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14436 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14437
14438
14439 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14440 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14441 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14442 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14443 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14444 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14445 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14446 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14447 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14448
14449 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14450 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14451 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14452 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14453 are examined. For example:
14454 .code
14455 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14456 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14457 postmaster@mydomain.example
14458 .endd
14459 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14460 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14461 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14462 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14463 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14464 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14465 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14466
14467
14468 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14469 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14470 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14471 .display
14472 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14473 .endd
14474 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14475 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14476 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14477 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14478 overrides the default.
14479
14480 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14481 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14482 and warning messages. For example:
14483 .code
14484 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14485 .endd
14486 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14487 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14488 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14489 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14490 not used.
14491
14492
14493 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14494 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14495 .cindex "Exim group"
14496 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14497 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14498 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14499 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14500 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14501 security issues.
14502
14503
14504 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14505 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14506 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14507 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14508 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14509 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14510 other place.
14511 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14512 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14513 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14514 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14515
14516
14517 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14518 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14519 .cindex "Exim user"
14520 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14521 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14522 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14523 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14524
14525 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14526 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14527 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14528 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14529
14530
14531 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14532 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14533 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14534 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14535
14536
14537 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14538 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14539
14540 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14541 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14542 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14543 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14544 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14545 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14546 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14547 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14548 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14549 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14550 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14551 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14552 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14553 addresses.
14554
14555
14556 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14557 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14558 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14559 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14560 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14561 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14562 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14563 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14564 retries.
14565
14566 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14567 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14568 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14569 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14570
14571
14572
14573 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14574 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14575 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14576 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14577 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14578 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14579 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14580 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14581 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14582 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14583 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14584 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14585 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14586 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14587 logging that you require.
14588
14589
14590 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14591 .cindex "HP-UX"
14592 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14593 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14594 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14595 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14596 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14597 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14598 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14599 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14600
14601 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14602 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14603 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14604 user's name.
14605
14606 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14607 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14608 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14609 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14610 .code
14611 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14612 gecos_name = $1
14613 .endd
14614
14615 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14616 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14617
14618
14619 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14620 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14621 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14622 implementations of TLS.
14623
14624
14625 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14626 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14627 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14628
14629 See
14630 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14631 for documentation.
14632
14633
14634
14635 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14636 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14637 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14638 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14639 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14640 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14641
14642
14643
14644 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14645 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14646 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14647 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14648 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14649 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14650 sections are rejected.
14651
14652
14653 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14654 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14655 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14656 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14657 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14658 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14659 zero means &"no limit"&.
14660
14661
14662
14663
14664 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14665 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14666 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14667 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14668 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14669 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14670 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14671 if you want to do semantic checking.
14672 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14673 set.
14674
14675
14676 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14677 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14678 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14679 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14680 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14681 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14682 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14683 .code
14684 helo_allow_chars = _
14685 .endd
14686 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14687
14688
14689 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14690 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14691 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14692 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14693 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14694 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14695 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14696 do.
14697
14698
14699 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14700 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14701 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14702 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14703 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14704 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14705 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14706 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14707 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14708 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14709 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14710 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14711
14712 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14713 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14714 EHLO command either:
14715
14716 .ilist
14717 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14718 .next
14719 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14720 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14721 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14722 calling host address, or
14723 .next
14724 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14725 .endlist
14726
14727 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14728 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14729 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14730
14731 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14732 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14733 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14734
14735 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14736 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14737 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14738 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14739 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14740 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14741 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14742 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14743 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14744 error.
14745
14746 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14747 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14748 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14749 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14750 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14751 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14752 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14753 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14754 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14755
14756 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14757 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14758 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14759 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14760 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14761
14762 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14763 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14764 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14765 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14766
14767
14768 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14769 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14770 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14771 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14772 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14773 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14774 default configuration file contains
14775 .code
14776 host_lookup = *
14777 .endd
14778 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14779 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14780
14781 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14782 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14783 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14784
14785 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14786 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14787 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14788 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14789 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14790 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14791
14792
14793 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14794 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14795 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14796 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14797 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14798 if you want.
14799
14800 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14801 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14802 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14803 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14804
14805
14806
14807 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14808 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14809 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14810 as soon as the connection is made.
14811 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14812 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14813 connections immediately.
14814
14815 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14816 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14817 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14818 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14819 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14820
14821
14822 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14823 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14824 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14825 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14826 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14827 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14828 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14829 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14830 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14831 .code
14832 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14833 .endd
14834 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14835
14836
14837
14838 .new
14839 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
14840 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
14841 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
14842 connections. For details see &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
14843 .wen
14844
14845
14846 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14847 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14848 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14849 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14850 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14851 records
14852 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14853 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14854
14855 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14856 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14857 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14858 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14859 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14860 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14861 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14862
14863
14864 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14865 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14866 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14867 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14868 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14869
14870
14871
14872 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14873 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14874 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14875 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14876 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14877 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14878
14879 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14880 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14881 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14882 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14883 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14884 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14885 for frozen messages. For example,
14886 .code
14887 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14888 .endd
14889 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14890 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14891 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14892 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14893 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14894 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14895
14896
14897 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14898 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14899 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14900 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14901 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14902 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14903 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14904 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14905 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14906 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14907
14908
14909 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14910 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14911
14912
14913 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14914 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14915 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14916 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14917 logged.
14918
14919
14920 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14921 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14922 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14923 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14924 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14925 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14926 and constrained to be a directory.
14927
14928
14929 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14930 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14931 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14932 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14933 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14934 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14935 and constrained to be a file.
14936
14937
14938 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14939 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14940 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14941 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14942 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14943
14944
14945 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14946 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14947 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14948 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14949 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14950 identity to be proven.
14951
14952
14953 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14954 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14955 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14956 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14957 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14958
14959
14960 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14961 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14962 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14963 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14964 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14965 with LDAP support.
14966
14967
14968 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14969 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14970 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14971 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14972 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14973 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14974 to hard/demand.
14975
14976
14977 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14978 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14979 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14980 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14981 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14982 of SSL-on-connect.
14983 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14984 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14985
14986
14987 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14988 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14989 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14990 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14991 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14992 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14993 has been built with LDAP support.
14994
14995
14996
14997 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14998 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14999 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15000 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15001 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15002 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15003 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15004
15005 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15006 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15007 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15008
15009 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15010 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15011 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15012 and the default qualify domain.
15013
15014 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15015 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15016 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15017 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15018
15019 .cindex "envelope sender"
15020 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15021 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15022 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15023
15024 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15025 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15026 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15027
15028
15029
15030
15031 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15032 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15033 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15034 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15035 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15036 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15037 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15038 example, if
15039 .code
15040 local_from_prefix = *-
15041 .endd
15042 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15043 .code
15044 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15045 .endd
15046 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15047 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15048 qualify domain.
15049
15050
15051 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15052 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15053
15054
15055 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15056 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15057 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15058 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15059 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15060 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15061 &%local_interfaces%& is
15062 .code
15063 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15064 .endd
15065 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15066 .code
15067 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15068 .endd
15069
15070 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15071 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15072 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15073 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15074 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15075 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15076 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15077 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15078
15079
15080
15081 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15082 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15083 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15084 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15085 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15086 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15087 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15088 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15089
15090
15091
15092
15093 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15094 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15095 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15096 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15097 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15098 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15099 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15100 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15101 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15102 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15103 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15104 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15105 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15106 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15107 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15108
15109
15110
15111 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15112 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15113 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15114 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15115 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15116 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15117 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15118 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15119 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15120 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15121 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15122 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15123 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15124 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15125 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15126
15127
15128 .option log_selector main string unset
15129 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15130 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15131 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15132 minus characters. For example:
15133 .code
15134 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15135 .endd
15136 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15137 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15138
15139
15140 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15141 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15142 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15143 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15144 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15145 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15146 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15147 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15148 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15149 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15150 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15151 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15152 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15153
15154
15155 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15156 .cindex "too many open files"
15157 .cindex "open files, too many"
15158 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15159 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15160 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15161 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15162 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15163 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15164 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15165 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15166 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15167 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15168 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15169 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15170
15171
15172 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15173 .cindex "length of login name"
15174 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15175 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15176 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15177 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15178 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15179 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15180
15181
15182 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15183 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15184 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15185 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15186 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15187 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15188 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15189 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15190
15191
15192 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15193 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15194 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15195 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15196 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15197 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15198 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15199
15200
15201 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15202 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15203 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15204 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15205 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15206 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15207 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15208 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15209 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15210 empty string, the option is ignored.
15211
15212
15213 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15214 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15215 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15216 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15217 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15218 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15219 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15220 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15221 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15222 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15223 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15224 colons will become hyphens.
15225
15226
15227 .option message_logs main boolean true
15228 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15229 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15230 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15231 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15232 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15233 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15234 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15235 which is not affected by this option.
15236
15237
15238 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15239 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15240 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15241 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15242 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15243 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15244 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15245 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15246 optionally followed by K or M.
15247
15248 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15249 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15250 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15251 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15252 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15253
15254 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15255 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15256 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15257 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15258 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15259 message that an individual transport can process.
15260
15261 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15262 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15263 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15264 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15265 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15266 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15267 some problems may result.
15268
15269 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15270 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15271 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15272
15273
15274 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15275 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15276 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15277 .code
15278 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15279 .endd
15280 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15281 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15282 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15283 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15284 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15285
15286
15287 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15288 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15289 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15290 contains a full description of this facility.
15291
15292
15293
15294 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15295 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15296 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15297 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15298 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15299
15300
15301 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15302 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15303 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15304 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15305 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15306 safety precaution.
15307
15308 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15309 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15310 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15311 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15312 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15313
15314 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15315 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15316 example is
15317 .code
15318 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15319 .endd
15320 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15321 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15322 transport driver.
15323
15324
15325 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15326 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15327 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15328 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15329 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15330
15331 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15332 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15333 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15334 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15335 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15336 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15337 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15338
15339 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15340 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15341 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15342 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15343 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15344
15345 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15346
15347 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15348 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15349 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15350 some now infamous attacks.
15351
15352 Examples:
15353 .code
15354 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15355 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15356 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15357
15358 # Disable older protocol versions:
15359 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15360 .endd
15361
15362 Possible options may include:
15363 .ilist
15364 &`all`&
15365 .next
15366 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15367 .next
15368 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15369 .next
15370 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15371 .next
15372 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15373 .next
15374 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15375 .next
15376 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15377 .next
15378 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15379 .next
15380 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15381 .next
15382 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15383 .next
15384 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15385 .next
15386 &`no_compression`&
15387 .next
15388 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15389 .next
15390 &`no_sslv2`&
15391 .next
15392 &`no_sslv3`&
15393 .next
15394 &`no_ticket`&
15395 .next
15396 &`no_tlsv1`&
15397 .next
15398 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15399 .next
15400 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15401 .next
15402 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15403 .next
15404 &`single_dh_use`&
15405 .next
15406 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15407 .next
15408 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15409 .next
15410 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15411 .next
15412 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15413 .next
15414 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15415 .next
15416 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15417 .endlist
15418
15419 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15420 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15421 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15422 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15423 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15424 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15425
15426
15427 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15428 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15429 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15430 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15431 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15432
15433
15434 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15435 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15436 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15437 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15438 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15439 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15440 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15441 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15442 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15443 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15444 an ACL.
15445
15446 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15447 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15448 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15449 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15450 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15451 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15452 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15453
15454
15455 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15456 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15457 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15458
15459
15460 .option perl_startup main string unset
15461 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15462 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15463
15464
15465 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15466 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15467 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15468 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15469 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15470 PostgreSQL support.
15471
15472
15473 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15474 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15475 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15476 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15477 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15478 to the host name:
15479 .code
15480 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15481 .endd
15482 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15483 spool directory.
15484 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15485 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15486 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15487
15488
15489 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15490 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15491 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15492 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15493 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15494 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15495 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15496 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15497 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15498
15499
15500 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15501 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15502 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15503 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15504 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15505 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15506 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15507 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15508
15509 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15510 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15511 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15512 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15513 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15514 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15515 volume of mail. Use with care!
15516
15517
15518 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15519 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15520 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15521 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15522 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15523 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15524 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15525 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15526 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15527 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15528
15529 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15530 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15531 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15532 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15533 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15534 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15535
15536
15537 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15538 .cindex "printing characters"
15539 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15540 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15541 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15542 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15543 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15544 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15545 characters.
15546
15547 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15548 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15549 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15550 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15551 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15552 standards.
15553
15554
15555 .option process_log_path main string unset
15556 .cindex "process log path"
15557 .cindex "log" "process log"
15558 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15559 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15560 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15561 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15562 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15563 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15564 different spool directories.
15565
15566
15567 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15568 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15569 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15570 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15571 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15572 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15573 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15574
15575
15576 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15577 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15578 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15579 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15580 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15581 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15582 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15583 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15584 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15585
15586 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15587 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15588 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15589 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15590 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15591 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15592 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15593
15594
15595 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15596 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15597 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15598
15599
15600
15601 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15602 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15603 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15604 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15605 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15606 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15607 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15608 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15609
15610
15611 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15612 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15613 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15614 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15615 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15616
15617
15618 .option queue_only main boolean false
15619 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15620 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15621 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15622 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15623 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15624 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15625
15626 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15627 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15628 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15629 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15630
15631
15632 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15633 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15634 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15635 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15636 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15637 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15638 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15639 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15640 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15641 .code
15642 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15643 .endd
15644 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15645 &_/some/file_& exists.
15646
15647
15648 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15649 .cindex "load average"
15650 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15651 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15652 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15653 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15654 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15655 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15656 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15657 false.
15658
15659 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15660 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15661 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15662 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15663
15664
15665 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15666 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15667 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15668 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15669 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15670 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15671 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15672 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15673 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15674 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15675 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15676 re-evaluated for each message.
15677
15678
15679 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15680 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15681 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15682 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15683 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15684 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15685
15686
15687 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15688 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15689 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15690 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15691 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15692 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15693 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15694 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15695 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15696 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15697 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15698 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15699 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15700
15701
15702
15703 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15704 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15705 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15706 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15707 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15708 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15709 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15710 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15711 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15712
15713 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15714 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15715 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15716 the daemon's command line.
15717
15718 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15719 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15720 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15721 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15722 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15723 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15724 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15725 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15726 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15727 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15728 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15729 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15730 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15731 &%queue_domains%&.
15732
15733
15734 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15735 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15736 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15737 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15738 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15739 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15740 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15741
15742 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15743 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15744 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15745 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15746 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15747 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15748 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15749 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15750 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15751 header lines. The default setting is:
15752
15753 .code
15754 received_header_text = Received: \
15755 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15756 {${if def:sender_ident \
15757 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15758 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15759 by $primary_hostname \
15760 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15761 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15762 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15763 ${if def:sender_address \
15764 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15765 id $message_exim_id\
15766 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15767 .endd
15768
15769 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15770 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15771 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15772 header lines such as the following:
15773 .code
15774 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15775 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15776 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15777 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15778 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15779 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15780 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15781 .endd
15782 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15783 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15784 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15785 message was accepted.
15786
15787
15788 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15789 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15790 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15791 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15792 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15793 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15794 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15795 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15796
15797
15798 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15799 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15800 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15801 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15802 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15803 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15804 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15805 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15806 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15807 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15808 option was not set.
15809
15810
15811 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15812 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15813 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15814 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15815 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15816 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15817 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15818 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15819 done.
15820
15821 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15822 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15823 RCPT commands in a single message.
15824
15825
15826 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15827 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15828 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15829 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15830 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15831 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15832 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15833
15834
15835 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15836 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15837 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15838 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15839 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15840 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15841 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15842 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15843 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15844 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15845 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15846 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15847 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15848 tagged with its process id.
15849
15850 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15851 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15852 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15853 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15854 is received.
15855
15856 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15857 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15858 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15859 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15860 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15861 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15862 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15863 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15864 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15865 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15866 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15867
15868 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15869 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15870 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15871 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15872
15873
15874 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15875 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15876 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15877 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15878 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15879 .code
15880 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15881 .endd
15882 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15883 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15884
15885
15886 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15887 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15888 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15889 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15890 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15891 past failures.
15892
15893
15894 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15895 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15896 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15897 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15898 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15899 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15900 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15901 the default value.
15902
15903
15904 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15905 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15906 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15907 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15908 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15909 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15910 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15911 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15912 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15913 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15914
15915
15916 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15917 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15918
15919
15920 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15921 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15922 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15923 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15924 an item in the list.
15925 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15926 for the system.
15927
15928 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15929 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15930 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15931 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15932 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15933
15934
15935 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15936 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15937 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15938 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15939 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15940 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15941 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15942 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15943 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15944 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15945
15946
15947 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15948 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15949 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15950 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15951 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15952 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15953 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15954
15955
15956
15957 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15958 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15959 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15960 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15961 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15962 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15963 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15964 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15965 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15966 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15967 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15968
15969
15970
15971 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15972 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15973 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15974 .cindex "inetd"
15975 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15976 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15977 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15978 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15979 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15980 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15981
15982 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15983 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15984 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15985 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15986
15987
15988 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15989 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15990 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15991 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15992 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15993 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15994 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15995 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15996
15997 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15998 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15999 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16000 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16001 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16002 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16003 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16004 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16005
16006
16007 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16008 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16009 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16010 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16011 live with.
16012
16013
16014 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16015 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16016 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16017 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16018 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16019 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16020 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16021 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16022 . the option name to split.
16023
16024 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16025 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16026 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16027 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16028 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16029 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16030 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16031 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16032 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16033 seen).
16034
16035
16036 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16037 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16038 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16039 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16040 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16041 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16042 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16043 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16044 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16045 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16046 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16047
16048 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16049 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16050 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16051 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16052 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16053 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16054
16055
16056
16057 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16058 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16059 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16060 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16061 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16062 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16063 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16064 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16065 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16066 to all messages received in the same connection.
16067
16068 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16069 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16070 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16071 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16072
16073
16074 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16075
16076 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16077 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16078 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16079 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16080 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16081 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16082 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16083 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16084 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16085 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16086 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16087 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16088 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16089
16090
16091 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16092 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16093 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16094 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16095 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16096 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16097 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16098 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16099 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16100 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16101 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16102 individual host.
16103
16104 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16105 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16106 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16107 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16108
16109
16110 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16111 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16112 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16113 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16114 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16115 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16116 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16117 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16118 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16119
16120 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16121 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16122 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16123 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16124
16125 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16126 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16127 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16128 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16129 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16130 For example:
16131 .code
16132 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16133 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16134 .endd
16135
16136 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16137 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16138 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16139 &%helo_data%& value.
16140
16141 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16142 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16143 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16144 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16145 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16146 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16147 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16148 .code
16149 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16150 $version_number $tod_full
16151 .endd
16152 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16153 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16154 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16155 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16156 multiline response).
16157
16158
16159 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16160 .cindex "checking disk space"
16161 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16162 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16163 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16164 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16165 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16166 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16167 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16168
16169
16170 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16171 .cindex "connection backlog"
16172 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16173 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16174 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16175 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16176 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16177 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16178 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16179 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16180 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16181 attacks by SYN flooding.
16182
16183
16184 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16185 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16186 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16187 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16188 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16189 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16190 fewer, but they still exist.
16191
16192 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16193 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16194 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16195 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16196 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16197 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16198 does detect many instances.
16199
16200 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16201 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16202 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16203 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16204
16205
16206
16207 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16208 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16209 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16210 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16211 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16212 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16213 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16214 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16215 example:
16216 .code
16217 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16218 $sender_host_address
16219 .endd
16220 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16221 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16222 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16223 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16224 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16225 the command.
16226
16227
16228 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16229 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16230 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16231 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16232 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16233
16234
16235 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16236 .cindex "load average"
16237 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16238 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16239 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16240 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16241 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16242 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16243
16244
16245
16246 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16247 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16248 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16249 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16250 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16251 .code
16252 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16253 .endd
16254 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16255 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16256 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16257 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16258 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16259
16260 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16261 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16262 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16263 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16264 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16265 not count towards the limit.
16266
16267
16268
16269 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16270 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16271 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16272 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16273 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16274 that subvert web
16275 clients
16276 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16277 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16278
16279
16280
16281 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16282 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16283 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16284 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16285 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16286 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16287 recipients.
16288
16289 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16290 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16291 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16292 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16293
16294 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16295 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16296 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16297 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16298 values:
16299
16300 .ilist
16301 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16302 .next
16303 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16304 fractional parts are allowed here.
16305 .next
16306 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16307 .next
16308 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16309 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16310 .endlist
16311
16312 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16313 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16314 .code
16315 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16316 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16317 .endd
16318 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16319 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16320 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16321 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16322
16323
16324 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16325 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16326
16327
16328 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16329 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16330
16331
16332 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16333 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16334 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16335 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16336 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16337 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16338 the message is abandoned.
16339 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16340 .code
16341 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16342 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16343 .endd
16344 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16345 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16346
16347 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16348 expanded before use and may depend on
16349 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16350
16351
16352 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16353 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16354 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16355 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16356 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16357 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16358
16359
16360 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16361 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16362 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16363
16364
16365 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16366 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16367 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16368 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16369 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16370 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16371 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16372 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16373 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16374 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16375 .code
16376 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16377 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16378 .endd
16379
16380 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16381 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16382 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16383 The default value is
16384 .code
16385 127.0.0.1 783
16386 .endd
16387 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16388
16389
16390
16391 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16392 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16393 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16394 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16395 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16396 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16397 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16398 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16399 arrival of the message.
16400
16401 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16402 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16403 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16404 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16405 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16406
16407 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16408 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16409 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16410 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16411 automatically deleted.
16412
16413 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16414 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16415 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16416 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16417 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16418 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16419 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16420 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16421 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16422
16423
16424 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16425 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16426 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16427 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16428 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16429 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16430 &$primary_hostname$&.
16431
16432 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16433 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16434 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16435 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16436 as failures in the configuration file.
16437
16438 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16439 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16440
16441 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16442 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16443 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16444 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16445
16446 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16447 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16448 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16449 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16450 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16451 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16452
16453 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16454 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16455 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16456 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16457 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16458 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16459 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16460
16461
16462 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16463 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16464 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16465 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16466 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16467 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16468 domain causes a syntax error.
16469 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16470 syntax checking.
16471
16472
16473 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16474 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16475 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16476 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16477 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16478 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16479 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16480 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16481 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16482 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16483 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16484 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16485
16486
16487 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16488 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16489 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16490 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16491 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16492 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16493 details of Exim's logging.
16494
16495
16496
16497 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16498 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16499 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16500 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16501 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16502
16503
16504
16505 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16506 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16507 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16508 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16509 details of Exim's logging.
16510
16511
16512 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16513 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16514 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16515 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16516 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16517 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16518 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16519 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16520 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16521 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16522 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16523
16524
16525 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16526 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16527 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16528 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16529 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16530 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16531
16532
16533 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16534 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16535 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16536 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16537 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16538
16539 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16540 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16541 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16542 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16543 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16544
16545 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16546 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16547 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16548 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16549 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16550 contains the pipe command.
16551
16552
16553 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16554 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16555 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16556 is used in a system filter.
16557
16558
16559 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16560 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16561 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16562 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16563 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16564 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16565 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16566 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16567 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16568 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16569
16570 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16571 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16572 transport option overrides.
16573
16574
16575 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16576 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16577 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16578 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16579 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16580 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16581 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16582 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16583 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16584 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16585 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16586 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16587 TCP_NODELAY.
16588
16589
16590 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16591 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16592 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16593 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16594 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16595 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16596 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16597 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16598 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16599 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16600
16601 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16602 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16603 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16604
16605
16606 .option timezone main string unset
16607 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16608 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16609 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16610 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16611 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16612 .code
16613 timezone = UTC
16614 .endd
16615 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16616 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16617 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16618 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16619 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16620 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16621
16622
16623 .new
16624 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16625 .wen
16626 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16627 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16628 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16629 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16630 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16631 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16632 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16633 .new
16634 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
16635 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If no certificate is available then
16636 the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
16637 .wen
16638
16639
16640 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16641 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16642 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16643 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16644 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16645 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16646 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16647
16648 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16649 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16650 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16651 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16652
16653 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16654 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16655 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16656 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16657
16658 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16659 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16660 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16661 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16662 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16663
16664 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16665
16666
16667 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16668 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16669 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16670 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16671 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16672 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16673
16674 The value must be at least 1024.
16675
16676 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16677 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16678 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16679
16680 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16681 number.
16682
16683 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16684 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16685 larger prime than requested.
16686
16687
16688 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16689 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16690 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16691 to be used by Exim.
16692
16693 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16694 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16695 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16696 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16697 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16698 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16699 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16700
16701 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16702 loaded by Exim.
16703
16704 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16705 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16706 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16707 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16708
16709 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16710 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16711 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16712 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16713
16714 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16715 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16716 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16717 "ike23".
16718
16719 The available primes are:
16720 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16721 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16722 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16723
16724 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16725 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16726
16727 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16728 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16729 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16730 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16731 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16732 userbase.
16733
16734 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16735 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16736 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16737 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16738 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16739 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16740 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16741
16742
16743 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16744 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16745 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16746 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16747
16748 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16749 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16750 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16751 which tell the library to choose.
16752
16753 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16754
16755
16756 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16757 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16758 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16759 This option
16760 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16761 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16762 Certificate Authority.
16763
16764 .new
16765 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
16766 .wen
16767
16768
16769 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16770 .cindex SSMTP
16771 .cindex SMTPS
16772 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16773 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16774 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16775 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16776
16777
16778
16779 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16780 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16781 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16782 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16783 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16784 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16785 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16786
16787 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16788
16789
16790 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16791 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16792 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16793 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16794 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16795 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16796 TLS session.
16797
16798
16799 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16800 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16801 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16802 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16803 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16804 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16805 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16806 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16807 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16808 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16809 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16810
16811
16812 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16813 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16814 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16815 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16816
16817
16818 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16819 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16820 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16821 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16822 word "system"
16823 or the absolute path to
16824 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16825 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16826
16827 The "system" value for the option will use a
16828 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16829 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16830 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16831 must be specified.
16832
16833 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
16834 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16835
16836 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16837 explicitly
16838 either by file or directory
16839 are added to those given by the system default location.
16840
16841 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16842 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16843 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16844 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16845 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16846 use the explicit directory version.
16847
16848 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16849
16850 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16851 being unset.
16852
16853
16854 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16855 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16856 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16857 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16858 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16859 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16860 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16861 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16862
16863 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16864 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16865 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16866 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16867 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16868 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16869 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16870
16871 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16872 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16873 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16874 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16875 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16876 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16877 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16878 certificate"&.
16879
16880 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16881 certificates.
16882
16883
16884 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16885 .cindex "trusted groups"
16886 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16887 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16888 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16889 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16890 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16891 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16892 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16893 are trusted.
16894
16895 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16896 .cindex "trusted users"
16897 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16898 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16899 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16900 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16901 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16902 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16903 Exim user are trusted.
16904
16905 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16906 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16907 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16908 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16909 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16910 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16911 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16912 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16913 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16914 &%-F%& option.
16915
16916 .option unknown_username main string unset
16917 See &%unknown_login%&.
16918
16919 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16920 .cindex "trusted users"
16921 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16922 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16923 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16924 .cindex "envelope sender"
16925 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16926 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16927 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16928 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16929 is used) is ignored.
16930
16931 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16932 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16933 .code
16934 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16935 .endd
16936 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16937 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16938 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16939 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16940 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16941 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16942 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16943 followed by a hyphen
16944 by a setting like this:
16945 .code
16946 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16947 .endd
16948 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16949 restriction, you can use
16950 .code
16951 untrusted_set_sender = *
16952 .endd
16953 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16954 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16955 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16956 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16957 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16958 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16959 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16960 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16961
16962 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16963 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16964 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16965 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16966 sender address.
16967
16968
16969 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16970 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16971 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16972 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16973 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16974 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16975 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16976 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16977 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16978 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16979 .code
16980 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16981 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16982 .endd
16983 The pattern can be seen by running
16984 .code
16985 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16986 .endd
16987 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16988 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16989 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16990 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16991 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16992 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16993
16994
16995 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16996 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16997
16998
16999 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17000 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17001 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17002 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17003 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17004 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17005 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17006 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17007
17008
17009 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17010 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17011 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17012 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17013 .ecindex IIDconfima
17014 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17015
17016
17017
17018
17019 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17020 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17021
17022 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17023 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17024 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17025 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17026 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17027
17028 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17029 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17030 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17031 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17032 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17033
17034
17035
17036 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17037 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17038 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17039 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17040 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17041 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17042 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17043
17044 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17045 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17046 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17047 routers, and the eventual transport.
17048
17049 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17050 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17051 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17052 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17053 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17054
17055 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17056 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17057 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17058 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17059 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17060
17061 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17062 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17063 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17064 .code
17065 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17066 .endd
17067 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17068 .code
17069 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17070 .endd
17071 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17072 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17073
17074 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17075 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17076 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17077 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17078 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17079 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17080 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17081
17082
17083
17084 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17085 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17086 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17087 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17088 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17089 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17090 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17091 routing.
17092
17093
17094
17095 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17096 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17097 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17098 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17099 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17100 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17101 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17102 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17103 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17104 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17105 you could put:
17106 .code
17107 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17108 .endd
17109 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17110 and
17111 .code
17112 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17113 .endd
17114 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17115 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17116 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17117 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17118
17119
17120 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17121 .cindex "case of local parts"
17122 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17123 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17124 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17125 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17126 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17127 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17128 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17129 more details.
17130
17131 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17132 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17133 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17134 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17135 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17136 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17137 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17138 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17139 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17140
17141 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17142 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17143 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17144 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17145
17146
17147
17148 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17149 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17150 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17151 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17152 .vindex "&$home$&"
17153 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17154 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17155 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17156 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17157 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17158 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17159 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17160 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17161 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17162 the router is skipped.
17163
17164 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17165 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17166 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17167 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17168 setting to achieve this. For example:
17169 .code
17170 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17171 .endd
17172 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17173 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17174 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17175
17176
17177
17178 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17179 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17180 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17181 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17182 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17183 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17184 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17185 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17186
17187 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17188 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17189
17190 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17191 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17192
17193 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17194 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17195 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17196 .code
17197 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17198 .endd
17199 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17200 .code
17201 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17202 .endd
17203
17204 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17205 .code
17206 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17207 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17208 condition = foobar
17209 .endd
17210
17211 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17212 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17213 be specified using &%condition%&.
17214
17215 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17216 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17217 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17218 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17219 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17220 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17221 Router rules processing behavior.
17222
17223 This is best illustrated in an example:
17224 .code
17225 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17226 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17227
17228 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17229 true {yes} {no}}
17230
17231 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17232 {yes} {no}}
17233 .endd
17234 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17235 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17236 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17237 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17238 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17239 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17240 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17241 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17242
17243 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17244 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17245 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17246 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17247 string characters.
17248
17249 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17250 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17251 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17252 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17253 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17254
17255
17256 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17257 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17258 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17259 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17260 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17261 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17262 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17263 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17264 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17265 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17266 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17267 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17268 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17269 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17270
17271
17272
17273 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17274 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17275 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17276 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17277 transport option of the same name.
17278
17279 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17280 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17281 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17282 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17283 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17284 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17285 the dnssec request bit set.
17286 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17287
17288 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17289 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17290 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17291 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17292 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17293 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17294 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17295 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17296 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17297
17298
17299 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17300 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17301 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17302 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17303 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17304 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17305 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17306 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17307
17308
17309
17310 .option driver routers string unset
17311 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17312 to be used.
17313
17314
17315 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17316 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17317 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17318 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17319 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17320 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17321 Not effective on redirect routers.
17322
17323
17324
17325 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17326 .cindex "envelope sender"
17327 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17328 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17329 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17330 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17331 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17332 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17333 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17334
17335 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17336 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17337 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17338 setting.
17339
17340 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17341 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17342 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17343 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17344
17345 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17346 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17347 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17348 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17349 settings:
17350 .code
17351 errors_to =
17352 errors_to = ""
17353 .endd
17354 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17355 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17356 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17357 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17358 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17359
17360 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17361 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17362 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17363 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17364 setting &%return_path%&.
17365
17366 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17367 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17368 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17369
17370
17371
17372 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17373 .cindex "address" "testing"
17374 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17375 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17376 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17377 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17378 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17379 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17380 on for the system alias file.
17381 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17382 are evaluated.
17383
17384 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17385 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17386 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17387
17388
17389
17390 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17391 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17392 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17393 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17394
17395
17396
17397 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17398 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17399 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17400
17401
17402
17403 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17404 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17405 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17406
17407
17408
17409 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17410 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17411 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17412 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17413 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17414 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17415 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17416 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17417 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17418
17419 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17420 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17421 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17422 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17423 transport for further details.
17424
17425
17426 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17427 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17428 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17429 .cindex "transport" "local"
17430 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17431 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17432 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17433 process.
17434 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17435 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17436 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17437 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17438 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17439
17440
17441
17442 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17443 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17444 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17445 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17446 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17447 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17448 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17449 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17450 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17451 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17452 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17453 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17454 &"see"& the added header lines.
17455
17456 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17457 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17458 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17459 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17460
17461 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17462 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17463
17464 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17465 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17466
17467 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17468 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17469 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17470 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17471 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17472 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17473 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17474 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17475 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17476 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17477
17478
17479
17480 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17481 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17482 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17483 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17484 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17485 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17486 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17487 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17488 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17489 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17490 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17491 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17492 &"see"& the original header lines.
17493
17494 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17495 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17496 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17497 errors.
17498
17499 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17500 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17501
17502 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17503 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17504
17505 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17506 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17507 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17508 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17509
17510 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17511 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17512 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17513
17514
17515
17516 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17517 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17518 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17519 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17520 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17521 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17522 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17523 like
17524 .code
17525 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17526 .endd
17527 by setting
17528 .code
17529 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17530 .endd
17531 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17532 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17533 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17534 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17535 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17536 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17537
17538 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17539 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17540 .code
17541 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17542 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17543 .endd
17544 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17545 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17546
17547 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17548 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17549 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17550 domain that is being routed.
17551
17552 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17553 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17554 checked.
17555
17556 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17557 .cindex "additional groups"
17558 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17559 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17560 .cindex "transport" "local"
17561 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17562 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17563 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17564 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17565 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17566
17567
17568
17569 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17570 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17571 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17572 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17573 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17574 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17575 evaluated.
17576
17577 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17578 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17579 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17580 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17581 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17582 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17583 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17584 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17585 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17586
17587 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17588 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17589 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17590 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17591 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17592 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17593 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17594 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17595 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17596 the relevant transport.
17597
17598 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17599 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17600 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17601 callout.
17602
17603 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17604 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17605 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17606 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17607 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17608 .code
17609 real_localuser:
17610 driver = accept
17611 local_part_prefix = real-
17612 check_local_user
17613 transport = local_delivery
17614 .endd
17615 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17616 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17617 .code
17618 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17619 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17620 .endd
17621
17622 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17623 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17624 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17625 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17626
17627
17628 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17629 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17630
17631
17632
17633 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17634 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17635 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17636 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17637 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17638 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17639 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17640 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17641 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17642 &%username-foo%&.
17643
17644
17645 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17646 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17647
17648
17649
17650 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17651 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17652 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17653 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17654 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17655 are evaluated, and
17656 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17657 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17658 example:
17659 .code
17660 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17661 .endd
17662 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17663 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17664 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17665 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17666 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17667 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17668 each virtual domain:
17669 .code
17670 postmaster:
17671 driver = redirect
17672 local_parts = postmaster
17673 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17674 .endd
17675
17676
17677 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17678 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17679 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17680 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17681 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17682 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17683 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17684 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17685 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17686 redirect addresses.
17687
17688
17689
17690 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17691 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17692 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17693 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17694 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17695 delivery to be deferred.
17696
17697 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17698 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17699 .oindex "&%self%&"
17700 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17701 means of the setting
17702 .code
17703 self = pass
17704 .endd
17705 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17706 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17707 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17708
17709 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17710 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17711 controls what happens next.
17712
17713
17714 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17715 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17716 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17717 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17718 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17719 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17720 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17721 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17722
17723 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17724 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17725 applies to all of them.
17726
17727
17728
17729 .option pass_router routers string unset
17730 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17731 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17732 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17733 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17734 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17735 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17736 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17737 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17738 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17739 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17740
17741
17742
17743 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17744 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17745 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17746 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17747 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17748 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17749
17750 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17751 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17752 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17753 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17754
17755
17756
17757 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17758 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17759 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17760 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17761 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17762 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17763 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17764
17765 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17766 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17767 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17768 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17769
17770 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17771 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17772 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17773 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17774 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17775
17776 .cindex "NFS"
17777 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17778 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17779 unavailable.
17780
17781 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17782 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17783 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17784 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17785 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17786 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17787 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17788 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17789
17790 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17791 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17792 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17793 operates as follows:
17794
17795 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17796 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17797 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17798 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17799 used. For example:
17800 .code
17801 require_files = mail:/some/file
17802 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17803 .endd
17804 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17805 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17806
17807 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17808 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17809 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17810 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17811
17812 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17813 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17814 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17815 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17816 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17817
17818 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17819 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17820 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17821 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17822 check again in that process.
17823
17824 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17825 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17826 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17827 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17828 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17829 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17830 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17831 .code
17832 require_files = +/some/file
17833 .endd
17834 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17835 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17836 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17837
17838
17839
17840 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17841 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17842 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17843 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17844 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17845 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17846 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17847 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17848 latter kind.
17849
17850 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17851 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17852 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17853 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17854 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17855 same name.
17856
17857 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17858 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17859 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17860
17861
17862
17863 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17864 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17865 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17866 .vindex "&$home$&"
17867 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17868 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17869 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17870 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17871 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17872 cause the router to defer.
17873
17874 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17875 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17876 place.
17877 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17878 are evaluated.)
17879 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17880 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17881
17882 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17883 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17884 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17885 of these values that is set:
17886
17887 .ilist
17888 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17889 .next
17890 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17891 .next
17892 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17893 .next
17894 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17895 .endlist
17896
17897 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17898 router, but not for the transport.
17899
17900
17901
17902 .option self routers string freeze
17903 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17904 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17905 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17906 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17907 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17908 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17909 of remote hosts.
17910 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17911 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17912 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17913 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17914 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17915
17916 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17917 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17918 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17919 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17920 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17921 cases:
17922
17923 .vlist
17924 .vitem &%defer%&
17925 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17926
17927 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17928 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17929 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17930 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17931
17932 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17933 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17934 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17935 rewritten.
17936
17937 .vitem &%pass%&
17938 .oindex "&%more%&"
17939 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17940 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17941 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17942 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17943 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17944 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17945 combination
17946 .code
17947 self = pass
17948 no_more
17949 .endd
17950 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17951 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17952 be passed to the next router.
17953
17954 .vitem &%fail%&
17955 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17956
17957 .vitem &%send%&
17958 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17959 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17960 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17961 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17962 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17963 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17964 .endlist
17965
17966
17967
17968 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17969 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17970 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17971 address matches something on the list.
17972 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17973 are evaluated.
17974
17975 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17976 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17977 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17978 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17979 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17980 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17981 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17982 matters.
17983
17984
17985 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17986 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17987 .cindex "packet radio"
17988 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17989 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17990 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17991 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17992 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17993 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17994 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17995 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17996
17997 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17998 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17999 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18000 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18001 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18002 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18003 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18004 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18005 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18006 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18007 .code
18008 translate_ip_address = \
18009 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18010 {$value}fail}}
18011 .endd
18012 The file would contain lines like
18013 .code
18014 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18015 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18016 .endd
18017 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18018 are doing.
18019
18020
18021
18022 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18023 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18024 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18025 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18026 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18027 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18028 delivery is deferred.
18029
18030 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18031 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18032 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18033
18034
18035
18036 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18037 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18038 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18039 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18040 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18041 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18042 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18043 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18044 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18045 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18046 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18047 environment.
18048
18049
18050
18051
18052 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18053 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18054 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18055 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18056 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18057 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18058 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18059 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18060 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18061 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18062
18063 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18064 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18065 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18066 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18067 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18068
18069 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18070 environment.
18071
18072
18073
18074
18075 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18076 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18077 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18078 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18079 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18080 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18081 delivery to be deferred.
18082
18083 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18084 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18085 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18086 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18087 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18088 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18089
18090 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18091 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18092 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18093 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18094 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18095 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18096 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18097 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18098
18099 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18100 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18101 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18102 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18103 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18104 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18105 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18106 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18107 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18108 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18109
18110 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18111 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18112 subsequent routers.
18113
18114
18115 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18116 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18117 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18118 .cindex "transport" "local"
18119 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18120 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18121 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18122 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18123 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18124 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18125 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18126 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18127 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18128 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18129 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18130 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18131
18132
18133
18134 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18135 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18136 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18137
18138
18139 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18140 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18141 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18142 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18143 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18144 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18145 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18146 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18147 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18148 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18149
18150 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18151 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18152 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18153 user or group.
18154
18155
18156 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18157 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18158 addresses,
18159 delivering in cutthrough mode
18160 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18161 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18162 are evaluated.
18163 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18164
18165
18166 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18167 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18168 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18169 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18170 are evaluated.
18171 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18172 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18173 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18174
18175
18176
18177
18178
18179
18180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18182
18183 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18184 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18185 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18186 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18187 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18188 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18189 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18190 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18191 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18192 .code
18193 localusers:
18194 driver = accept
18195 domains = mydomain.example
18196 check_local_user
18197 transport = local_delivery
18198 .endd
18199 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18200 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18201 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18202 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18203
18204
18205
18206
18207
18208
18209 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18210 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18211
18212 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18213 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18214 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18215 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18216 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18217 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18218
18219 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18220 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18221 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18222 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18223 records.
18224
18225 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18226 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18227 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18228 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18229 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18230 generic option, the router declines.
18231
18232 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18233 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18234 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18235
18236 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18237 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18238 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18239 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18240 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18241 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18242
18243
18244 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18245 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18246 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18247 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18248 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18249 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18250
18251 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18252 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18253 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18254 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18255 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18256 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18257 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18258 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18259 case routing fails.
18260
18261
18262 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18263 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18264 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18265 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18266 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18267
18268 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18269 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18270
18271 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18272 .ilist
18273 The domain does not exist in DNS
18274 .next
18275 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18276 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18277 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18278 .next
18279 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18280 .next
18281 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18282 .next
18283 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18284 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18285 .next
18286 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18287 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18288 .next
18289 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18290 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18291 .next
18292 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18293 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18294 .endlist
18295
18296
18297
18298
18299 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18300 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18301 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18302
18303 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18304 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18305 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18306 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18307 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18308 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18309 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18310
18311
18312 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18313 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18314 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18315 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18316 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18317 required. For example,
18318 .code
18319 check_srv = smtp
18320 .endd
18321 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18322 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18323 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18324 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18325 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18326 normal way.
18327
18328 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18329 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18330 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18331 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18332 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18333 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18334
18335 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18336 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18337 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18338 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18339 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18340 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18341 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18342 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18343
18344 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18345 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18346
18347
18348
18349
18350 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18351 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18352 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18353 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18354 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18355 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18356 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18357 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18358 also being queued.
18359
18360
18361 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18362 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18363 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18364 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18365 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18366 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18367 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18368 setting:
18369 .code
18370 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18371 .endd
18372 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18373 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18374 the address record.
18375
18376
18377 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18378 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18379 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18380 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18381
18382
18383
18384
18385 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18386 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18387 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18388 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18389 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18390 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18391 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18392 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18393 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18394 &'resolv.conf'&.
18395
18396
18397
18398 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18399 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18400 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18401 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18402 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18403 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18404 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18405 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18406 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18407 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18408 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18409
18410 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18411 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18412 sense.
18413
18414 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18415 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18416 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18417 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18418 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18419 header rewriting.
18420
18421
18422 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18423 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18424 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18425 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18426 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18427 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18428 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18429 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18430
18431 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18432 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18433 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18434 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18435 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18436 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18437 without processing them independently,
18438 provided the following conditions are met:
18439
18440 .ilist
18441 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18442 &%headers_remove%&.
18443 .next
18444 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18445 the domain.
18446 .endlist
18447
18448
18449
18450
18451 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18452 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18453 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18454 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18455 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18456 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18457 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18458 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18459 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18460 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18461
18462 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18463 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18464 local wildcard.
18465
18466
18467
18468 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18469 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18470 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18471 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18472
18473
18474
18475
18476 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18477 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18478 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18479 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18480 if
18481 .code
18482 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18483 .endd
18484 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18485 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18486 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18487 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18488 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18489 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18490
18491
18492 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18493 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18494 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18495 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18496 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18497
18498 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18499 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18500 such as that implied by
18501 .code
18502 domains = @mx_any
18503 .endd
18504 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18505 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18506 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18507 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18508
18509
18510
18511
18512
18513
18514
18515
18516
18517 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18518 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18519
18520 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18521 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18522 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18523 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18524 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18525 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18526 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18527 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18528 router handles the address
18529 .code
18530 root@[192.168.1.1]
18531 .endd
18532 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18533 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18534 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18535 .code
18536 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18537 .endd
18538 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18539 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18540
18541 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18542 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18543 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18544 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18545
18546 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18547 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18548 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18549 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18550
18551
18552
18553 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18555
18556 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18557 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18558 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18559 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18560 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18561 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18562 must set
18563 .code
18564 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18565 .endd
18566 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18567
18568 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18569 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18570 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18571 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18572 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18573 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18574 must not be specified for it.
18575
18576 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18577 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18578 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18579 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18580 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18581 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18582 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18583
18584
18585 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18586 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18587 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18588 delivery to the address is deferred.
18589
18590
18591 .option port iplookup integer 0
18592 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18593 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18594 call.
18595
18596
18597 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18598 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18599 protocols is to be used.
18600
18601
18602 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18603 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18604 default value is:
18605 .code
18606 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18607 .endd
18608 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18609 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18610
18611
18612 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18613 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18614 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18615 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18616 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18617 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18618 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18619 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18620
18621
18622 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18623 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18624 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18625 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18626 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18627 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18628 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18629 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18630 following could be used:
18631 .code
18632 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18633 reroute = $local_part@$1
18634 .endd
18635
18636 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18637 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18638 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18639 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18640
18641
18642
18643
18644 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18646
18647 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18648 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18649 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18650 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18651 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18652 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18653 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18654 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18655 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18656 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18657
18658 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18659 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18660 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18661 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18662 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18663 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18664 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18665
18666 .vindex "&$host$&"
18667 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18668 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18669 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18670 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18671 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18672 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18673 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18674 text string.
18675
18676 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18677 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18678 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18679 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18680 below, following the list of private options.
18681
18682
18683 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18684
18685 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18686 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18687
18688 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18689 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18690
18691 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18692 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18693 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18694 of the following values:
18695 .code
18696 decline
18697 defer
18698 fail
18699 freeze
18700 ignore
18701 pass
18702 .endd
18703 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18704 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18705 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18706 &%pass_router%&),
18707 .oindex "&%more%&"
18708 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18709 router only if &%more%& is true.
18710
18711 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18712 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18713 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18714 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18715
18716 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18717 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18718 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18719
18720
18721 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18722 .cindex "randomized host list"
18723 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18724 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18725 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18726 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18727 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18728 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18729 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18730 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18731
18732 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18733 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18734 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18735 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18736 .code
18737 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18738 .endd
18739 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18740 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18741 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18742 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18743 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18744
18745
18746 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18747 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18748 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18749 example:
18750 .code
18751 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18752 .endd
18753 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18754 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18755 deferred.
18756
18757
18758 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18759 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18760 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18761 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18762
18763
18764 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18765 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18766 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18767 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18768 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18769 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18770 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18771 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18772
18773 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18774 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18775 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18776 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18777 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18778 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18779 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18780 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18781
18782
18783
18784
18785 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18786 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18787 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18788 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18789 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18790 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18791 .display
18792 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18793 .endd
18794 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18795 no options:
18796 .code
18797 route_list = \
18798 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18799 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18800 .endd
18801 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18802 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18803 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18804 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18805 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18806 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18807 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18808 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18809 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18810 in a &%route_list%&).
18811
18812 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18813 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18814 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18815 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18816
18817
18818
18819 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18820 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18821 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18822 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18823 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18824 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18825 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18826 like this:
18827 .code
18828 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18829 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18830 .endd
18831 This data can be accessed by setting
18832 .code
18833 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18834 .endd
18835 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18836 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18837 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18838 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18839 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18840
18841
18842
18843
18844 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18845 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18846 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18847 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18848 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18849 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18850 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18851
18852 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18853 variables are set during its expansion:
18854
18855 .ilist
18856 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18857 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18858 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18859 .code
18860 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18861 .endd
18862 .next
18863 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18864 .next
18865 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18866
18867 .next
18868 .vindex "&$value$&"
18869 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18870 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18871 .code
18872 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18873 .endd
18874 .endlist
18875
18876 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18877 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18878
18879
18880
18881 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18882 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18883 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18884 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18885 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18886 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18887
18888 .ilist
18889 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18890 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18891 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18892 .code
18893 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18894 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18895 .endd
18896 .next
18897 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18898 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18899 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18900 number follows. For example:
18901 .code
18902 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18903 .endd
18904 .endlist
18905
18906 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18907 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18908 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18909 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18910 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18911 transport.
18912
18913 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18914 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18915 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18916 records in the DNS. For example:
18917 .code
18918 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18919 .endd
18920 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18921 example:
18922 .code
18923 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18924 .endd
18925 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18926 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18927 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18928 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18929 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18930 happens is controlled by the
18931 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18932 &%self%& option of the router.
18933
18934 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18935 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18936 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18937 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18938 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18939 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18940 defined by MX preferences.
18941
18942 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18943 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18944 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18945
18946 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18947 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18948 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18949 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18950
18951 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18952 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18953 router.
18954
18955 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18956 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18957 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18958
18959 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18960 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18961
18962
18963
18964 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18965 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18966 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18967 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18968 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18969 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18970 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18971
18972 .ilist
18973 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18974 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18975 .next
18976 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18977 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18978 .next
18979 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18980 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18981 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18982 .next
18983 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18984 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18985 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18986 .endlist
18987
18988 For example:
18989 .code
18990 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18991 domain2 host4:host5
18992 .endd
18993 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18994 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18995 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18996 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18997 call.
18998
18999 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19000 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19001 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19002 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19003 function called.
19004
19005
19006
19007 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19008 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19009
19010 .vindex "&$host$&"
19011 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19012 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19013
19014
19015
19016 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19017 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19018 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19019
19020 .ilist
19021 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19022 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19023 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19024 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19025 .code
19026 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19027 .endd
19028 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19029 your first router something like this:
19030 .code
19031 smart_route:
19032 driver = manualroute
19033 domains = !+local_domains
19034 transport = remote_smtp
19035 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19036 .endd
19037 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19038 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19039 they are tried in order
19040 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19041 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19042 .code
19043 smart_route:
19044 driver = manualroute
19045 transport = remote_smtp
19046 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19047 .endd
19048 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19049 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19050 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19051 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19052 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19053 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19054 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19055 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19056
19057 .next
19058 .cindex "mail hub example"
19059 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19060 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19061 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19062 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19063 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19064 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19065 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19066 lookup is easier to manage.
19067
19068 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19069 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19070 example:
19071 .code
19072 hub_route:
19073 driver = manualroute
19074 transport = remote_smtp
19075 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19076 .endd
19077 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19078 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19079 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19080 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19081 domain can be used to find the host:
19082 .code
19083 through_firewall:
19084 driver = manualroute
19085 transport = remote_smtp
19086 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19087 .endd
19088 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19089 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19090 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19091 next router.
19092
19093 .next
19094 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19095 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19096 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19097 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19098 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19099 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19100 .code
19101 save_in_file:
19102 driver = manualroute
19103 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19104 route_list = saved.domain.example
19105 .endd
19106 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19107 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19108 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19109 .code
19110 save_in_file:
19111 driver = manualroute
19112 route_list = \
19113 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19114 *.saved.domain2.example \
19115 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19116 batch_pipe
19117 .endd
19118 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19119 .vindex "&$host$&"
19120 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19121 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19122 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19123 the address if the lookup fails.
19124
19125 .next
19126 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19127 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19128 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19129 one way it can be done:
19130 .code
19131 # Transport
19132 uucp:
19133 driver = pipe
19134 user = nobody
19135 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19136 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19137 return_fail_output = true
19138
19139 # Router
19140 uucphost:
19141 transport = uucp
19142 driver = manualroute
19143 route_data = \
19144 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19145 .endd
19146 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19147 .code
19148 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19149 .endd
19150 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19151 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19152 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19153 .endlist
19154 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19155 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19156
19157
19158
19159
19160
19161
19162
19163
19164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19166
19167 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19168 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19169 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19170 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19171 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19172 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19173 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19174 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19175 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19176 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19177 options:
19178 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19179
19180 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19181 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19182 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19183 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19184 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19185
19186
19187 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19188 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19189 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19190 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19191 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19192 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19193
19194
19195 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19196 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19197 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19198 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19199 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19200 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19201 not set, a value for the gid also.
19202
19203 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19204 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19205 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19206 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19207 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19208 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19209 gid.
19210
19211
19212 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19213 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19214 before running the command.
19215
19216
19217 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19218 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19219 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19220 timeout.
19221
19222
19223 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19224 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19225 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19226 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19227 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19228
19229 .ilist
19230 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19231 below).
19232 .next
19233 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19234 &%no_more%& is set.
19235 .next
19236 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19237 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19238 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19239 included in the SMTP response.
19240 .next
19241 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19242 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19243 included in any SMTP response.
19244 .next
19245 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19246 .next
19247 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19248 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19249 .next
19250 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19251 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19252 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19253 .endlist
19254
19255 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19256 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19257 the page):
19258 .code
19259 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19260 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19261 .endd
19262 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19263 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19264 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19265 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19266
19267 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19268 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19269 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19270 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19271 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19272
19273 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19274 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19275 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19276 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19277 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19278
19279 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19280 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19281 variable. For example, this return line
19282 .code
19283 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19284 .endd
19285 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19286 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19287 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19288 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19289
19290
19291
19292
19293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19294 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19295
19296 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19297 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19298 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19299 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19300 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19301 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19302 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19303 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19304 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19305 redirected in several different ways:
19306
19307 .ilist
19308 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19309 independently.
19310 .next
19311 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19312 .next
19313 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19314 .next
19315 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19316 .next
19317 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19318 .next
19319 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19320 .next
19321 It can be discarded.
19322 .endlist
19323
19324 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19325 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19326 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19327 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19328
19329 If success DSNs have been requested
19330 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19331 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19332 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19333
19334
19335
19336 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19337 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19338 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19339 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19340 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19341 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19342 .code
19343 system_aliases:
19344 driver = redirect
19345 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19346 .endd
19347 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19348 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19349 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19350 cause delivery to be deferred.
19351
19352 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19353 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19354 .code
19355 userforward:
19356 driver = redirect
19357 check_local_user
19358 file = $home/.forward
19359 no_verify
19360 .endd
19361 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19362 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19363 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19364 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19365 comments.
19366
19367
19368
19369 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19370 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19371 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19372 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19373
19374 .ilist
19375 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19376 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19377 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19378 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19379 .next
19380 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19381 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19382 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19383 saves some resources.
19384 .endlist
19385
19386
19387
19388
19389
19390
19391 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19392 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19393 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19394 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19395 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19396
19397 .ilist
19398 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19399 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19400 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19401 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19402 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19403 document is intended for use by end users.
19404 .next
19405 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19406 described in the next section.
19407 .endlist
19408
19409 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19410 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19411 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19412 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19413 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19414
19415
19416
19417 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19418 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19419 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19420 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19421 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19422 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19423 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19424 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19425 commas or newlines.
19426 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19427 quotes.
19428
19429 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19430 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19431 next newline character is ignored.
19432
19433 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19434 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19435 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19436 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19437 removed.
19438
19439 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19440 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19441 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19442 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19443 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19444 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19445 setting:
19446 .code
19447 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19448 .endd
19449
19450
19451 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19452 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19453 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19454 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19455 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19456 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19457 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19458 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19459 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19460 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19461 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19462
19463 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19464 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19465 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19466 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19467 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19468 .code
19469 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19470 .endd
19471 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19472 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19473 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19474 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19475 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19476 synonymously.
19477
19478 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19479 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19480 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19481 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19482 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19483
19484 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19485 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19486 contains:
19487 .code
19488 Sam.Reman: spqr
19489 .endd
19490 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19491 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19492 this forward file:
19493 .code
19494 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19495 .endd
19496 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19497 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19498 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19499 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19500 should really contain
19501 .code
19502 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19503 .endd
19504 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19505 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19506 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19507
19508
19509
19510 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19511 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19512 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19513
19514 .ilist
19515 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19516 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19517 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19518 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19519 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19520 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19521 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19522
19523 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19524 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19525 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19526 in double quotes, for example:
19527 .code
19528 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19529 .endd
19530 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19531 quote just the command. An item such as
19532 .code
19533 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19534 .endd
19535 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19536
19537 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19538 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19539 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19540 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19541 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19542 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19543 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19544 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19545 an &%accept%& router.
19546
19547 .next
19548 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19549 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19550 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19551 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19552 .code
19553 /home/world/minbari
19554 .endd
19555 is treated as a file name, but
19556 .code
19557 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19558 .endd
19559 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19560 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19561 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19562 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19563
19564 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19565 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19566
19567 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19568 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19569 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19570 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19571
19572 .next
19573 .cindex "included address list"
19574 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19575 If an item is of the form
19576 .code
19577 :include:<path name>
19578 .endd
19579 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19580 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19581 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19582 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19583 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19584 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19585 .code
19586 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19587 .endd
19588 It must be given as
19589 .code
19590 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19591 .endd
19592 .next
19593 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19594 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19595 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19596 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19597 .cindex "black hole"
19598 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19599 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19600 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19601 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19602
19603 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19604 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19605 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19606 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19607 &_/dev/null_&.
19608
19609 .next
19610 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19611 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19612 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19613 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19614 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19615 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19616 redirection items of the form
19617 .code
19618 :defer:
19619 :fail:
19620 .endd
19621 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19622 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19623 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19624 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19625 .code
19626 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19627 .endd
19628 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19629 of a
19630 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19631 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19632 default.
19633 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19634 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19635 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19636
19637 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19638 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19639 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19640 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19641 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19642 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19643 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19644 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19645 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19646 ignored.
19647
19648 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19649 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19650 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19651 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19652
19653 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19654 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19655 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19656 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19657 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19658
19659 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19660 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19661 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19662 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19663 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19664 rules still apply.
19665
19666 .next
19667 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19668 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19669 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19670 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19671 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19672 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19673 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19674 .endlist
19675
19676
19677 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19678 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19679 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19680 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19681 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19682 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19683 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19684 aliasing scheme of the type
19685 .code
19686 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19687 localpart1: pipe
19688 localpart2: pipe
19689 .endd
19690 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19691 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19692 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19693 such as
19694 .code
19695 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19696 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19697 .endd
19698 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19699 the pipes are distinct.
19700
19701
19702
19703 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19704 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19705 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19706 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19707 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19708 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19709 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19710 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19711 can be used to avoid this.
19712
19713
19714 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19715 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19716 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19717 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19718 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19719 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19720 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19721
19722
19723
19724 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19725
19726 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19727 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19728
19729
19730 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19731 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19732 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19733
19734
19735 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19736 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19737 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19738 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19739
19740
19741 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19742 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19743 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19744 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19745 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19746 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19747 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19748
19749 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19750 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19751
19752
19753 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19754 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19755 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19756 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19757 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19758
19759
19760
19761 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19762 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19763 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19764 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19765 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19766 let ordinary users do.
19767
19768
19769
19770 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19771 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19772 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19773 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19774 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19775 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19776
19777 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19778 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19779 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19780 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19781 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19782 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19783 .code
19784 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19785 .endd
19786 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19787 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19788 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19789 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19790 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19791 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19792 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19793 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19794
19795
19796 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19797 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19798 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19799 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19800 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19801 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19802 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19803 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19804
19805
19806
19807 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19808 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19809 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19810 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19811 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19812 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19813
19814
19815 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19816 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19817 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19818 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19819 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19820 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19821
19822 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19823 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19824 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19825 .code
19826 data = #Exim filter\n\
19827 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19828 .endd
19829 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19830 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19831 choice into a newline.
19832
19833
19834 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19835 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19836 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19837 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19838 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19839
19840
19841 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19842 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19843 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19844 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19845 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19846 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19847 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19848 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19849
19850 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19851 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19852 runs a check on the containing directory,
19853 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19854 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19855 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19856 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19857 not, the router declines.
19858
19859
19860 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19861 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19862 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19863 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19864 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19865 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19866 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19867
19868
19869 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19870 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19871 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19872 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19873 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19874
19875
19876 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19877 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19878 redirection list.
19879
19880
19881 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19882 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19883 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19884
19885
19886
19887
19888 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19889 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19890 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19891 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19892 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19893 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19894 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19895 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19896 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19897
19898
19899 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19900 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19901 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19902 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19903 functions.
19904
19905 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19906 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19907 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19908 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19909
19910 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19911 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19912 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19913 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19914 &_.forward_& files).
19915
19916
19917 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19918 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19919 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19920
19921
19922 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19923 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19924 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19925 of the embedded Perl support.
19926
19927
19928 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19929 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19930 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19931
19932
19933 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19934 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19935 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19936
19937
19938 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19939 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19940 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19941 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19942 &%one_time%& is set.
19943
19944
19945 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19946 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19947 to make use of &%run%& items.
19948
19949
19950 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19951 If this option is true, items of the form
19952 .code
19953 :include:<path name>
19954 .endd
19955 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19956
19957
19958 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19959 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19960 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19961 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19962 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19963
19964
19965 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19966 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19967 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19968
19969
19970 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19971 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19972 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19973 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19974 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19975
19976
19977
19978
19979 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19980 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19981 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19982 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19983 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19984 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19985 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19986
19987
19988 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19989 .cindex "EACCES"
19990 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19991 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19992 file did not exist.
19993
19994
19995 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19996 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19997 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19998 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19999 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20000
20001 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20002 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20003 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20004 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20005 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20006 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20007 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20008 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20009
20010
20011
20012 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20013 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20014 redirection list must start with this directory.
20015
20016
20017 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20018 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20019 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20020
20021
20022 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20023 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20024 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20025 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20026 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20027 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20028 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20029 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20030 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20031 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20032 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20033 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20034 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20035 before they subscribed.
20036
20037 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20038 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20039 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20040 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20041 attempt.
20042
20043 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20044 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20045 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20046 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20047
20048 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20049 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20050 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20051
20052 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20053 &%one_time%&.
20054
20055 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20056 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20057 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20058 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20059 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20060 expansion.
20061
20062
20063 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20064 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20065 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20066 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20067 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20068 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20069 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20070 See &%check_owner%& above.
20071
20072
20073 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20074 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20075 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20076 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20077
20078
20079 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20080 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20081 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20082 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20083 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20084 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20085 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20086
20087
20088 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20089 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20090 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20091 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20092 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20093 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20094 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20095 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20096
20097 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20098 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20099 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20100 addresses.
20101
20102 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20103 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20104 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20105 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20106 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20107 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20108 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20109 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20110 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20111 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20112
20113
20114 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20115 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20116 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20117 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20118 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20119 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20120
20121
20122 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20123 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20124 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20125 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20126 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20127 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20128
20129
20130 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20131 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20132 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20133 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20134 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20135
20136
20137 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20138 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20139 :subaddress part of an address.
20140
20141 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20142 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20143 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20144 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20145
20146
20147 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20148 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20149 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20150 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20151 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20152 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20153 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20154
20155
20156
20157 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20158 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20159 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20160 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20161 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20162 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20163 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20164 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20165 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20166 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20167 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20168 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20169 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20170 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20171 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20172 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20173
20174 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20175 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20176 the following routers.
20177
20178 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20179 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20180 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20181 so it is passed to the following routers.
20182
20183 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20184 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20185 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20186 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20187
20188 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20189 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20190 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20191 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20192 .code
20193 userforward:
20194 driver = redirect
20195 allow_filter
20196 check_local_user
20197 file = $home/.forward
20198 file_transport = address_file
20199 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20200 reply_transport = address_reply
20201 no_verify
20202 skip_syntax_errors
20203 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20204 syntax_errors_text = \
20205 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20206 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20207 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20208 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20209 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20210 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20211 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20212 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20213 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20214 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20215 .endd
20216 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20217 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20218 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20219 .code
20220 real_localuser:
20221 driver = accept
20222 check_local_user
20223 local_part_prefix = real-
20224 transport = local_delivery
20225 .endd
20226 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20227 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20228 .code
20229 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20230 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20231 .endd
20232
20233
20234 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20235 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20236
20237
20238 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20239 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20240 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20241 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20242
20243
20244
20245
20246
20247
20248 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20249 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20250
20251 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20252 "Environment for local transports"
20253 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20254 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20255 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20256 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20257 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20258 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20259 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20260
20261 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20262 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20263 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20264 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20265
20266 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20267 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20268 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20269 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20270 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20271
20272
20273
20274 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20275 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20276 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20277 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20278 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20279 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20280 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20281 time.
20282
20283 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20284 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20285 .code
20286 my_transport:
20287 driver = pipe
20288 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20289 .endd
20290 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20291 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20292 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20293 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20294
20295
20296
20297
20298 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20299 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20300 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20301 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20302 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20303 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20304 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20305 group (set by the transport). For example:
20306 .code
20307 # Routers ...
20308 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20309 local_users:
20310 driver = accept
20311 check_local_user
20312 transport = group_delivery
20313
20314 # Transports ...
20315 # This transport overrides the group
20316 group_delivery:
20317 driver = appendfile
20318 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20319 group = mail
20320 .endd
20321 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20322 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20323 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20324 set.
20325
20326 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20327 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20328 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20329 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20330 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20331 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20332
20333 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20334 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20335 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20336 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20337 original gid is also used.
20338
20339 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20340 following that is set is used:
20341
20342 .ilist
20343 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20344 .next
20345 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20346 .next
20347 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20348 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20349 .next
20350 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20351 .next
20352 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20353 the uid is the creator's uid;
20354 .next
20355 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20356 .endlist
20357
20358 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20359 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20360 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20361 The first of the following that is set is used:
20362
20363 .ilist
20364 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20365 .next
20366 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20367 .next
20368 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20369 .next
20370 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20371 .next
20372 The Exim uid.
20373 .endlist
20374
20375 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20376 &%never_users%& list.
20377
20378
20379
20380
20381
20382 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20383 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20384 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20385 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20386 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20387 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20388 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20389 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20390 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20391 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20392
20393 .ilist
20394 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20395 .next
20396 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20397 .next
20398 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20399 .next
20400 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20401 .endlist
20402
20403 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20404
20405 .ilist
20406 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20407 .next
20408 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20409 .endlist
20410
20411
20412 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20413 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20414 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20415
20416
20417
20418 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20419 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20420 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20421 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20422 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20423 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20424 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20425 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20426 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20427 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20428 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20429 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20430 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20431 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20432
20433
20434
20435
20436
20437
20438
20439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20441
20442 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20443 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20444 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20445 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20446 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20447
20448
20449 .option body_only transports boolean false
20450 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20451 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20452 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20453 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20454 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20455 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20456 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20457 automatically suppress them.
20458
20459
20460 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20461 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20462 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20463 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20464 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20465 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20466
20467
20468 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20469 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20470 deliveries by the transport or for any
20471 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20472 what you are doing.
20473
20474
20475 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20476 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20477 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20478 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20479 transport is run.
20480 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20481 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20482 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20483 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20484 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20485 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20486 one.
20487 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20488 transport and the router that called it.
20489
20490 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20491 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20492 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20493 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20494 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20495 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20496 safely be resent to other recipients.
20497
20498
20499 .option driver transports string unset
20500 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20501 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20502
20503
20504 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20505 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20506 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20507 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20508 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20509 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20510 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20511 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20512 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20513 resent to other recipients.
20514
20515
20516 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20517 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20518 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20519 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20520 &%user%& (see below).
20521
20522
20523 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20524 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20525 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20526 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20527 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20528 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20529 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20530 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20531 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20532 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20533 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20534
20535 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20536 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20537
20538
20539 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20540 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20541 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20542 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20543 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20544 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20545 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20546 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20547
20548
20549 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20550 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20551 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20552 This option specifies a list of header names,
20553 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20554 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20555 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20556 routers.
20557 Each list item is separately expanded.
20558 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20559 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20560 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20561
20562 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20563 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20564
20565 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20566 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20567 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20568
20569
20570
20571 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20572 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20573 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20574 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20575 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20576 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20577 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20578 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20579 example,
20580 .code
20581 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20582 x@y w@z
20583 .endd
20584 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20585 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20586 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20587 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20588 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20589 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20590 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20591 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20592 change envelope recipients at this time.
20593
20594
20595 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20596 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20597 .vindex "&$home$&"
20598 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20599 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20600 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20601 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20602 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20603 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20604 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20605 deferred.
20606
20607
20608 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20609 .cindex "additional groups"
20610 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20611 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20612 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20613 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20614 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20615
20616
20617 .new
20618 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20619 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20620 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
20621 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20622 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20623 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20624 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20625 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20626
20627 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20628 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20629 incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20630 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20631 Obviously there is scope for
20632 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20633 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20634
20635 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20636 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20637 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20638 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20639 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20640 .wen
20641
20642
20643 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20644 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20645 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20646 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20647 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20648 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20649 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20650 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20651 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20652 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20653 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20654 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20655 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20656 delivered.
20657
20658
20659
20660 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20661 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20662 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20663 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20664 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20665 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20666 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20667 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20668 that contains
20669 .code
20670 local_part_prefix = *-
20671 .endd
20672 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20673 is delivered with
20674 .code
20675 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20676 .endd
20677 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20678 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20679 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20680 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20681 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20682
20683
20684 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20685 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20686 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20687 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20688 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20689 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20690 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20691 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20692 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20693
20694 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20695 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20696 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20697 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20698
20699 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20700 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20701 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20702
20703
20704 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20705 .cindex "envelope sender"
20706 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20707 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20708 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20709 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20710 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20711 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20712 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20713 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20714 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20715
20716 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20717 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20718
20719 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20720 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20721 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20722 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20723 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20724 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20725 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20726
20727 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20728 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20729 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20730 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20731 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20732
20733
20734
20735 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20736 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20737 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20738 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20739 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20740 have easy access to it.
20741
20742 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20743 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20744 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20745 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20746 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20747 recipients.
20748
20749
20750 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20751 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20752
20753
20754 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20755 .cindex "shadow transport"
20756 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20757 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20758 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20759
20760 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20761 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20762 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20763 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20764 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20765 cause a log line to be written.
20766
20767 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20768 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20769 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20770 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20771 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20772 of the form
20773 .code
20774 ST=<shadow transport name>
20775 .endd
20776 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20777 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20778 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20779 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20780 headers that some sites insist on.
20781
20782
20783 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20784 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20785 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20786 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20787 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20788 individual users or via a system filter.
20789 .new
20790 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
20791 .wen
20792
20793 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20794 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20795 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20796 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20797 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20798
20799 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20800 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20801 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20802 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20803 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20804 &(pipe)& transports.
20805
20806 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20807 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20808 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20809 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20810 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20811
20812 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20813 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20814 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20815 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20816
20817 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20818 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20819 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20820 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20821 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20822 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20823
20824 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20825 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20826 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20827 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20828 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20829 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20830 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20831 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20832
20833 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20834 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20835 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20836 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20837 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20838 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20839 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20840 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20841 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20842 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20843
20844 .vindex "&$host$&"
20845 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20846 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20847 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20848 which the message is being sent. For example:
20849 .code
20850 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20851 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20852 .endd
20853
20854 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20855 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20856 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20857 .ilist
20858 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20859 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20860 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20861 example:
20862 .code
20863 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20864 .endd
20865 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20866 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20867 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20868 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20869 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20870 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20871 .next
20872 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20873 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20874 arguments. Consider this example:
20875 .code
20876 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20877 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20878 .endd
20879 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20880 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20881 .code
20882 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20883 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20884 .endd
20885 .endlist
20886
20887 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20888 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20889 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20890 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20891 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20892 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20893 bounced from a transport filter.
20894
20895 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20896 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20897 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20898
20899
20900 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20901 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20902 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20903 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20904 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20905 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20906 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20907 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20908 becomes a temporary error.
20909
20910
20911 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20912 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20913 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20914 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20915 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20916 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20917 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20918 option is not set.
20919
20920 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20921 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20922 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20923
20924 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20925 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20926 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20927 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20928 retry data.
20929 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20930 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20931 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20932
20933
20934
20935
20936
20937
20938 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20939 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20940
20941 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20942 "Address batching"
20943 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20944 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20945 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20946 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20947 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20948 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20949 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20950
20951 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20952 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20953 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20954 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20955 local transport, for example:
20956
20957 .ilist
20958 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20959 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20960 recipients saves space.
20961 .next
20962 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20963 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20964 .next
20965 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20966 to a scanner program or
20967 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20968 acceptable.
20969 .endlist
20970
20971 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20972 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20973 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20974
20975 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20976 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20977 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20978 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20979 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20980 to certain conditions:
20981
20982 .ilist
20983 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20984 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20985 batching is possible.
20986 .next
20987 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20988 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20989 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20990 .next
20991 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20992 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20993 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20994 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20995 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20996 from taking place.
20997 .next
20998 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20999 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21000 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21001 be the same.
21002 .endlist
21003
21004 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21005 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21006 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21007 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21008 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21009 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21010 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21011 .code
21012 check_string = "."
21013 escape_string = ".."
21014 .endd
21015 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21016 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21017 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21018
21019 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21020 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21021 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21022 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21023 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21024 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21025
21026 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21027 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21028 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21029 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21030 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21031 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21032 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21033 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21034 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21035
21036
21037
21038
21039 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21040 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21041
21042 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21043 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21044 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21045 .cindex "directory creation"
21046 .cindex "creating directories"
21047 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21048 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21049 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21050 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21051 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21052 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21053 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21054 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21055 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21056 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21057
21058 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21059 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21060 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21061 included.
21062
21063 .cindex "quota" "system"
21064 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21065 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21066 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21067
21068 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21069 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21070 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21071 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21072
21073 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21074 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21075 private options.
21076
21077 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21078 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21079 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21080 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21081 option).
21082
21083
21084
21085 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21086 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21087 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21088 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21089 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21090
21091 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21092 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21093 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21094 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21095 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21096 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21097 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21098 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21099 operation. There are two cases:
21100
21101 .ilist
21102 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21103 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21104 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21105 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21106 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21107 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21108 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21109 .next
21110 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21111 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21112 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21113 .endlist
21114
21115
21116 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21117 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21118 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21119 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21120 form:
21121 .code
21122 save folder23
21123 .endd
21124 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21125 .code
21126 require "fileinto";
21127 fileinto "folder23";
21128 .endd
21129 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21130 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21131 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21132 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21133 way of handling this requirement:
21134 .code
21135 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21136 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21137 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21138 {$address_file} \
21139 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21140 }} \
21141 }
21142 .endd
21143 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21144 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21145 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21146
21147 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21148 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21149 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21150 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21151 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21152 path to the transport.
21153
21154 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21155 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21156
21157
21158
21159
21160 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21161 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21162
21163
21164
21165 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21166 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21167 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21168 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21169 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21170 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21171 delivery is deferred.
21172
21173
21174 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21175 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21176 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21177 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21178 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21179 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21180 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21181 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21182
21183
21184 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21185 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21186 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21187 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21188 file.
21189
21190
21191 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21192 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21193
21194
21195 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21196 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21197 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21198 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21199 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21200
21201
21202 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21203 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21204 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21205 process is running.
21206
21207
21208 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21209 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21210 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21211 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21212 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21213 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21214 contains is significant.
21215
21216 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21217 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21218 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21219 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21220 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21221
21222 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21223 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21224 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21225 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21226 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21227 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21228 .code
21229 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21230 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21231 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21232 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21233 .endd
21234 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21235 .cindex "directory creation"
21236 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21237 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21238 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21239
21240 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21241 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21242 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21243 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21244 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21245
21246
21247
21248 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21249 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21250 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21251 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21252 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21253 beneath.
21254
21255 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21256 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21257 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21258 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21259 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21260 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21261 &%file_must_exist%&.
21262
21263
21264 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21265 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21266 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21267 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21268
21269 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21270 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21271 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21272 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21273 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21274
21275
21276 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21277 .cindex "base62"
21278 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21279 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21280 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21281 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21282 .code
21283 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21284 .endd
21285 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21286 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21287 option.
21288
21289
21290 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21291 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21292 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21293
21294
21295 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21296 See &%check_string%& above.
21297
21298
21299 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21300 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21301 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21302 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21303 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21304 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21305 &%file%&.
21306
21307 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21308 .cindex "locking files"
21309 .cindex "lock files"
21310 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21311 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21312
21313 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21314 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21315 examples:
21316 .code
21317 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21318 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21319 file = $home/inbox
21320 .endd
21321 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21322 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21323 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21324 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21325 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21326 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21327
21328
21329
21330 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21331 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21332 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21333 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21334 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21335 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21336 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21337 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21338 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21339 this added to it:
21340 .code
21341 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21342 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21343 .endd
21344 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21345 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21346 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21347 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21348 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21349 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21350 delivery is deferred.
21351
21352
21353 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21354 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21355 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21356 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21357
21358
21359 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21360 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21361 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21362 .cindex "locking files"
21363 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21364 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21365 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21366 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21367 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21368 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21369 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21370 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21371
21372 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21373 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21374 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21375 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21376
21377 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21378 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21379 retries is
21380 .code
21381 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21382 .endd
21383 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21384 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21385 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21386
21387 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21388 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21389 .code
21390 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21391 .endd
21392
21393 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21394 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21395 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21396 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21397
21398
21399 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21400 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21401 for details of locking.
21402
21403
21404 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21405 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21406 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21407
21408
21409 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21410 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21411 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21412
21413
21414 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21415 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21416 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21417 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21418 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21419
21420
21421 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21422 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21423 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21424 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21425 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21426 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21427 external source that maintains the data.
21428
21429
21430 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21431 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21432 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21433 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21434 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21435 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21436 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21437 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21438
21439
21440
21441 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21442 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21443 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21444 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21445 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21446 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21447 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21448 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21449 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21450 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21451
21452
21453 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21454 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21455 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21456 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21457 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21458 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21459 calculation. The default value is:
21460 .code
21461 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21462 .endd
21463 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21464 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21465 &_Trash_&
21466 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21467 .code
21468 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21469 .endd
21470 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21471 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21472 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21473 directly into that directory.
21474
21475
21476 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21477 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21478 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21479
21480
21481 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21482 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21483 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21484
21485
21486 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21487 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21488 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21489 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21490 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21491 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21492 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21493 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21494
21495 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21496 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21497 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21498 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21499 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21500 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21501 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21502 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21503 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21504 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21505
21506
21507 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21508 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21509 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21510 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21511 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21512 below for further details.
21513
21514
21515 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21516 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21517 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21518
21519
21520 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21521 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21522 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21523
21524
21525 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21526 .cindex "locking files"
21527 .cindex "file" "locking"
21528 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21529 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21530 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21531 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21532 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21533 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21534 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21535
21536 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21537 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21538 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21539 combination:
21540 .code
21541 mbx_format = true
21542 message_prefix =
21543 message_suffix =
21544 .endd
21545 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21546 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21547 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21548 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21549 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21550 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21551 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21552 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21553
21554 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21555 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21556 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21557 append messages to it.
21558
21559
21560 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21561 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21562 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21563 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21564 in which case it is:
21565 .code
21566 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21567 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21568 .endd
21569 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21570 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21571
21572 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21573 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21574 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21575 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21576 setting
21577 .code
21578 message_suffix =
21579 .endd
21580 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21581 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21582
21583 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21584 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21585 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21586 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21587 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21588 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21589 value, and this option is ignored.
21590
21591
21592 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21593 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21594 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21595 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21596 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21597
21598
21599 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21600 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21601 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21602 on users about incoming mail.
21603
21604
21605 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21606 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21607 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21608 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21609 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21610 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21611 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21612 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21613 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21614
21615 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21616 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21617 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21618
21619 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21620 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21621 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21622 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21623 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21624 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21625
21626 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21627 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21628 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21629 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21630 be handled.
21631
21632 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21633
21634 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21635 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21636 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21637 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21638 system quota failures.
21639
21640 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21641 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21642 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21643 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21644 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21645 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21646 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21647 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21648 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21649 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21650
21651
21652 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21653 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21654 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21655 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21656 delivery directory.
21657
21658
21659 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21660 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21661 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21662 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21663 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21664 &"no quota"&.
21665
21666
21667 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21668 See &%quota%& above.
21669
21670
21671 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21672 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21673 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21674 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21675 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21676 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21677 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21678
21679 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21680 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21681 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21682 the file length to the file name. For example:
21683 .code
21684 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21685 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21686 .endd
21687 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21688 number of lines in the message.
21689
21690 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21691 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21692 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21693
21694 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21695
21696
21697 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21698 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21699 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21700 .code
21701 quota_warn_message = "\
21702 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21703 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21704 This message is automatically created \
21705 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21706 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21707 a warning threshold that is\n\
21708 set by the system administrator.\n"
21709 .endd
21710
21711
21712 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21713 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21714 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21715 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21716 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21717 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21718 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21719 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21720 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21721 sign. For example:
21722 .code
21723 quota = 10M
21724 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21725 .endd
21726 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21727 percent sign is ignored.
21728
21729 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21730 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21731 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21732 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21733 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21734 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21735 .code
21736 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21737 .endd
21738 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21739 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21740 option.
21741
21742 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21743 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21744 percentage.
21745
21746
21747 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21748 .cindex "envelope sender"
21749 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21750 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21751 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21752 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21753 for details of batch SMTP.
21754
21755
21756 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21757 .cindex "carriage return"
21758 .cindex "linefeed"
21759 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21760 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21761 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21762 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21763
21764 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21765 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21766 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21767 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21768 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21769 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21770
21771
21772 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21773 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21774 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21775 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21776 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21777 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21778
21779
21780 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21781 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21782 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21783 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21784 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21785
21786 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21787 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21788 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21789 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21790
21791 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21792 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21793 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21794 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21795 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21796 error.
21797
21798 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21799 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21800
21801
21802 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21803 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21804 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21805 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21806 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21807 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21808 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21809
21810 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21811 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21812 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21813 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21814 file corruption.
21815
21816 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21817 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21818 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21819
21820
21821 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21822 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21823 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21824 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21825 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21826 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21827 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21828 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21829 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21830
21831 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21832 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21833 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21834 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21835
21836
21837
21838
21839 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21840 .cindex "appending to a file"
21841 .cindex "file" "appending"
21842 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21843
21844 .ilist
21845 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21846 return is given.
21847
21848 .next
21849 .cindex "directory creation"
21850 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21851 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21852 &%directory_mode%& option.
21853
21854 .next
21855 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21856 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21857 transport.
21858
21859 .next
21860 .cindex "file" "locking"
21861 .cindex "locking files"
21862 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21863 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21864 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21865
21866 .olist
21867 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21868 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21869 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21870 .next
21871 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21872 .next
21873 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21874 Unlink the hitching post name.
21875 .next
21876 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21877 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21878 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21879 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21880 .next
21881 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21882 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21883 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21884 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21885 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21886 it before trying again.
21887 .endlist olist
21888
21889 .next
21890 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21891 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21892 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21893
21894 .next
21895 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21896 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21897 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21898 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21899 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21900 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21901 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21902 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21903 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21904 checked.
21905
21906 .next
21907 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21908 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21909 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21910 delivery is deferred.
21911
21912 .next
21913 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21914 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21915 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21916 permissions.
21917
21918 .next
21919 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21920 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21921 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21922
21923 .next
21924 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21925 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21926 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21927
21928 .next
21929 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21930 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21931 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21932 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21933 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21934 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21935 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21936 that prevents link following.
21937
21938 .next
21939 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21940 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21941 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21942 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21943 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21944
21945 .next
21946 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21947
21948 .next
21949 .cindex "file" "locking"
21950 .cindex "locking files"
21951 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21952 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21953 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21954 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21955 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21956 .code
21957 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21958 .endd
21959 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21960 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21961 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21962
21963 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21964 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21965 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21966
21967 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21968 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21969 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21970 delivery is deferred.
21971
21972 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21973 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21974 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21975 immediately. It retries up to
21976 .code
21977 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21978 .endd
21979 times (rounded up).
21980 .endlist
21981
21982 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21983 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21984
21985
21986 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21987 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21988 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21989 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21990 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21991 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21992 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21993 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21994 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21995 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21996
21997 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21998 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21999 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22000 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22001 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22002 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22003 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22004
22005 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22006 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22007 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22008 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22009
22010
22011 .cindex "maildir format"
22012 .cindex "mailstore format"
22013 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22014 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22015 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22016 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22017 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22018
22019 .cindex "directory creation"
22020 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22021 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22022 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22023 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22024 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22025 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22026 deferred.
22027
22028
22029
22030 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22031 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22032 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22033 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22034 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22035 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22036 &_new_& subdirectory.
22037
22038 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22039 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22040 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22041 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22042 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22043 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22044 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22045
22046 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22047 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22048 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22049 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22050 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22051 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22052 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22053 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22054
22055 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22056 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22057 folders. Consider this example:
22058 .code
22059 maildir_format = true
22060 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22061 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22062 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22063 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22064 .endd
22065 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22066 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22067 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22068 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22069 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22070 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22071
22072 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22073 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22074 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22075 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22076 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22077
22078 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22079 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22080 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22081
22082 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22083 .cindex "maildir++"
22084 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22085 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22086 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22087 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22088 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22089 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22090 amount of space used.
22091
22092 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22093 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22094 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22095 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22096 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22097 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22098
22099
22100
22101
22102 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22103 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22104 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22105 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22106 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22107 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22108
22109
22110 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22111 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22112 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22113 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22114 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22115 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22116 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22117 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22118 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22119 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22120 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22121 backwards compatibility).
22122
22123 For one common implementation, you might set:
22124 .code
22125 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22126 .endd
22127 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22128
22129 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22130 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22131 &[stat()]& each message file.
22132
22133
22134 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22135 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22136 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22137 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22138 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22139 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22140 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22141 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22142 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22143
22144 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22145 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22146 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22147 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22148 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22149 need to know the quota.
22150
22151 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22152 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22153
22154 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22155 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22156 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22157 details.
22158
22159
22160 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22161 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22162 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22163 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22164 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22165 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22166 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22167 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22168
22169 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22170 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22171 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22172 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22173 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22174 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22175
22176 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22177 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22178 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22179 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22180 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22181 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22182
22183 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22184 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22185 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22186 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22187
22188
22189 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22190 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22191 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22192 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22193 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22194 .code
22195 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22196 .endd
22197 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22198 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22199 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22200 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22201 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22202
22203
22204
22205
22206
22207
22208 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22209 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22210
22211 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22212 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22213 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22214 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22215 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22216 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22217 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22218 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22219
22220 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22221 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22222 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22223 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22224 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22225
22226
22227 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22228 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22229 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22230 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22231 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22232
22233 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22234 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22235 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22236 transport is run as a consequence of a
22237 &%mail%&
22238 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22239 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22240 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22241 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22242 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22243 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22244
22245 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22246 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22247 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22248 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22249
22250 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22251 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22252 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22253 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22254 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22255 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22256 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22257
22258 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22259 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22260 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22261 the transport defers.
22262 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22263 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22264
22265 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22266 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22267 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22268 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22269
22270 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22271 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22272 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22273 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22274 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22275 problems. They are just discarded.
22276
22277
22278
22279 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22280 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22281
22282 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22283 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22284 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22285
22286
22287 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22288 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22289 when the message is specified by the transport.
22290
22291
22292 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22293 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22294 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22295 string comes first.
22296
22297
22298 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22299 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22300 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22301
22302
22303 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22304 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22305 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22306
22307
22308 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22309 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22310 specified by the transport.
22311
22312
22313 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22314 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22315 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22316 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22317
22318
22319 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22320 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22321 the message is specified by the transport.
22322
22323
22324 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22325 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22326 used.
22327
22328
22329 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22330 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22331 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22332 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22333 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22334
22335
22336
22337 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22338 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22339 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22340 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22341
22342 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22343 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22344 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22345 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22346 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22347 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22348 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22349 infinity.
22350
22351 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22352 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22353 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22354 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22355 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22356
22357 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22358 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22359 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22360 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22361 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22362 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22363
22364
22365 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22366 See &%once%& above.
22367
22368
22369 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22370 See &%once%& above.
22371 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22372
22373
22374 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22375 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22376 specified by the transport.
22377
22378
22379 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22380 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22381 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22382 configuration option.
22383
22384
22385 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22386 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22387 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22388 automatic responses. For example:
22389 .code
22390 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22391 .endd
22392 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22393 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22394 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22395 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22396 small.
22397
22398
22399
22400 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22401 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22402 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22403 the text comes first.
22404
22405
22406 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22407 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22408 when the message is specified by the transport.
22409 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22410 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22411
22412
22413
22414
22415 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22417
22418 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22419 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22420 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22421 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22422 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22423 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22424 specified command
22425 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22426 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22427 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22428 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22429 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22430 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22431 .code
22432 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22433 .endd
22434 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22435 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22436 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22437 as follows:
22438
22439 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22440 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22441
22442
22443 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22444 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22445 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22446 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22447 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22448
22449
22450 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22451 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22452 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22453 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22454 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22455 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22456 LMTP protocol.
22457
22458 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22459 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22460 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22461 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22462 in its response to the LHLO command.
22463
22464 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22465 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22466 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22467 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22468
22469
22470 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22471 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22472 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22473 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22474 LMTP transport:
22475 .code
22476 lmtp:
22477 driver = lmtp
22478 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22479 batch_max = 20
22480 user = exim
22481 .endd
22482 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22483 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22484
22485
22486
22487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22489
22490 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22491 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22492 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22493 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22494 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22495 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22496 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22497 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22498 following ways:
22499
22500 .ilist
22501 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22502 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22503 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22504 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22505 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22506 .next
22507 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22508 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22509 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22510 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22511 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22512 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22513 that are routed to the transport.
22514 .next
22515 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22516 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22517 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22518 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22519 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22520 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22521 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22522 .endlist
22523
22524
22525 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22526 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22527 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22528
22529 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22530 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22531 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22532 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22533 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22534 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22535 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22536
22537
22538 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22539 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22540 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22541 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22542 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22543 .new
22544 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22545 of "1" to enforce serialization.
22546 .wen
22547
22548
22549
22550
22551 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22552 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22553 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22554 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22555 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22556 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22557 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22558 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22559 &"local delivery failed"&.
22560
22561 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22562 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22563 will be sent as normal.
22564
22565 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22566 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22567 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22568 apply in this case.
22569
22570 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22571 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22572 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22573 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22574
22575 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22576 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22577 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22578 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22579 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22580 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22581 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22582 &%temp_errors%&.
22583
22584
22585
22586 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22587 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22588 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22589 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22590 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22591 run.
22592
22593 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22594 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22595 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22596 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22597
22598 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22599 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22600 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22601 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22602 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22603 .code
22604 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22605 .endd
22606 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22607 arguments. You have to write
22608 .code
22609 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22610 .endd
22611 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22612 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22613 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22614 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22615 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22616 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22617 example:
22618 .code
22619 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22620 .endd
22621
22622 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22623 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22624 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22625 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22626 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22627 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22628 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22629 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22630 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22631 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22632
22633 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22634 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22635 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22636 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22637 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22638 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22639 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22640 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22641
22642 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22643 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22644 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22645 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22646 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22647 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22648 control what is done with it.
22649
22650 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22651 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22652 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22653 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22654 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22655 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22656 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22657 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22658 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22659 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22660 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22661
22662
22663
22664 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22665 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22666 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22667 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22668 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22669 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22670 environment.
22671 .display
22672 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22673 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22674 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22675 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22676 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22677 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22678 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22679 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22680 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22681 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22682 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22683 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22684 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22685 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22686 &`USER `& see below
22687 .endd
22688 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22689 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22690 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22691 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22692 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22693 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22694 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22695
22696 .cindex "HOST"
22697 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22698 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22699 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22700 the router.
22701
22702 .cindex "HOME"
22703 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22704 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22705 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22706 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22707
22708
22709 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22710 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22711
22712
22713
22714 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22715 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22716 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22717 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22718 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22719 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22720 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22721 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22722 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22723 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22724 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22725 example, if
22726 .code
22727 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22728 .endd
22729 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22730 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22731 &%use_shell%& is set.
22732
22733
22734 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22735 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22736
22737
22738 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22739 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22740 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22741
22742
22743 .option check_string pipe string unset
22744 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22745 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22746 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22747 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22748 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22749 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22750 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22751 ignored.
22752
22753
22754 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22755 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22756 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22757 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22758 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22759 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22760 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22761
22762
22763 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22764 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22765 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22766 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22767 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22768 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22769 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22770
22771
22772 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22773 See &%check_string%& above.
22774
22775
22776 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22777 .cindex "exec failure"
22778 .cindex "failure of exec"
22779 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22780 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22781 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22782 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22783 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22784
22785
22786 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22787 .cindex "signal exit"
22788 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22789 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22790 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22791 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22792
22793
22794 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22795 .cindex "force command"
22796 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22797 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22798 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22799 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22800 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22801 command. For example:
22802 .code
22803 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22804 force_command
22805 .endd
22806
22807 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22808 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22809 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22810
22811
22812 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22813 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22814 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22815 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22816 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22817 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22818
22819 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22820 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22821
22822
22823 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22824 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22825 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22826 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22827 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
22828 written to the main log.
22829
22830
22831 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22832 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
22833 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
22834 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
22835 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
22836 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
22837 be set.
22838
22839
22840 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22841 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
22842 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
22843 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
22844 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22845
22846
22847 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22848 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22849 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22850 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22851 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22852 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22853 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22854 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22855
22856
22857 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22858 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22859 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22860 .code
22861 message_prefix = \
22862 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22863 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22864 .endd
22865 .cindex "Cyrus"
22866 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22867 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22868 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22869 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22870 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22871 setting
22872 .code
22873 message_prefix =
22874 .endd
22875 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22876 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22877
22878
22879 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22880 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22881 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22882 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22883 .code
22884 message_suffix =
22885 .endd
22886 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22887 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22888
22889
22890 .option path pipe string "see below"
22891 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22892 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22893 .code
22894 /bin:/usr/bin
22895 .endd
22896 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22897 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22898 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22899
22900
22901 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22902 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22903 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22904 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22905 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22906 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22907 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22908 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22909 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22910
22911
22912 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22913 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22914 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22915 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22916 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22917 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22918 accept the message is used.
22919
22920
22921 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22922 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22923 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22924 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22925 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22926 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22927
22928
22929 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22930 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22931 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22932 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22933 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22934 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22935 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22936
22937
22938
22939 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22940 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22941 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22942 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22943 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22944 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22945 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22946 of them may be set.
22947
22948
22949
22950 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22951 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22952 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22953 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22954 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22955 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22956 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22957 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22958 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22959 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22960 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22961 and 73, respectively.
22962
22963
22964 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22965 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22966 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22967 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22968 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22969 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22970 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22971
22972 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22973 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22974 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22975 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22976 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22977 delivery to be deferred.
22978
22979 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22980 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22981
22982
22983 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22984 .cindex "envelope sender"
22985 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22986 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22987 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22988 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22989 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22990
22991 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22992 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22993 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22994 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22995 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22996 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22997 class database.
22998
22999
23000 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23001 .cindex "carriage return"
23002 .cindex "linefeed"
23003 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23004 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23005 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23006 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23007
23008 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23009 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23010 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23011 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23012 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23013
23014
23015 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23016 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23017 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23018 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23019 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23020 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23021 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23022 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23023 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23024 its &%-c%& option.
23025
23026
23027
23028 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23029 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23030 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23031 .cindex "external local delivery"
23032 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23033 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23034 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23035 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23036 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23037 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23038 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23039 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23040 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23041 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23042 .code
23043 # transport
23044 procmail_pipe:
23045 driver = pipe
23046 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23047 return_path_add
23048 delivery_date_add
23049 envelope_to_add
23050 check_string = "From "
23051 escape_string = ">From "
23052 umask = 077
23053 user = $local_part
23054 group = mail
23055
23056 # router
23057 procmail:
23058 driver = accept
23059 check_local_user
23060 transport = procmail_pipe
23061 .endd
23062 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23063 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23064 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23065 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23066 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23067 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23068
23069 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23070 .code
23071 IFS=" "
23072 .endd
23073 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23074 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23075
23076 .cindex "Cyrus"
23077 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23078 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23079 .code
23080 # transport
23081 local_delivery_cyrus:
23082 driver = pipe
23083 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23084 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23085 user = cyrus
23086 group = mail
23087 return_output
23088 log_output
23089 message_prefix =
23090 message_suffix =
23091
23092 # router
23093 local_user_cyrus:
23094 driver = accept
23095 check_local_user
23096 local_part_suffix = .*
23097 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23098 .endd
23099 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23100 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23101 sender.
23102 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23103 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23104
23105
23106 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23107 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23108
23109 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23110 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23111 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23112 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23113 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23114 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23115 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23116 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23117
23118
23119 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23120 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23121 two ways:
23122
23123 .ilist
23124 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23125 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23126 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23127 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23128 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23129 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23130 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23131 .next
23132 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23133 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23134 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23135 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23136 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23137 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23138 process.
23139 .endlist
23140
23141
23142 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23143 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23144 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23145
23146
23147
23148 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23149 .vindex "&$host$&"
23150 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23151 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23152 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23153 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23154 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23155 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23156 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23157 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23158
23159
23160 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23161 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23162 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23163 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23164 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23165 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23166 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23167 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23168 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23169 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23170 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23171 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23172 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23173 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23174
23175 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23176 and will be removed in a future release.
23177
23178
23179 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23180 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23181 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23182
23183
23184 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23185 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23186 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23187 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23188 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23189 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23190 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23191 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23192
23193 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23194 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23195 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23196 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23197 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23198 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23199 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23200 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23201 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23202
23203
23204 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23205 .cindex "Cyrus"
23206 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23207 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23208 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23209 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23210 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23211 ignored.
23212
23213 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23214 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23215 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23216 particular connection.
23217
23218 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23219 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23220 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23221 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23222
23223 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23224 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23225 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23226 .code
23227 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23228 .endd
23229 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23230 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23231
23232 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23233 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23234 value.
23235
23236
23237 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23238 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23239 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23240 authenticated as a client.
23241
23242
23243 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23244 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23245 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23246 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23247
23248
23249 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23250 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23251 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23252 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23253 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23254 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23255 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23256
23257
23258 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23259 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23260 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23261 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23262 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23263 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23264 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23265 option.
23266
23267
23268 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23269 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23270 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23271 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23272
23273
23274 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23275 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23276 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23277 cutoff times.
23278
23279 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23280 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23281 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23282 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23283 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23284 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23285
23286 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23287 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23288 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23289 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23290 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23291 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23292 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23293 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23294 to them.
23295
23296
23297 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23298 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23299 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23300 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23301 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23302
23303
23304 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23305 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23306 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23307 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23308 details.
23309
23310
23311 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23312 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23313 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23314 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23315 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23316 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23317 the dnssec request bit set.
23318 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23319
23320
23321
23322 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23323 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23324 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23325 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23326 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23327 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23328 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23329 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23330 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23331
23332
23333
23334 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23335 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23336 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23337 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23338 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23339 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23340 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23341
23342 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23343 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23344 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23345 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23346 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23347
23348
23349 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23350 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23351 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23352 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23353 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23354 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23355 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23356 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23357
23358 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23359 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23360 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23361 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23362 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23363 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23364
23365 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23366 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23367 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23368 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23369 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23370
23371 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23372 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23373 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23374 copy of the message is sent.
23375
23376 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23377 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23378 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23379 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23380 fails"& facility.
23381
23382
23383 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23384 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23385 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23386 zero.
23387
23388 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23389 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23390 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23391 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23392 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23393 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23394
23395 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23396 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23397 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23398 implementations of TLS.
23399
23400 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23401 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23402 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23403 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23404 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23405 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23406 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23407 option is:
23408 .code
23409 $primary_hostname
23410 .endd
23411 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23412 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23413 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23414 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23415 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23416 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23417 interface address, you could use this:
23418 .code
23419 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23420 {$primary_hostname}}
23421 .endd
23422 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23423 callouts.
23424
23425 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23426 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23427 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23428 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23429 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23430 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23431
23432 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23433 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23434 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23435 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23436
23437 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23438 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23439 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23440 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23441 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23442 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23443 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23444
23445 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23446 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23447 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23448 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23449 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23450 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23451 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23452 address are used.
23453
23454 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23455 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23456
23457
23458 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23459 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23460 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23461 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23462 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23463 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23464 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23465 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23466 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23467 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23468
23469
23470 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23471 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23472 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23473 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23474
23475
23476 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23477 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23478 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23479 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23480
23481 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23482 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23483 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23484 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23485 to any host that matches this list.
23486
23487
23488 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23489 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23490 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23491 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23492 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23493 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23494 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23495 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23496
23497
23498 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23499 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23500 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23501 why it exists.
23502
23503
23504
23505 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23506 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23507 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23508 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23509 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23510 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23511 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23512 explanation of when this might be needed.
23513
23514
23515 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23516 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23517 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23518 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23519 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23520
23521
23522 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23523 .cindex "randomized host list"
23524 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23525 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23526 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23527 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23528 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23529 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23530 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23531 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23532
23533 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23534 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23535 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23536 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23537 .code
23538 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23539 .endd
23540 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23541 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23542 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23543
23544 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23545 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23546 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23547 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23548 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23549 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23550 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23551 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23552 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23553
23554
23555 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23556 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23557 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23558 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23559 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23560
23561 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23562 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23563 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23564 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23565 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23566
23567 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23568 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23569 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23570 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23571 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23572 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23573
23574 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23575 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23576 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23577 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23578 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23579 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23580 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23581
23582 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23583 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23584 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23585 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23586 for multi-recipient messages.
23587 The option can usually be left as default.
23588
23589 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23590 .cindex "bind IP address"
23591 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23592 .vindex "&$host$&"
23593 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23594 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23595 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23596 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23597 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23598 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23599 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23600 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23601 unknown.
23602
23603 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23604 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23605 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23606 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23607 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23608 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23609 .code
23610 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23611 .endd
23612 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23613 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23614 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23615 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23616
23617
23618 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23619 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23620 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23621 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23622 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23623 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23624 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23625 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23626 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23627 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23628 unreachable hosts.
23629
23630
23631 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23632 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23633 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23634 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23635 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23636
23637 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23638 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23639 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23640 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23641 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23642 permits this.
23643
23644
23645 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23646 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23647 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23648 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23649 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23650 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23651 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23652 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23653
23654 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23655 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23656 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23657
23658 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23659 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23660 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23661 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23662 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23663 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23664 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23665 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23666
23667 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23668 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23669 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23670 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23671 is deferred.
23672
23673
23674
23675 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23676 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23677 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23678 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23679 .vindex "&$port$&"
23680 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23681 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23682 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23683 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23684 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23685
23686 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23687 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23688 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23689 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23690
23691
23692 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23693 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23694 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23695 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23696 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23697 addresses is not affected.
23698
23699 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23700 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23701 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23702 Exim to use only the host name.
23703 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23704
23705
23706 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23707 .cindex "serializing connections"
23708 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23709 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23710 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23711 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23712 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23713 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23714 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23715
23716 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23717 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23718 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23719 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23720 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23721 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23722
23723 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23724 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23725 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23726 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23727 are used for ETRN serialization.
23728
23729 .new
23730 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23731 .wen
23732
23733
23734 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23735 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23736 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23737 .cindex "size" "of message"
23738 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23739 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23740 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23741 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23742 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23743 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23744 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23745 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23746
23747 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23748 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23749
23750
23751 .new
23752 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
23753 .cindex proxy SOCKS
23754 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
23755 transport. For details see &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
23756 .wen
23757
23758
23759 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23760 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23761 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23762 .vindex "&$host$&"
23763 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23764 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23765 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23766 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23767 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23768 details of TLS.
23769
23770 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23771 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23772 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23773 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23774 client.
23775
23776
23777 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23778 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23779 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23780 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23781 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23782
23783
23784 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23785 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23786 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23787 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23788 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23789 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23790 will fail.
23791
23792 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23793
23794
23795 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23796 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23797 .vindex "&$host$&"
23798 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23799 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23800 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23801 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23802 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23803 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23804 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23805 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23806
23807
23808 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23809 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23810 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23811 .vindex "&$host$&"
23812 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23813 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23814 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23815 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23816 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23817 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23818 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23819 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23820 ciphers is a preference order.
23821
23822
23823
23824 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23825 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23826 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23827 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23828 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23829 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23830 certificate and private key for the session.
23831
23832 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23833
23834 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23835 TLS extensions.
23836
23837
23838
23839
23840 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23841 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23842 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23843 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23844 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23845 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23846 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23847 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23848 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23849 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23850 in clear.
23851
23852
23853 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23854 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23855 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23856 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23857 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23858 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23859 Note that unless the host is in this list
23860 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23861 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23862 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23863 certificate verification succeeds.
23864
23865
23866 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23867 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23868 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23869 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23870 while verifying the server certificate,
23871 checks will be included on the host name
23872 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23873 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23874 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23875
23876 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23877
23878
23879 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23880 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23881 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23882 .vindex "&$host$&"
23883 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23884 The value of this option must be either the
23885 word "system"
23886 or the absolute path to
23887 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23888 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23889
23890 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23891 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23892 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23893 must be specified.
23894
23895 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
23896 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23897
23898 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23899 explicitly
23900 either by file or directory
23901 are added to those given by the system default location.
23902
23903 The values of &$host$& and
23904 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23905 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23906
23907 For back-compatibility,
23908 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23909 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23910 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23911
23912
23913 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23914 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23915 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23916 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23917 certificate verification must succeed.
23918 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23919 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23920 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23921
23922
23923
23924
23925 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23926 "SECTvalhosmax"
23927 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23928 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23929 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23930 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23931 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23932
23933
23934 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23935 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23936 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23937 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23938 retrying.
23939
23940 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23941 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23942 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23943
23944 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23945 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23946 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23947 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23948 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23949
23950 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23951 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23952 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23953 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23954 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23955 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23956 see below for an exception).
23957
23958 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23959 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23960 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23961 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23962 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23963
23964 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23965 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23966 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23967 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23968 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23969 reached their retry times.
23970
23971 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23972 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23973 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23974 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23975 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23976 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23977 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23978 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23979 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23980 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23981 reached.
23982
23983 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23984 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23985 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23986 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23987 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23988 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23989
23990 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23991 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23992 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23993 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23994 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23995 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23996
23997
23998
23999
24000
24001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24002 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24003
24004 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24005 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24006 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24007 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24008 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24009 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24010
24011 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24012 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24013 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24014 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24015 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24016 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24017 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24018
24019 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24020 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24021 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24022 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24023
24024
24025 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24026 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24027 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24028 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24029
24030 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24031 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24032 facility; you do not have to use it.
24033
24034 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24035 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24036 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24037 address to which it applies.
24038
24039 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24040 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24041 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24042 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24043 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24044 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24045 rules.
24046
24047 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24048 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24049 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24050 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24051
24052
24053 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24054 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24055 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24056 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24057 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24058 discouraged.
24059
24060 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24061 illustrated by these examples:
24062
24063 .ilist
24064 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24065 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24066 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24067 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24068 .next
24069 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24070 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24071 .endlist
24072
24073
24074
24075 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24076 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24077 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24078 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24079 message's processing.
24080
24081 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24082 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24083 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24084 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24085 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24086 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24087 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24088 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24089 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24090
24091 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24092 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24093 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24094 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24095 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24096 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24097 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24098 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24099 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24100 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24101
24102 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24103 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24104 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24105 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24106 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24107 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24108
24109 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24110 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24111 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24112
24113 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24114 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24115 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24116 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24117 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24118 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24119 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24120 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24121 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24122
24123 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24124 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24125 transport time.
24126
24127
24128
24129
24130 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24131 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24132 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24133 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24134 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24135 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24136 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24137 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24138 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24139 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24140 .code
24141 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24142 .endd
24143 might produce the output
24144 .code
24145 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24146 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24147 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24148 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24149 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24150 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24151 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24152 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24153 .endd
24154 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24155 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24156 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24157 set for a particular transport.
24158
24159
24160 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24161 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24162 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24163 rules in the form
24164 .display
24165 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24166 .endd
24167 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24168 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24169 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24170 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24171
24172 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24173 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24174 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24175 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24176 ignored.
24177
24178 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24179 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24180 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24181
24182 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24183 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24184 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24185 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24186 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24187 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24188 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24189
24190 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24191 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24192 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24193 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24194 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24195 .code
24196 *@* ${lookup ...
24197 .endd
24198 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24199 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24200
24201
24202 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24203 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24204 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24205 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24206 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24207 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24208 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24209 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24210 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24211
24212 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24213 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24214 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24215
24216 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24217 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24218 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24219 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24220 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24221 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24222 of pattern they are set as follows:
24223
24224 .ilist
24225 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24226 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24227 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24228 pattern
24229 .code
24230 *queen@*.fict.example
24231 .endd
24232 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24233 .code
24234 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24235 $1 = hearts-
24236 $2 = wonderland
24237 .endd
24238 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24239 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24240
24241 .next
24242 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24243 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24244 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24245 rewriting rule of the form
24246 .display
24247 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24248 .endd
24249 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24250 .code
24251 $1 = foo
24252 $2 = bar
24253 $3 = baz.example
24254 .endd
24255 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24256 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24257 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24258 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24259 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24260 .endlist
24261
24262
24263 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24264 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24265 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24266 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24267 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24268 .code
24269 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24270 .endd
24271 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24272 &'From:'& headers.
24273
24274 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24275 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24276 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24277 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24278 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24279 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24280 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24281 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24282 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24283 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24284 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24285 entry written to the panic log.
24286
24287
24288
24289 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24290 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24291
24292 .ilist
24293 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24294 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24295 .next
24296 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24297 .next
24298 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24299 .endlist
24300
24301 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24302 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24303
24304
24305
24306 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24307 "SECID154"
24308 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24309 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24310 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24311 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24312 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24313 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24314 .display
24315 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24316 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24317 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24318 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24319 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24320 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24321 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24322 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24323 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24324 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24325 .endd
24326 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24327 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24328 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24329
24330 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24331 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24332
24333
24334 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24335 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24336 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24337 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24338 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24339 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24340 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24341 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24342 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24343
24344 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24345 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24346 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24347 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24348 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24349 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24350 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24351 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24352
24353
24354 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24355 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24356 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24357 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24358
24359 .ilist
24360 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24361 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24362 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24363 .next
24364 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24365 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24366 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24367 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24368 .next
24369 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24370 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24371 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24372 .next
24373 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24374 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24375 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24376 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24377 .code
24378 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24379 .endd
24380 into
24381 .code
24382 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24383 .endd
24384 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24385 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24386 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24387 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24388 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24389 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24390 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24391 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24392 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
24393
24394 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24395 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24396 .endlist
24397
24398
24399 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24400 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24401 .code
24402 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24403 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24404 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24405 .endd
24406 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24407 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24408 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24409 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24410 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24411 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24412 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24413 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24414
24415 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24416 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24417 .code
24418 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24419 .endd
24420 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24421 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24422
24423 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24424 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24425 messages that originate outside the local host:
24426 .code
24427 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24428 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24429 .endd
24430 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24431 space.
24432
24433 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24434 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24435 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24436 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24437 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24438 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24439 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24440 components. For example, the rule
24441 .code
24442 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24443 .endd
24444 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24445 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24446 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24447 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24448 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24449 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24450 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24451 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24452
24453
24454
24455
24456
24457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24459
24460 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24461 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24462 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24463 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24464 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24465 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24466 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24467 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24468 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24469 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24470 address, domain and error.
24471
24472 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24473 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24474 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24475 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24476 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24477 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24478 log selector is set, the message
24479 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24480 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24481 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24482 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24483
24484 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24485 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24486 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24487 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24488 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24489 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24490 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24491 domain are maintained independently.
24492
24493 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24494 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24495 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24496 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24497 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24498 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24499 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24500 the local address is reached.
24501
24502 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24503 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24504 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24505 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24506 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24507
24508 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24509 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24510 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24511 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24512 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24513 messages that it should now be retaining.
24514
24515
24516
24517 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24518 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24519 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24520 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24521 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24522 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24523 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24524 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24525 message's sender, respectively.
24526
24527
24528 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24529 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24530 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24531 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24532 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24533 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24534 example,
24535 .code
24536 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24537 .endd
24538 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24539 whereas
24540 .code
24541 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24542 .endd
24543 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24544 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24545 part.
24546
24547 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24548 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24549 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24550 expressions work in address lists.
24551 .display
24552 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24553 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24554 .endd
24555
24556
24557 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24558 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24559 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24560 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24561 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24562 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24563 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24564 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24565 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24566
24567 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24568 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24569 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24570 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24571 local transports).
24572
24573 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24574 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24575 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24576 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24577 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24578 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24579 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24580 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24581 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24582 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24583 commands.
24584
24585
24586
24587 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24588 "SECID160"
24589 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24590 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24591 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24592 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24593 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24594 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24595 .code
24596 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24597 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24598 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24599 .endd
24600 and the retry rules are
24601 .code
24602 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24603 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24604 .endd
24605 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24606 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24607 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24608 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24609 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24610 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24611
24612 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24613 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24614 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24615 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24616
24617 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24618 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24619 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24620 .code
24621 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24622 .endd
24623 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24624 textual form of the IP address.
24625
24626 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24627 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24628 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24629 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24630
24631 .vlist
24632 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24633 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24634 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24635
24636 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24637 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24638 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24639
24640 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24641 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24642
24643 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24644 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24645 .endlist
24646
24647 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24648 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24649 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24650 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24651 retry rule of this form:
24652 .code
24653 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24654 .endd
24655 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24656 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24657
24658 .vlist
24659 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24660 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24661 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24662 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24663
24664 .vitem &%lookup%&
24665 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24666 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24667 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24668 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24669 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24670
24671 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24672 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24673
24674 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24675 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24676
24677 .vitem &%refused%&
24678 A connection was refused.
24679
24680 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24681 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24682
24683 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24684 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24685
24686 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24687 A connection attempt timed out.
24688
24689 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24690 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24691 obtained from an MX record.
24692
24693 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24694 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24695 obtained from an MX record.
24696
24697 .vitem &%timeout%&
24698 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24699
24700 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24701 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24702 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24703 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24704
24705 .vitem &%quota%&
24706 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24707 transport.
24708
24709 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24710 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24711 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24712 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24713 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24714 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24715 for four days.
24716 .endlist
24717
24718 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24719 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24720 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24721 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24722 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24723 heuristic rules:
24724
24725 .ilist
24726 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24727 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24728 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24729 .next
24730 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24731 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24732 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24733 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24734 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24735 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24736 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24737 .next
24738 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24739 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24740 .endlist
24741
24742 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24743 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24744 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24745 error).
24746
24747
24748
24749 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24750 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24751 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24752 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24753 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24754 form:
24755 .display
24756 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24757 .endd
24758 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24759 .code
24760 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24761 .endd
24762 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24763 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24764 For example:
24765 .code
24766 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24767 .endd
24768 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24769 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24770 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24771 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24772 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24773
24774 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24775 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24776 .code
24777 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24778 .endd
24779 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24780 list is never matched.
24781
24782
24783
24784
24785
24786 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24787 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24788 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24789 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24790 .display
24791 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24792 .endd
24793 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24794 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24795 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24796 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24797 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24798
24799 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24800 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24801 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24802 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24803 The available algorithms are:
24804
24805 .ilist
24806 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24807 the interval.
24808 .next
24809 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24810 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24811 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24812 .next
24813 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24814 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24815 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24816 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24817 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24818 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24819 queue processing times.
24820 .endlist
24821
24822 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24823 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24824 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24825 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24826 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24827 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24828 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24829 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24830 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24831 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24832 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24833 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24834
24835 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24836 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24837 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24838 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24839 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24840 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24841 time.
24842
24843 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24844 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24845 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24846 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24847 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24848 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24849 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24850 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24851 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24852 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24853 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24854 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24855
24856 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24857 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24858 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24859 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24860 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24861 deliveries that have been deferred.
24862
24863
24864 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24865 Here are some example retry rules:
24866 .code
24867 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24868 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24869 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24870 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24871 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24872 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24873 .endd
24874 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24875 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24876 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24877 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24878 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24879 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24880 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24881 days.
24882
24883 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24884 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24885 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24886 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24887 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24888
24889 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24890 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24891 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24892 were not obtained from an MX record.
24893
24894 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24895 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24896 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24897 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24898 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24899
24900
24901
24902 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24903 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24904 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24905 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24906 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24907 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24908 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24909 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24910 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24911 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24912 failing for the first time.
24913
24914 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24915 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24916 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24917 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24918
24919 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24920 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24921 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24922
24923
24924
24925
24926 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24927 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24928 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24929 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24930 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24931 default retry rule:
24932 .code
24933 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24934 .endd
24935 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24936 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24937 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24938
24939 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24940 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24941 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24942 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24943 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24944
24945 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24946 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24947 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24948
24949 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24950 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24951 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24952 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24953 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24954 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24955 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24956 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24957
24958 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24959 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24960 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24961 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24962 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24963 notice.
24964
24965 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24966 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24967 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24968 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24969 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24970 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24971 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24972 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24973 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24974 true.
24975
24976 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24977 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24978 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24979 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24980 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24981 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24982 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24983 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24984 reached.
24985
24986 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24987 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24988 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24989 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24990 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24991 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24992 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24993 time out the address.
24994
24995 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24996 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24997 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24998 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24999 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25000 considered immediately.
25001 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25002 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25003
25004
25005
25006
25007
25008
25009 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25010 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25011
25012 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25013 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25014 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25015 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25016 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25017 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25018 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25019 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25020 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25021 other.
25022
25023 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25024 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25025
25026 .ilist
25027 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25028 the client's EHLO command.
25029 .next
25030 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25031 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25032 .next
25033 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25034 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25035 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25036 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25037 with the AUTH command.
25038 .next
25039 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25040 .next
25041 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25042 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25043 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25044 connection.
25045 .next
25046 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25047 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25048 unauthenticated connection.
25049 .endlist
25050
25051 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25052 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25053 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25054 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25055 .display
25056 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25057 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25058 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25059 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25060 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25061 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25062 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25063 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25064 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25065 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25066 &`250 HELP`&
25067 .endd
25068 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25069 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25070 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25071 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25072 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25073 included by setting
25074 .code
25075 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25076 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25077 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25078 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25079 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25080 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25081 AUTH_SPA=yes
25082 AUTH_TLS=yes
25083 .endd
25084 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25085 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25086 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25087 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25088 work via a socket interface.
25089 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25090 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25091 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25092 supporting setting a server keytab.
25093 The sixth can be configured to support
25094 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25095 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25096 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25097 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25098 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25099
25100 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25101 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25102 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25103 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25104 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25105 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25106 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25107
25108 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25109 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25110 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25111 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25112 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25113 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25114 .code
25115 cram:
25116 driver = cram_md5
25117 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25118 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25119 client_name = ph10
25120 client_secret = secret2
25121 .endd
25122 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25123 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25124
25125 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25126 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25127 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25128 in Exim.
25129
25130 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25131 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25132 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25133 authenticating data.
25134
25135 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25136 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25137 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25138 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25139 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25140 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25141 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25142 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25143 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25144 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25145 choose to honour.
25146
25147 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25148 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25149 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25150 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25151
25152
25153
25154 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25155 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25156 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25157
25158 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25159 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25160 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25161 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25162 encrypted by a setting such as:
25163 .code
25164 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25165 .endd
25166
25167
25168 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25169 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25170 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25171 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25172
25173
25174 .option driver authenticators string unset
25175 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25176 authenticators is to be used.
25177
25178
25179 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25180 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25181 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25182 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25183 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25184 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25185
25186
25187 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25188 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25189 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25190 mechanism is not advertised.
25191 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25192 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25193 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25194
25195
25196 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25197 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25198 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25199 for details.
25200
25201 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25202 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25203
25204 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25205 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25206 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25207 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25208 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25209 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25210 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25211 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25212 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25213 the error text.
25214
25215
25216 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25217 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25218 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25219 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25220 out the values of variables.
25221 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25222 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25223
25224
25225 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25226 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25227 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25228 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25229 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25230 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25231 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25232 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25233 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25234
25235
25236 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25237 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25238 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25239 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25240 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25241 remembered for later use.
25242 How it is used is described in the following section.
25243
25244
25245
25246
25247
25248 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25249 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25250 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25251 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25252 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25253 message:
25254
25255 .ilist
25256 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25257 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25258 .next
25259 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25260 .next
25261 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25262 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25263 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25264 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25265 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25266 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25267 given for the MAIL command.
25268 .next
25269 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25270 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25271 authenticated.
25272 .next
25273 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25274 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25275 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25276 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25277 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25278 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25279 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25280 message.
25281 .endlist
25282
25283
25284 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25285 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25286 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25287 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25288
25289 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25290 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25291 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25292 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25293 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25294 ACL is run.
25295
25296
25297
25298 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25299 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25300 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25301 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25302 conditions:
25303
25304 .ilist
25305 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25306 .next
25307 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25308 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25309 .endlist
25310
25311 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25312 the mechanisms are advertised.
25313
25314 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25315 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25316 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25317 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25318 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25319 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25320 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25321 .code
25322 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25323 .endd
25324 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25325
25326 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25327 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25328 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25329 such as:
25330 .code
25331 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25332 .endd
25333 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25334 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25335 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25336
25337 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25338 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25339 command. This is the case if
25340
25341 .ilist
25342 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25343 .next
25344 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25345 .next
25346 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25347 server authenticators.
25348 .endlist
25349
25350
25351 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25352 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25353 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25354
25355 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25356 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25357 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25358 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25359 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25360 rejected with a 504 error.
25361
25362 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25363 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25364 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25365 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25366 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25367 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25368 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25369 no successful authentication.
25370
25371
25372
25373
25374 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25375 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25376 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25377 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25378 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25379 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25380 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25381 script:
25382 .code
25383 use MIME::Base64;
25384 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25385 .endd
25386 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25387 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25388 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25389 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25390 command line to run this script on such data might be
25391 .code
25392 encode '\0user\0password'
25393 .endd
25394 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25395 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25396 whose code value is zero.
25397
25398 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25399 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25400 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25401 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25402
25403 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25404 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25405 example, a command such as
25406 .code
25407 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25408 .endd
25409 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25410
25411 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25412 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25413 .code
25414 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25415 .endd
25416 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25417 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25418 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25419 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25420
25421
25422
25423 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25424 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25425 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25426 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25427 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25428 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25429
25430 .ilist
25431 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25432 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25433 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25434 of the authenticator.
25435 .next
25436 .vindex "&$host$&"
25437 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25438 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25439 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25440 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25441 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25442 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25443 delivery to be deferred.
25444 .next
25445 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25446 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25447 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25448 usual way.
25449 .next
25450 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25451 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25452 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25453 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25454 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25455 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25456 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25457 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25458 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25459 .endlist
25460
25461 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25462 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25463 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25464 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25465 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25466 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25467 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25468 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25469 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25470 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25471 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25472 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25473 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25474
25475
25476
25477
25478
25479
25480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25482
25483 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25484 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25485 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25486 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25487 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25488 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25489 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25490 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25491 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25492 connections as you do for login accounts.
25493
25494 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25495 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25496 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25497
25498 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25499 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25500 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25501
25502 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25503 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25504 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25505 given.
25506
25507 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25508 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25509 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25510 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25511 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25512 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25513 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25514
25515 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25516 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25517 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25518 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25519 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25520 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25521 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25522
25523 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25524 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25525 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25526 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25527
25528 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25529 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25530 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25531
25532 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25533 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25534 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25535 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25536 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25537 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25538 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25539 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25540 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25541 string as the error text
25542
25543 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25544 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25545 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25546
25547
25548
25549 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25550 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25551 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25552 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25553 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25554 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25555 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25556 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25557
25558 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25559 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25560 configured as follows:
25561 .code
25562 fixed_plain:
25563 driver = plaintext
25564 public_name = PLAIN
25565 server_prompts = :
25566 server_condition = \
25567 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25568 server_set_id = $auth2
25569 .endd
25570 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25571 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25572 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25573 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25574
25575 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25576 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25577 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25578 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25579 .code
25580 250-AUTH PLAIN
25581 .endd
25582 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25583 .code
25584 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25585 .endd
25586 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25587 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25588 .code
25589 AUTH PLAIN
25590 .endd
25591 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25592 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25593
25594 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25595 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25596 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25597 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25598 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25599
25600 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25601 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25602 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25603
25604 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25605 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25606 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25607 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25608 This is an incorrect example:
25609 .code
25610 server_condition = \
25611 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25612 .endd
25613 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25614 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25615 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25616 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25617 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25618 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25619 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25620 .code
25621 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25622 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25623 .endd
25624 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25625 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25626 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25627 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25628 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25629
25630
25631 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25632 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25633 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25634 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25635 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25636 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25637 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25638 .code
25639 fixed_login:
25640 driver = plaintext
25641 public_name = LOGIN
25642 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25643 server_condition = \
25644 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25645 server_set_id = $auth1
25646 .endd
25647 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25648 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25649 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25650 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25651
25652 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25653 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25654 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25655 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25656 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25657 .code
25658 login:
25659 driver = plaintext
25660 public_name = LOGIN
25661 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25662 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25663 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25664 ldapauth{\
25665 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25666 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25667 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25668 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25669 .endd
25670 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25671 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25672 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25673 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25674 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25675 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25676 uninterpreted string.
25677
25678
25679 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25680 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25681 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25682 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25683 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25684 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25685
25686
25687
25688
25689 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25690 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25691 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25692
25693 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25694 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25695 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25696 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25697 usual.
25698
25699 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25700 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25701 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25702 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25703 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25704 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25705 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25706 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25707 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25708 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25709 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25710 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25711
25712 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25713 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25714
25715 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25716 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25717 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25718 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25719 the string.
25720
25721 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25722 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25723 .code
25724 fixed_plain:
25725 driver = plaintext
25726 public_name = PLAIN
25727 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25728 .endd
25729 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25730 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25731 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25732 .code
25733 fixed_login:
25734 driver = plaintext
25735 public_name = LOGIN
25736 client_send = : username : mysecret
25737 .endd
25738 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25739 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25740 prompts.
25741 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25742 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25743
25744
25745
25746
25747 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25749
25750 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25751 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25752 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25753 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25754 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25755 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25756 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25757 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25758 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25759 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25760 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25761 available in plain text at either end.
25762
25763
25764 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25765 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25766 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25767 authenticator as a server:
25768
25769 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25770 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25771 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25772 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25773 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25774 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25775 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25776 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25777 returned to the client.
25778
25779 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25780 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25781 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25782 numeric variables for other things.
25783
25784 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25785 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25786 user name, authentication fails.
25787 .code
25788 fixed_cram:
25789 driver = cram_md5
25790 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25791 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25792 server_set_id = $auth1
25793 .endd
25794 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25795 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25796 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25797 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25798 .code
25799 lookup_cram:
25800 driver = cram_md5
25801 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25802 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25803 {$value}fail}
25804 server_set_id = $auth1
25805 .endd
25806 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25807 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25808
25809 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25810 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25811 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25812 realm, with:
25813 .code
25814 cyrusless_crammd5:
25815 driver = cram_md5
25816 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25817 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25818 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25819 server_set_id = $auth1
25820 .endd
25821
25822 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25823 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25824 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25825
25826
25827
25828 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25829 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25830 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25831
25832
25833 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25834 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25835 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25836
25837
25838 .vindex "&$host$&"
25839 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25840 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25841 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25842 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25843 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25844 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25845 send the message to the current server.
25846
25847 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25848 strings, is:
25849 .code
25850 fixed_cram:
25851 driver = cram_md5
25852 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25853 client_name = ph10
25854 client_secret = secret
25855 .endd
25856 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25857 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25858
25859
25860
25861 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25863
25864 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25865 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25866 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25867 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25868 .cindex "Kerberos"
25869 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25870 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25871
25872 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25873 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25874 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25875 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25876 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25877
25878 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25879 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25880 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25881 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25882
25883 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25884 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25885 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25886 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25887 depending on the driver you are using.
25888
25889 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25890 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25891 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25892 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25893 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25894 implementation.
25895
25896 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25897 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25898 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25899 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25900 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25901 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25902 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25903 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25904
25905
25906 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25907 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25908 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25909 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25910 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25911 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25912 things.
25913
25914
25915 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25916 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25917 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25918 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25919
25920
25921 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25922 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25923 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25924 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25925 example:
25926 .code
25927 sasl:
25928 driver = cyrus_sasl
25929 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25930 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25931 server_set_id = $auth1
25932 .endd
25933
25934 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25935 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25936
25937
25938 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25939 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25940
25941
25942 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25943 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25944 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25945 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25946 .code
25947 sasl_cram_md5:
25948 driver = cyrus_sasl
25949 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25950 server_set_id = $auth1
25951
25952 sasl_plain:
25953 driver = cyrus_sasl
25954 public_name = PLAIN
25955 server_set_id = $auth2
25956 .endd
25957 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25958 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25959 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25960 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25961 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25962
25963
25964
25965
25966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25967 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25968 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25969 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25970 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25971 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25972 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25973 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25974 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25975 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25976 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25977
25978 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25979
25980 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25981 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25982 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25983 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25984 .code
25985 dovecot_plain:
25986 driver = dovecot
25987 public_name = PLAIN
25988 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25989 server_set_id = $auth1
25990
25991 dovecot_ntlm:
25992 driver = dovecot
25993 public_name = NTLM
25994 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25995 server_set_id = $auth1
25996 .endd
25997 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25998 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25999 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26000 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26001 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26002 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26003 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26004 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26005
26006
26007 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26008 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26009 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26010 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26011 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26012 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26013 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26014 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26015 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26016 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26017 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26018 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26019 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26020 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26021 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26022 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26023 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26024 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26025 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26026 without code changes in Exim.
26027
26028
26029 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26030 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26031 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26032 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26033 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26034 context.
26035
26036 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26037 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26038 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26039
26040 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26041 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26042 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26043
26044 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26045 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26046 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26047
26048
26049 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26050 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26051 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26052 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26053
26054
26055 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26056 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26057 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26058 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26059 example:
26060 .code
26061 sasl:
26062 driver = gsasl
26063 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26064 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26065 server_set_id = $auth1
26066 .endd
26067
26068
26069 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26070 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26071 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26072 the password itself.
26073
26074 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26075 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26076 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26077 if available, else the empty string.
26078 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26079 else the empty string.
26080
26081 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26082
26083 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26084 option to be simply "true".
26085
26086
26087 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26088 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26089 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26090
26091
26092 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26093 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26094 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26095 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26096
26097
26098 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26099 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26100 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26101 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26102
26103
26104 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26105 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26106 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26107
26108
26109 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26110 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26111 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26112 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26113
26114 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26115 meanings for these variables:
26116
26117 .ilist
26118 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26119 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26120 .next
26121 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26122 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26123 .next
26124 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26125 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26126 .endlist
26127
26128 On a per-mechanism basis:
26129
26130 .ilist
26131 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26132 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26133 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26134 .next
26135 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26136 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26137 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26138 .next
26139 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26140 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26141 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26142 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26143 .endlist
26144
26145 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26146 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26147 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26148
26149
26150 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26151 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26152 .code
26153 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26154 driver = gsasl
26155 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26156 server_realm = imap.example.org
26157 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26158 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26159 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26160 server_condition = yes
26161 .endd
26162
26163
26164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26166
26167 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26168 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26169 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26170 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26171 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26172 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26173 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26174 reliably.
26175
26176 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26177 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26178 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26179 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26180
26181 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26182 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26183 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26184 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26185
26186 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26187 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26188 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26189 from the keytab.
26190
26191
26192 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26193 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26194 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26195 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26196
26197 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26198 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26199 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26200 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26201
26202 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26203 .ilist
26204 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26205 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26206 .next
26207 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26208 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26209 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26210 GSS Display Name.
26211 .endlist
26212
26213
26214 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26215 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26216
26217 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26218 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26219 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26220 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26221 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26222 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26223 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26224 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26225 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26226 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26227 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26228 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26229 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26230 follows:
26231
26232 .ilist
26233 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26234 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26235 .next
26236 The server sends back a challenge.
26237 .next
26238 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26239 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26240 .endlist
26241
26242 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26243
26244
26245
26246 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26247 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26248 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26249
26250 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26251 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26252 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26253 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26254 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26255 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26256 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26257 for other things. For example:
26258 .code
26259 spa:
26260 driver = spa
26261 public_name = NTLM
26262 server_password = \
26263 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26264 .endd
26265 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26266 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26267
26268
26269
26270
26271
26272 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26273 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26274 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26275
26276
26277
26278 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26279 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26280
26281
26282 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26283 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26284
26285
26286 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26287 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26288 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26289 &'msn.com'&:
26290 .code
26291 msn:
26292 driver = spa
26293 public_name = MSN
26294 client_username = msn/msn_username
26295 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26296 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26297 .endd
26298 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26299 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26300
26301
26302
26303
26304
26305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26306 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26307
26308 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26309 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26310 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26311 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26312 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26313 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26314 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26315 authentication based on client certificates.
26316
26317 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26318 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26319 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26320 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26321 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26322 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26323
26324 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26325 for which it must have been requested via the
26326 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26327 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26328
26329 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26330 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26331 and can authenticate the connection.
26332 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26333
26334 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26335
26336
26337 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26338 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26339
26340 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26341 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26342 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26343 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26344 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26345 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26346
26347 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26348 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26349 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26350
26351 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26352
26353
26354 Example:
26355 .code
26356 tls:
26357 driver = tls
26358 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26359 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26360 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26361 {!= {0} \
26362 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26363 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26364 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26365 } } } }
26366 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26367 .endd
26368 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26369 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26370
26371
26372 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26373 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26374 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26375
26376
26377
26378 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26379 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26380
26381 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26382 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26383 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26384 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26385 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26386 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26387 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26388 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26389 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26390 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26391 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26392 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26393 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26394 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26395 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26396 certificates are used.
26397
26398 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26399 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26400 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26401 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26402 between them is encrypted.
26403
26404 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26405 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26406 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26407 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26408 encryption state.
26409
26410 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26411 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26412 in order to get TLS to work.
26413
26414
26415
26416 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26417 "SECID284"
26418 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26419 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26420 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26421 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26422 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26423 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26424 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26425 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26426 allocated for this purpose.
26427
26428 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26429 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26430 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26431 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26432 .code
26433 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26434 .endd
26435 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26436 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26437 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26438 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26439 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26440 defined elsewhere.
26441
26442 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26443 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26444
26445
26446
26447
26448
26449
26450 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26451 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26452 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26453 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26454 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26455 .code
26456 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26457 .endd
26458 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26459 .code
26460 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26461 .endd
26462 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26463 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26464
26465 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26466
26467 .ilist
26468 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26469 cannot be the path of a directory
26470 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26471 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26472 .next
26473 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26474 .next
26475 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26476 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26477 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26478 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26479 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26480 .next
26481 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26482 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26483 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26484 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26485 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26486 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26487 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26488 option).
26489 .next
26490 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26491 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26492 .next
26493 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26494 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26495 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26496 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26497 .next
26498 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26499 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26500 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26501 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26502 .endlist
26503
26504
26505 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26506 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26507 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26508 but not the chosen filename.
26509 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26510 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26511
26512 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26513 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26514 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26515 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26516 of bits requested.
26517 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26518 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26519 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26520 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26521 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26522 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26523 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26524
26525 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26526 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26527 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26528 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26529 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26530
26531 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26532 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26533 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26534 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26535 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26536 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26537
26538 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26539 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26540 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26541
26542 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26543 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26544 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26545 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26546 .code
26547 # ls
26548 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26549 # rm -f new-params
26550 # touch new-params
26551 # chown exim:exim new-params
26552 # chmod 0600 new-params
26553 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26554 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26555 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26556 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26557 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26558 # chmod 0400 new-params
26559 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26560 .endd
26561 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26562 stalling is removed.
26563
26564 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26565 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26566 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26567 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26568 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26569 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26570 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26571 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26572 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26573 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26574 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26575
26576 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26577 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26578 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26579 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26580
26581 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26582 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26583 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26584 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26585 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26586
26587
26588 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26589 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26590 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26591 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26592 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26593 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26594 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26595 directly to this function call.
26596 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26597 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26598 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26599 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26600
26601 .ilist
26602 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26603 .next
26604 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26605 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26606 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26607 SSL v3 algorithms.
26608 .next
26609 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26610 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26611 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26612 algorithms.
26613 .endlist
26614
26615 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26616 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26617 .ilist
26618 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26619 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26620 stated.
26621 .next
26622 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26623 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26624 .next
26625 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26626 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26627 .endlist
26628
26629 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26630 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26631 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26632 not be moved to the end of the list.
26633 .endlist
26634
26635 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26636 string:
26637 .code
26638 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26639 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26640 .endd
26641
26642 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26643 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26644 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26645 choice of clients used:
26646 .code
26647 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26648 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26649 {DEFAULT}\
26650 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26651 .endd
26652
26653
26654
26655 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26656 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26657 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26658 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26659 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26660 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26661 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26662 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26663 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26664 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26665 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26666 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26667
26668 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26669 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26670
26671 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26672 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26673 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26674 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26675 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26676 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26677
26678 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26679 "Priority strings". This is online as
26680 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26681 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26682 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26683 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26684 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26685
26686 For example:
26687 .code
26688 # Disable older versions of protocols
26689 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26690 .endd
26691
26692 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26693 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26694 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26695
26696 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26697 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26698 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26699 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26700 used:
26701 .code
26702 # GnuTLS variant
26703 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26704 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26705 {SECURE128}}
26706 .endd
26707
26708
26709 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26710 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26711 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26712 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26713 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26714 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26715 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26716 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26717
26718 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26719 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26720 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26721 with the error
26722 .code
26723 554 Security failure
26724 .endd
26725 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26726 rejected with a 554 error code.
26727
26728 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26729 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26730 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26731 without some further configuration at the server end.
26732
26733 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26734 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26735 .code
26736 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26737 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26738 .endd
26739 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26740 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26741 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26742 that goes with it. These files need to be
26743 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26744 always be given as full path names.
26745 The key must not be password-protected.
26746 They can be the same file if both the
26747 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26748 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26749 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26750 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26751 the server's certificate.
26752
26753 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26754 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26755 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26756
26757 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26758 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26759 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26760 transport.
26761
26762 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26763 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26764 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26765 .code
26766 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26767 .endd
26768 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26769 with the parameters contained in the file.
26770 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26771 available:
26772 .code
26773 tls_dhparam = none
26774 .endd
26775 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26776 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26777 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26778 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26779
26780 See the command
26781 .code
26782 openssl dhparam
26783 .endd
26784 for a way of generating file data.
26785
26786 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26787 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26788 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26789 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26790 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26791
26792 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26793 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26794 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26795 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26796 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26797 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26798 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26799 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26800 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26801
26802 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26803 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26804 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26805 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26806 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26807 documentation for more details.
26808
26809 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26810 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26811
26812
26813 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26814 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26815 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26816 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26817 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26818 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26819 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26820 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26821 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26822 expected certificates.
26823 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26824 an explicit file or,
26825 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26826 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26827
26828 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26829 directory is used
26830 (OpenSSL only),
26831 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26832 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26833 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26834 .code
26835 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26836 .endd
26837 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26838
26839 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26840 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26841 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26842 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26843 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26844 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26845 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26846 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26847 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26848 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26849
26850 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26851 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26852 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26853 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26854
26855 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26856 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26857 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26858 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26859 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26860 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26861
26862
26863 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26864 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26865 .cindex "revocation list"
26866 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26867 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26868 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26869 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26870 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26871 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26872 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26873 CRL in PEM format.
26874 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26875 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26876
26877 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26878 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26879 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26880 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26881 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26882 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26883
26884 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26885 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26886 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26887 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26888
26889 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26890 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26891 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26892 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26893 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26894 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26895 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26896 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26897
26898 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26899 .new
26900 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
26901 .wen
26902 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26903
26904 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26905 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26906 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26907 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26908 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26909
26910 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26911 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26912 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26913 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26914 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26915 next connection.
26916
26917 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26918 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26919 ignored.
26920
26921 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26922 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26923 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26924 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26925 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26926 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26927
26928 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26929 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26930
26931 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26932
26933 .code
26934 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26935 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26936 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26937
26938 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26939 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26940 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26941 .endd
26942
26943
26944
26945
26946 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26947 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26948 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26949 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26950 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26951 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26952 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26953 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26954 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26955
26956 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26957 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26958 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26959 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26960 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26961
26962 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26963 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26964 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26965 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26966 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26967 usual way.
26968
26969 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26970 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26971 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26972 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26973 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26974 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26975 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26976 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26977 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26978 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26979 unencrypted.
26980
26981 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26982 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26983 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26984 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26985
26986 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26987 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26988 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26989 a file or,
26990 depending on library version, a directory,
26991 must name a file or,
26992 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26993 The client verifies the server's certificate
26994 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26995 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26996 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26997 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26998
26999 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27000 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27001 or need not succeed respectively.
27002
27003 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27004 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27005 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27006 value is empty.
27007 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27008 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27009 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27010 otherwise.
27011
27012 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27013 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27014 for OCSP to be relevant.
27015
27016 If
27017 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27018 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27019 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27020 alternative hosts, if any.
27021
27022 &*Note*&:
27023 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27024 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27025 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27026 client.
27027
27028 .vindex "&$host$&"
27029 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27030 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27031 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27032 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27033 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27034
27035 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27036 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27037 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27038 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27039 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27040 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27041 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27042 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27043 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27044 outgoing connection.
27045
27046
27047
27048 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27049 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27050 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27051 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27052 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27053 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27054 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27055 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27056 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27057 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27058 for this session.
27059
27060 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27061 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27062 address.
27063
27064 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27065 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27066 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27067 be of limited use in that environment.
27068
27069 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27070 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27071 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27072 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27073 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27074
27075 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27076 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27077 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27078 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27079 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27080
27081 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27082 received from a client.
27083 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27084
27085 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27086 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27087 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27088
27089 .ilist
27090 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27091 &%tls_certificate%&
27092 .next
27093 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27094 &%tls_crl%&
27095 .next
27096 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27097 &%tls_privatekey%&
27098 .next
27099 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27100 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27101 .next
27102 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27103 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27104 .endlist
27105
27106 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27107 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27108 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27109 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27110
27111 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27112 are re-expanded.
27113
27114 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27115 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27116 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27117 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27118
27119 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27120 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27121 built, then you have SNI support).
27122
27123
27124
27125 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27126 "SECTmulmessam"
27127 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27128 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27129 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27130 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27131 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27132 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27133 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27134 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27135 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27136 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27137 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27138
27139 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27140 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27141 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27142 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27143 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27144 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27145 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27146 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27147 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27148
27149 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27150 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27151 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27152 information is recorded.
27153
27154 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27155 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27156 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27157
27158
27159
27160
27161 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27162 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27163 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27164 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27165 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27166 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27167 to Apache, currently at
27168 .display
27169 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27170 .endd
27171 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27172 links to further files.
27173 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27174 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27175 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27176 .display
27177 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27178 .endd
27179
27180
27181 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27182 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27183 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27184 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27185 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27186 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27187 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27188 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27189 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27190 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27191 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27192 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27193 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27194
27195 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27196 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27197 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27198 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27199
27200
27201
27202 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27203 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27204 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27205 with OpenSSL, like this:
27206 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27207 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27208 .code
27209 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27210 -days 9999 -nodes
27211 .endd
27212 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27213 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27214 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27215 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27216 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27217 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27218 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27219
27220 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27221 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27222 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27223 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27224 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27225 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27226 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27227 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27228 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27229 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27230 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27231 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27232 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27233 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27234 be a sensible resolution).
27235
27236 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27237 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27238 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27239
27240 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27241 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27242 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27243 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27244 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27245 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27246
27247 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27248 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27249 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27250 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27251 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27252 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27253
27254
27255
27256 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27258
27259 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27260 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27261 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27262 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27263 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27264 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27265 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27266 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27267 one very small ACL:
27268 .code
27269 begin acl
27270 small_acl:
27271 accept hosts = one.host.only
27272 .endd
27273 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27274 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27275
27276 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27277 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27278 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27279 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27280 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27281 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27282 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27283 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27284
27285
27286 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27287 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27288 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27289 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27290 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27291
27292
27293
27294 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27295 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27296 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27297 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27298 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27299 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27300 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27301 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27302 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27303 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27304 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27305 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27306 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27307 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27308 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27309 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27310 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27311 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27312 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27313 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27314
27315 .table2 140pt
27316 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27317 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27318 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27319 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27320 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27321 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27322 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27323 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27324 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27325 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27326 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27327 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27328 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27329 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27330 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27331 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27332 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27333 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27334 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27335 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27336 .endtable
27337
27338 For example, if you set
27339 .code
27340 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27341 .endd
27342 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27343 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27344 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27345 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27346 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27347 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27348 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27349
27350
27351 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27352 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27353 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27354 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27355 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27356 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27357 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27358 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27359 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27360 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27361 in any of these ACLs.
27362
27363 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27364 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27365 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27366 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27367 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27368 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27369 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27370 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27371 .code
27372 control = suppress_local_fixups
27373 .endd
27374 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27375 run, it is too late.
27376
27377 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27378 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27379
27380 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27381 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27382 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27383
27384
27385 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27386 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27387 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27388 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27389 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27390 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27391 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27392 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27393 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27394
27395
27396 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27397 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27398 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27399 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27400 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27401 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27402 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27403 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27404 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27405
27406 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27407 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27408 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27409 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27410 an EHLO response.
27411
27412
27413 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27414 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27415 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27416 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27417 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27418 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27419 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27420 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27421 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27422 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27423
27424 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27425 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27426 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27427 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27428 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27429 associated with the DATA command.
27430
27431 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27432 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27433 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27434 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27435 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27436 your resources.
27437
27438 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27439 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27440 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27441 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27442
27443 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27444 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27445 enabled (which is the default).
27446
27447 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27448 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27449 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27450
27451 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27452
27453 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27454
27455
27456 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27457 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27458 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27459
27460 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27461
27462
27463 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27464 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27465 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27466 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27467 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27468 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27469 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27470 has been accepted.
27471
27472 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27473 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27474 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27475 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27476 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27477 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27478 for some or all recipients.
27479
27480 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27481 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27482 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27483 .new
27484 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27485 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27486 is &"yes"&.
27487 .wen
27488 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27489 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27490 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27491
27492 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27493 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27494
27495 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27496 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27497 the feature was not requested by the client.
27498
27499 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27500 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27501 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27502 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27503 does not in fact control any access.
27504 For this reason, it may only accept
27505 or warn as its final result.
27506
27507 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27508 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27509 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27510 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27511
27512 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27513 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27514
27515 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27516 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27517 response to QUIT.
27518
27519 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27520 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27521 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27522 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27523 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27524
27525
27526 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27527 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27528 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27529 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27530 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27531 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27532 situation even worse.
27533
27534 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27535 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27536 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27537 and &%warn%&.
27538
27539 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27540 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27541 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27542 connection. The possible values are:
27543 .table2
27544 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27545 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27546 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27547 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27548 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27549 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27550 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27551 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27552 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27553 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27554 .endtable
27555 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27556 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27557 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27558 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27559 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27560 used.
27561
27562
27563 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27564 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27565 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27566 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27567 .code
27568 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27569 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27570 .endd
27571 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27572 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27573 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27574 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27575 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27576
27577 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27578 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27579 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27580
27581 .ilist
27582 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27583 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27584 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27585 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27586 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27587 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27588 .code
27589 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27590 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27591 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27592 .endd
27593 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27594 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27595 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27596 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27597 .next
27598 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27599 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27600 matches the string.
27601 .next
27602 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27603 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27604 want to have something like
27605 .code
27606 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27607 .endd
27608 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27609 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27610 .endlist
27611
27612
27613
27614
27615 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27616 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27617 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27618 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27619 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27620 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27621 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27622 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27623 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27624
27625 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27626 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27627 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27628
27629
27630 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27631 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27632 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27633 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27634
27635 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27636 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27637 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27638 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27639 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27640 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27641 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27642
27643
27644 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27645 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27646 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27647
27648
27649
27650 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27651 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27652 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27653 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27654 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27655 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27656
27657 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27658 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27659 used to accept or reject anything.
27660
27661 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27662 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27663 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27664 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27665
27666 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27667 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27668 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27669 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27670 configuration file.
27671
27672
27673
27674
27675 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27676 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27677 .vindex &$domain$&
27678 .vindex &$local_part$&
27679 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27680 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27681 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27682 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27683 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27684 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27685 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27686 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27687 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27688
27689 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27690 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27691 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27692 how it is used.
27693
27694 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27695 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27696 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27697 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27698 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27699 received).
27700
27701 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27702 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27703 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27704 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27705 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27706 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27707 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27708 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27709
27710
27711
27712
27713
27714 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27715 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27716 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27717 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27718 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27719 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27720 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27721 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27722 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27723 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27724 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27725 unencrypted connections.
27726 .code
27727 acl_check_auth:
27728 accept encrypted = *
27729 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27730 {CRAM-MD5}}
27731 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27732 .endd
27733 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27734 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27735 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27736 option to do this.)
27737
27738
27739
27740 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27741 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27742 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27743 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27744 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27745 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27746 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27747
27748 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27749 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27750 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27751 example:
27752 .code
27753 deny dnslists = list1.example
27754 dnslists = list2.example
27755 .endd
27756 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27757 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27758 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27759 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27760 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27761
27762
27763 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27764 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27765
27766 .ilist
27767 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27768 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27769 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27770 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27771 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27772 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27773 check a RCPT command:
27774 .code
27775 accept domains = +local_domains
27776 endpass
27777 verify = recipient
27778 .endd
27779 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27780 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27781 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27782 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27783 &%endpass%&.
27784
27785 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27786 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27787 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27788 configuration.
27789
27790 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27791 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27792 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27793 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27794 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27795 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27796 .display
27797 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27798 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27799 .endd
27800 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27801 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27802 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27803
27804 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27805 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27806 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27807 of &%endpass%&.
27808
27809
27810 .next
27811 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27812 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27813 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27814 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27815 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27816 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27817 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27818
27819
27820 .next
27821 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27822 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27823 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27824 example,
27825 .code
27826 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27827 .endd
27828 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27829
27830
27831 .next
27832 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27833 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27834 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27835 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27836 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27837 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27838 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27839 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27840 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27841
27842 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27843 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27844 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27845
27846
27847 .next
27848 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27849 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27850 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27851 .code
27852 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27853 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27854 .endd
27855 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27856 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27857
27858 .next
27859 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27860 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27861 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27862 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27863 .code
27864 require message = Sender did not verify
27865 verify = sender
27866 .endd
27867 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27868 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27869 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27870 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27871
27872 .next
27873 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27874 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27875 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27876 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27877 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27878 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27879 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27880
27881 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27882 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27883 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27884 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27885 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27886
27887 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27888 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27889 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27890 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27891 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27892 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27893 onwards.
27894
27895
27896 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27897 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27898 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27899 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27900 .code
27901 warn !verify = sender
27902 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27903 .endd
27904 .endlist
27905
27906 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27907
27908 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27909 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27910 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27911 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27912 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27913
27914
27915
27916 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27917 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27918 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27919 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27920 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27921 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27922 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27923 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27924 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27925 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27926 .ilist
27927 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27928 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27929 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27930 on the same SMTP connection.
27931 .next
27932 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27933 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27934 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27935 .endlist
27936
27937 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27938 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27939 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27940 .code
27941 accept hosts = whatever
27942 set acl_m4 = some value
27943 accept authenticated = *
27944 set acl_c_auth = yes
27945 .endd
27946 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27947 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27948 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27949
27950 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27951 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27952 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27953 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27954 error is generated.
27955
27956 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27957 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27958
27959
27960 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27961 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27962 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27963 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27964 .code
27965 deny domains = *.dom.example
27966 !verify = recipient
27967 .endd
27968 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27969 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27970 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27971 two statements are equivalent:
27972 .code
27973 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27974 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27975 .endd
27976 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27977 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27978
27979 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27980 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27981 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27982 .code
27983 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27984 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27985 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27986 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27987 .endd
27988 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27989 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27990 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27991 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27992 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27993 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27994 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27995
27996 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27997 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27998 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27999 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28000 message is handled.
28001
28002 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28003 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28004 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28005 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28006 .code
28007 require message = Can't verify sender
28008 verify = sender
28009 message = Can't verify recipient
28010 verify = recipient
28011 message = This message cannot be used
28012 .endd
28013 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28014 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28015 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28016 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28017 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28018 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28019
28020 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28021 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28022 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28023 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28024 .code
28025 deny hosts = ...
28026 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28027 message = Invalid sender from client host
28028 .endd
28029 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28030 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28031
28032
28033
28034 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28035 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28036 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28037
28038 .vlist
28039 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28040 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28041 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28042 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28043
28044 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28045 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28046 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28047 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28048 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28049 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28050 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28051 write rather ugly lines like this:
28052 .display
28053 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28054 .endd
28055 Instead, all you need is
28056 .display
28057 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28058 .endd
28059
28060 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28061 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28062 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28063 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28064 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28065 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28066 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28067 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28068
28069 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28070 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28071 in several different ways. For example:
28072
28073 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28074 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28075 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28076 . ==== way.
28077
28078 .ilist
28079 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28080 .code
28081 accept ...some conditions
28082 control = queue_only
28083 .endd
28084 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28085 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28086
28087 .next
28088 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28089 .code
28090 accept ...some conditions...
28091 control = queue_only
28092 ...some more conditions...
28093 .endd
28094 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28095 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28096 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28097 to be relevant.
28098
28099 .next
28100 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28101 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28102 example:
28103 .code
28104 warn ...some conditions...
28105 control = freeze
28106 accept ...
28107 .endd
28108 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28109 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28110 log entry.
28111
28112 .next
28113 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28114 &%require%& verb. For example:
28115 .code
28116 require control = no_multiline_responses
28117 .endd
28118 .endlist
28119
28120 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28121 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28122 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28123 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28124 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28125 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28126 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28127 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28128 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28129
28130 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28131 example:
28132 .code
28133 deny ...some conditions...
28134 delay = 30s
28135 .endd
28136 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28137 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28138 .code
28139 deny delay = 30s
28140 ...some conditions...
28141 .endd
28142 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28143 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28144 .code
28145 warn ...some conditions...
28146 delay = 2m
28147 control = freeze
28148 accept ...
28149 .endd
28150
28151 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28152 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28153 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28154 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28155 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28156 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28157 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28158
28159
28160 .vitem &*endpass*&
28161 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28162 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28163 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28164 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28165 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28166 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28167 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28168
28169
28170 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28171 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28172 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28173 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28174 .code
28175 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28176 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28177 .endd
28178 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28179 example:
28180 .display
28181 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28182 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28183 .endd
28184 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28185 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28186 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28187 message.
28188
28189 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28190 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28191 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28192 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28193 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28194 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28195 ignored.
28196
28197 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28198 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28199 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28200 error message.
28201
28202 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28203 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28204 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28205 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28206 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28207 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28208
28209 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28210 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28211 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28212 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28213 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28214 logging rejections.
28215
28216
28217 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28218 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28219 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28220 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28221 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28222 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28223 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28224 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28225 .display
28226 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28227 &` log_reject_target =`&
28228 .endd
28229 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28230 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28231 current ACL.
28232
28233
28234 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28235 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28236 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28237 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28238 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28239 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28240 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28241 ACLs. For example:
28242 .display
28243 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28244 &` control = freeze`&
28245 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28246 .endd
28247 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28248 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28249 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28250 example:
28251 .code
28252 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28253 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28254 .endd
28255
28256
28257 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28258 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28259 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28260 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28261 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28262 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28263 &%accept%& for details.)
28264
28265 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28266 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28267 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28268 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28269 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28270 .code
28271 require message = Host not recognized
28272 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28273 .endd
28274 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28275 processed.)
28276
28277 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28278 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28279 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28280 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28281 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28282 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28283 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28284 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28285 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28286 EHLO options.
28287
28288 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28289 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28290 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28291 .code
28292 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28293 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28294 .endd
28295 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28296 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28297 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28298 2&'xx'&.
28299
28300 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28301 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28302
28303 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28304 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28305 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28306 response.
28307
28308 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28309 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28310 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28311
28312 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28313 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28314 However, the original message is available in the variable
28315 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28316 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28317 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28318 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28319
28320 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28321 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28322 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28323 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28324 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28325 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28326 effect.
28327
28328
28329 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28330 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28331 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28332 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28333
28334
28335 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28336 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28337 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28338 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28339
28340
28341 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28342 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28343 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28344 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28345 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28346 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28347 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28348 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28349 when:
28350 .code
28351 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28352 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28353 .endd
28354 .endlist
28355
28356
28357
28358
28359 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28360 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28361 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28362
28363 .vlist
28364 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28365 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28366 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28367 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28368 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28369 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28370 not work without it. For example:
28371 .code
28372 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28373 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28374 .endd
28375 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28376 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28377 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28378 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28379 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28380
28381
28382 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28383 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28384 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28385 .cindex "case of local parts"
28386 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28387 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28388 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28389 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28390 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28391 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28392 is encountered.
28393
28394 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28395 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28396 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28397 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28398 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28399
28400 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28401 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28402 spam score:
28403 .code
28404 warn control = caseful_local_part
28405 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28406 $acl_m4 + \
28407 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28408 }
28409 control = caselower_local_part
28410 .endd
28411 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28412 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28413
28414
28415 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28416 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28417 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28418 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28419
28420 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28421 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28422 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28423 is used for all recipients of the message,
28424 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28425 and data is copied from one to the other.
28426
28427 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28428 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28429 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28430 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28431 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28432 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28433
28434 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28435 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28436 Note also that headers cannot be
28437 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28438 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28439
28440 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28441 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28442 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28443 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28444
28445 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28446 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28447 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28448 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28449 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28450 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28451
28452 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28453 (possibly faked)
28454 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28455
28456
28457 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28458 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28459 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28460 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28461 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28462 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28463 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28464 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28465 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28466 contexts):
28467 .code
28468 control = debug
28469 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28470 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28471 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28472 .endd
28473
28474
28475 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28476 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28477 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28478 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28479 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28480
28481
28482 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28483 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28484 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28485 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28486 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28487 strings or to numeric value.
28488 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28489 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28490 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28491
28492 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28493 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28494 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28495 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28496 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28497
28498
28499 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28500 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28501 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28502 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28503 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28504 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28505 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28506 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28507
28508 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28509 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28510 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28511 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28512 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28513 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28514 work with.
28515
28516
28517 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28518 .cindex "fake defer"
28519 .cindex "defer, fake"
28520 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28521 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28522 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28523 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28524 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28525
28526 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28527 .cindex "fake rejection"
28528 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28529 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28530 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28531 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28532 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28533 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28534 the same SMTP connection.
28535
28536 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28537 message is supplied, the following is used:
28538 .code
28539 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28540 550-kept for evaluation.
28541 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28542 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28543 .endd
28544 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28545
28546 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28547 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28548 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28549 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28550 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28551 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28552 SMTP connection.
28553
28554 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28555 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28556 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28557 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28558
28559 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28560 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28561 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28562 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28563 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28564 disables such output flushing.
28565
28566 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28567 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28568 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28569 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28570 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28571 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28572
28573 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28574 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28575 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28576 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28577 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28578 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28579 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28580 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28581 to be useful in production.
28582
28583 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28584 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28585 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28586 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28587 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28588
28589 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28590 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28591 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28592 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28593 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28594 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28595
28596 .ilist
28597 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28598 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28599 verification failed"&) is sent.
28600 .next
28601 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28602 line is output.
28603 .endlist
28604
28605 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28606 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28607
28608 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28609 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28610 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28611 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28612 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28613 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28614 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28615
28616 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28617 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28618 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28619 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28620 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28621 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28622 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28623 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28624 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28625 same SMTP connection.
28626
28627 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28628 .cindex "message" "submission"
28629 .cindex "submission mode"
28630 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28631 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28632 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28633 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28634 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28635 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28636 late (the message has already been created).
28637
28638 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28639 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28640 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28641 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28642 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28643
28644 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28645 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28646 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28647 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28648 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28649
28650 .ilist
28651 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28652 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28653 .next
28654 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28655 .next
28656 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28657 .endlist ilist
28658
28659 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28660 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28661 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28662 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28663 data is read.
28664
28665 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28666 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28667 .endlist vlist
28668
28669
28670 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28671 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28672
28673 .ilist
28674 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28675 .next
28676 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28677 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28678 .next
28679 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28680 .next
28681 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28682 .endlist
28683
28684
28685
28686 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28687 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28688 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28689 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28690 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28691 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28692 .code
28693 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28694 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28695 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28696 .endd
28697 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28698 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28699 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28700 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28701 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28702 RCPT ACL).
28703
28704 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28705 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28706
28707 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28708 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28709 contains one or more newlines that
28710 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28711 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28712 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28713
28714 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28715 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28716 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28717 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28718 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28719 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28720 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28721 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28722 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28723 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28724 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28725
28726 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28727 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28728 of message headers
28729 until they are added to the
28730 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28731 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28732 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28733 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28734 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28735 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28736 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28737
28738 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28739
28740 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28741 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28742 .display
28743 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28744 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28745
28746 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28747 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28748 .endd
28749 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28750 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28751 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28752 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28753 honoured.
28754
28755 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28756 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28757 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28758 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28759 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28760 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28761 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28762 specifications.
28763
28764 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28765 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28766 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28767 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28768 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28769
28770 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28771 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28772 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28773 to be a header name first.) For example:
28774 .code
28775 warn add_header = \
28776 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28777 .endd
28778 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28779 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28780 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28781 up in reverse order.
28782
28783 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28784 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28785 system filter or in a router or transport.
28786
28787
28788
28789 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28790 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28791 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28792 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28793 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28794 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28795 .code
28796 warn message = Remove internal headers
28797 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28798 .endd
28799 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28800 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28801 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28802 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28803 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28804 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28805
28806 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28807 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28808
28809 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28810 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28811 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28812 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28813 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28814 .code
28815 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28816 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28817 warn message = Remove internal headers
28818 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28819 .endd
28820 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28821 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28822 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28823 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28824 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28825 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28826 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28827 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28828 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28829 would have been removed.
28830
28831 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28832 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28833 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28834 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28835 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28836 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28837 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28838 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28839 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28840
28841 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28842 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28843 .display
28844 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28845 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28846
28847 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28848 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28849 .endd
28850 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28851 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28852 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28853 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28854 are honoured.
28855
28856 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28857 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28858 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28859
28860
28861
28862
28863 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28864 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28865 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28866 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28867 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28868 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28869
28870 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28871 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28872 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28873 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28874 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28875 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28876 The conditions are as follows:
28877
28878
28879 .vlist
28880 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28881 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28882 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28883 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28884 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28885 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28886 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28887 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28888 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28889 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28890 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28891 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28892
28893 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28894 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28895 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28896 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28897 The name and values are expanded separately.
28898 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28899 will act as argument separators.
28900
28901 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28902 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28903 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28904 conditions are tested.
28905
28906 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28907 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28908 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28909 for different local users or different local domains.
28910
28911 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28912 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28913 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28914 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28915 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28916 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28917 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28918 .code
28919 authenticated = *
28920 .endd
28921
28922 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28923 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28924 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28925 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28926 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28927 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28928 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28929 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28930 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28931 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28932 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28933 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28934 negative.
28935
28936 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28937 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28938 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28939 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28940 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28941 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28942 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28943 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28944
28945 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28946 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28947 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28948 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28949 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28950
28951 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28952 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28953 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28954 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28955 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28956 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28957 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28958 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28959 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28960 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28961
28962 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28963 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28964 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28965 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28966 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28967 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28968 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28969 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28970 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28971 &%domains%& test.
28972
28973 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28974 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28975
28976
28977 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28978 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28979 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28980 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28981 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28982 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28983 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28984 .code
28985 encrypted = *
28986 .endd
28987
28988
28989 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28990 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28991 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28992 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28993 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28994 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28995 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28996 .code
28997 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28998 .endd
28999 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29000 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29001 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29002
29003 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29004 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29005 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29006 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29007 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29008 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29009
29010 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29011 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29012 .code
29013 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29014 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29015 .endd
29016 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29017 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29018 statement can then check the IP address.
29019
29020 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29021 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29022 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29023 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29024 .code
29025 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29026 message = $host_data
29027 .endd
29028 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29029
29030 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29031 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29032 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29033 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29034 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29035 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29036 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29037 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29038 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29039 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29040
29041 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29042 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29043 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29044 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29045 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29046 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29047 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29048
29049 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29050 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29051 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29052 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29053 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29054 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29055 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29056 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29057
29058 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29059 .cindex "rate limiting"
29060 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29061 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29062
29063 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29064 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29065 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29066 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29067 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29068 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29069
29070 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29071 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29072 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29073 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29074 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29075 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29076 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29077
29078 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29079 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29080 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29081 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29082 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29083 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29084 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29085 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29086 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29087 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29088 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29089 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29090 influence the sender checking.
29091
29092 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29093 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29094
29095 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29096 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29097 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29098 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29099 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29100 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29101 .code
29102 senders = :
29103 .endd
29104 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29105 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29106
29107 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29108 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29109 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29110 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29111 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29112 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29113
29114 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29115 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29116 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29117 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29118 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29119 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29120 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29121 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29122 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29123 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29124
29125 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29126 .cindex "CSA verification"
29127 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29128 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29129 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29130
29131 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29132 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29133 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29134 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29135 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29136 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29137 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29138 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29139 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29140 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29141
29142 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29143 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29144 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29145
29146 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29147 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29148 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29149 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29150 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29151 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29152 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29153 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29154 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29155 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29156 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29157 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29158 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29159 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29160 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29161
29162 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29163 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29164 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29165 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29166 .code
29167 deny senders = :
29168 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29169 !verify = header_sender
29170 .endd
29171
29172 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29173 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29174 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29175 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29176 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29177 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29178 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29179 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29180 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29181 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29182 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29183 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29184 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29185 appropriate.
29186
29187 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29188 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29189 .code
29190 To: @
29191 .endd
29192 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29193 common as they used to be.
29194
29195 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29196 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29197 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29198 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29199 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29200 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29201 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29202 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29203 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29204 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29205 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29206 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29207 independently of this condition.
29208
29209 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29210 option), this condition is always true.
29211
29212
29213 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29214 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29215 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29216 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29217 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29218 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29219 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29220 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29221 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29222
29223 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29224 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29225
29226
29227 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29228 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29229 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29230 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29231 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29232 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29233 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29234 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29235 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29236 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29237 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29238 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29239 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29240 value for the child address.
29241
29242 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29243 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29244 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29245 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29246 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29247 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29248 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29249 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29250 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29251 original IP address.
29252
29253 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29254 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29255
29256 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29257 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29258
29259 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29260 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29261 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29262 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29263 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29264 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29265 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29266 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29267 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29268
29269 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29270 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29271 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29272 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29273 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29274 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29275 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29276
29277 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29278 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29279 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29280
29281 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29282 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29283 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29284 verified as a sender.
29285 .endlist
29286
29287
29288
29289 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29290 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29291 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29292 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29293 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29294 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29295 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29296 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29297 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29298 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29299 .code
29300 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29301 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29302 .endd
29303 the following records are looked up:
29304 .code
29305 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29306 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29307 .endd
29308 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29309 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29310 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29311 use two separate conditions:
29312 .code
29313 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29314 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29315 .endd
29316 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29317 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29318 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29319 processed.
29320
29321 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29322 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29323 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29324 following special items in the list:
29325 .display
29326 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29327 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29328 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29329 .endd
29330 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29331 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29332 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29333 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29334 .code
29335 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29336 .endd
29337 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29338 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29339 .code
29340 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29341 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29342 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29343 .endd
29344 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29345 .cindex DNS TTL
29346 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29347 .new
29348 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29349 .wen
29350 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29351 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29352 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29353 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29354
29355
29356
29357 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29358 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29359 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29360 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29361 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29362 .code
29363 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29364 .endd
29365 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29366 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29367 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29368 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29369
29370
29371
29372
29373 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29374 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29375 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29376 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29377 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29378 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29379 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29380 .code
29381 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29382 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29383 .endd
29384 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29385 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29386 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29387 up by this example is
29388 .code
29389 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29390 .endd
29391 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29392 addresses. For example:
29393 .code
29394 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29395 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29396 .endd
29397 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29398 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29399
29400
29401
29402
29403 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29404 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29405 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29406 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29407 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29408 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29409 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29410 either to double the separators like this:
29411 .code
29412 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29413 .endd
29414 or to change the separator character, like this:
29415 .code
29416 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29417 .endd
29418 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29419 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29420 occurs. Consider this condition:
29421 .code
29422 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29423 .endd
29424 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29425 .code
29426 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29427 a.domain.black.list.tld
29428 .endd
29429 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29430 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29431 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29432 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29433 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29434 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29435 error for a previous item.
29436
29437 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29438 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29439 .code
29440 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29441 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29442 .endd
29443 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29444 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29445 .code
29446 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29447 $sender_address_domain \
29448 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29449 see $dnslist_text.
29450 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29451 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29452 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29453 .endd
29454 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29455 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29456 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29457 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29458 .code
29459 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29460 .endd
29461 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29462 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29463
29464 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29465 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29466
29467
29468
29469
29470 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29471 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29472 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29473 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29474 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29475 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29476 .display
29477 127.1.0.1 RBL
29478 127.1.0.2 DUL
29479 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29480 127.1.0.4 RSS
29481 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29482 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29483 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29484 .endd
29485 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29486 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29487 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29488
29489
29490 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29491 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29492 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29493 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29494 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29495 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29496 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29497 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29498 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29499 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29500 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29501 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29502 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29503 cases, for example:
29504 .code
29505 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29506 .endd
29507 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29508 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29509 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29510 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29511 .code
29512 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29513 .endd
29514 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29515 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29516
29517 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29518 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29519 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29520 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29521 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29522 information.
29523
29524 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29525 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29526 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29527 .code
29528 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29529 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29530 at $dnslist_domain
29531 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29532 .endd
29533
29534
29535
29536 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29537 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29538 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29539 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29540 For example,
29541 .code
29542 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29543 .endd
29544 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29545 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29546 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29547 describes how multiple records are handled.
29548
29549 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29550 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29551 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29552 .code
29553 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29554 .endd
29555 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29556 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29557 first. For example:
29558 .code
29559 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29560 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29561 .endd
29562
29563 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29564 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29565 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29566 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29567 tested. For example:
29568 .code
29569 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29570 .endd
29571 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29572 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29573 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29574 .code
29575 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29576 .endd
29577 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29578 an odd number.
29579
29580
29581
29582 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29583 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29584 condition. Whereas
29585 .code
29586 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29587 .endd
29588 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29589 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29590 .code
29591 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29592 .endd
29593 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29594 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29595 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29596 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29597
29598 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29599 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29600
29601 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29602 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29603 .code
29604 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29605 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29606 .endd
29607 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29608 Consider this example:
29609 .code
29610 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29611 list.dsbl.org : \
29612 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29613 relays.ordb.org
29614 .endd
29615 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29616 .code
29617 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29618 list.dsbl.org
29619 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29620 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29621 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29622 .endd
29623 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29624
29625
29626
29627
29628 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29629 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29630 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29631 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29632 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29633 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29634 .code
29635 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29636 .endd
29637 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29638 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29639 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29640 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29641 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29642 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29643
29644 .ilist
29645 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29646 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29647 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29648 .next
29649 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29650 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29651 changed to:
29652 .code
29653 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29654 .endd
29655 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29656 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29657 .code
29658 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29659 .endd
29660 for the condition to be true.
29661 .endlist
29662
29663 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29664 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29665 .ilist
29666 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29667 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29668 .code
29669 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29670 .endd
29671 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29672 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29673 .next
29674 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29675 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29676 .code
29677 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29678 .endd
29679 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29680 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29681 .code
29682 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29683 .endd
29684 for the condition to be false.
29685 .endlist
29686 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29687 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29688
29689
29690
29691
29692 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29693 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29694 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29695 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29696 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29697 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29698 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29699 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29700 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29701 lists.
29702
29703 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29704 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29705 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29706 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29707 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29708 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29709 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29710 .code
29711 reject message = \
29712 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29713 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29714 dnslists = \
29715 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29716 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29717 .endd
29718 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29719 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29720 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29721 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29722 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29723 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29724
29725 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29726 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29727 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29728 .code
29729 reject dnslists = \
29730 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29731 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29732 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29733 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29734 .endd
29735 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29736 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29737 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29738
29739
29740
29741 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29742 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29743 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29744 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29745 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29746 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29747 .code
29748 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29749 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29750 .endd
29751 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29752 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29753 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29754 .code
29755 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29756 .endd
29757 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29758 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29759
29760 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29761 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29762 .code
29763 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29764 dnslists = some.list.example
29765 .endd
29766
29767 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29768 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29769 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29770 .code
29771 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29772 .endd
29773
29774 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29775 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29776 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29777 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29778 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29779 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29780 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29781 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29782 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29783 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29784 .display
29785 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29786 .endd
29787 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29788 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29789
29790 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29791 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29792 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29793 of &'p'&.
29794
29795 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29796 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29797 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29798 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29799 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29800 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29801 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29802 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29803 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29804
29805 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29806 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29807 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29808 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29809
29810 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29811 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29812 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29813 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29814 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29815 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29816 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29817 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29818 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29819 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29820
29821 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29822 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29823 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29824 ACL.
29825
29826 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29827 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29828 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29829 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29830 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29831 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29832
29833 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29834 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29835 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29836 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29837 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29838 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29839 the &%count=%& option.
29840
29841
29842 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29843 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29844 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29845 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29846 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29847
29848 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29849 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29850 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29851 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29852
29853 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29854 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29855 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29856 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29857 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29858 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29859 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29860
29861 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29862 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29863 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29864 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29865 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29866 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29867 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29868
29869 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29870 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29871 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29872 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29873 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29874
29875 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29876 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29877 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29878 multiple different commands.
29879
29880 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29881 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29882 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29883 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29884 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29885
29886 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29887
29888
29889 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29890 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29891 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29892 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29893 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29894
29895 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29896 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29897
29898 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29899 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29900 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29901 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29902 new rate.
29903 .code
29904 acl_check_connect:
29905 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29906 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29907 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29908 # ...
29909 acl_check_mail:
29910 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29911 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29912 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29913 .endd
29914
29915 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29916 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29917 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29918 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29919 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29920 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29921 checks.
29922
29923 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29924 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29925 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29926 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29927 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29928
29929
29930 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29931 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29932 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29933 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29934 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29935 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29936 rest of the ACL.
29937
29938 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29939 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29940 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29941 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29942 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29943 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29944 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29945 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29946 from getting any email through.
29947
29948 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29949 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29950 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29951 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29952 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29953 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29954 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29955 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29956 .code
29957 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29958 .endd
29959
29960
29961 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29962 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29963 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29964 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29965 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29966 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29967 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29968 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29969 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29970
29971 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29972 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29973 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29974 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29975 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29976 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29977
29978 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29979 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29980 rate.
29981
29982 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29983 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29984 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29985 required increases with larger limits.
29986
29987 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29988 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29989 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29990 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29991 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29992 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29993 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29994 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29995 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29996 as intended.
29997
29998
29999 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30000 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30001 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30002 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30003 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30004 message. For example:
30005 .code
30006 # Log all senders' rates
30007 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30008 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30009
30010 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30011 # at the decimal point.
30012 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30013 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30014 $sender_rate_limit }s
30015
30016 # Keep authenticated users under control
30017 deny authenticated = *
30018 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30019
30020 # System-wide rate limit
30021 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30022 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30023
30024 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30025 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30026 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30027 messages per $sender_rate_period
30028 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30029 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30030 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30031 .endd
30032 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30033 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30034 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30035 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30036 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30037 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30038 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30039
30040
30041
30042 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30043 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30044 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30045 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30046 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30047 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30048 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30049 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30050 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30051 .code
30052 verify = sender/callout
30053 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30054 .endd
30055 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30056 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30057 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30058 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30059 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30060 The available options are as follows:
30061
30062 .ilist
30063 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30064 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30065 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30066 .next
30067 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30068 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30069 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30070 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30071 .next
30072 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30073 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30074 .next
30075 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30076 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30077 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30078 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30079 .endlist
30080
30081 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30082 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30083 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30084 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30085 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30086 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30087 coding like this:
30088 .code
30089 warn !verify = sender
30090 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30091 .endd
30092 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30093 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30094 verification failure.
30095
30096 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30097 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30098
30099 .ilist
30100 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30101 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30102 .next
30103 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30104 .next
30105 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30106 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30107 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30108 .next
30109 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30110 .next
30111 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30112 .endlist
30113
30114 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30115 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30116
30117
30118
30119
30120 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30121 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30122 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30123 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30124 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30125 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30126 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30127 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30128 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30129 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30130 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30131 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30132 sender's domain.
30133
30134 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30135 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30136 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30137 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30138 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30139 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30140
30141 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30142 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30143 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30144 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30145 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30146
30147 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30148 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30149 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30150 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30151 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30152 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30153 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30154 supplies a host list.
30155 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30156
30157 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30158 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30159 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30160 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30161 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30162 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30163 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30164
30165 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30166 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30167 following SMTP commands are sent:
30168 .display
30169 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30170 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30171 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30172 &`QUIT`&
30173 .endd
30174 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30175 set to &"lmtp"&.
30176
30177 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30178 settings.
30179
30180 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30181 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30182 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30183 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30184 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30185 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30186
30187 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30188 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30189 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30190 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30191 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30192
30193 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30194 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30195 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30196 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30197 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30198
30199
30200
30201
30202 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30203 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30204 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30205 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30206 .code
30207 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30208 .endd
30209 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30210 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30211 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30212
30213
30214 .vlist
30215 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30216 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30217 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30218 For example:
30219 .code
30220 verify = sender/callout=5s
30221 .endd
30222 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30223 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30224 the &%connect%& parameter.
30225
30226
30227 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30228 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30229 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30230 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30231 .code
30232 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30233 .endd
30234 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30235
30236 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30237 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30238 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30239 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30240 updated in this circumstance.
30241
30242 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30243 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30244 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30245 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30246 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30247 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30248
30249
30250 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30251 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30252 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30253 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30254 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30255 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30256 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30257 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30258 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30259 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30260 .code
30261 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30262 .endd
30263 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30264
30265
30266 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30267 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30268 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30269 For example:
30270 .code
30271 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30272 .endd
30273 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30274 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30275 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30276 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30277 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30278
30279
30280 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30281 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30282 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30283 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30284
30285 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30286 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30287 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30288 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30289 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30290 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30291 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30292 made, until the cache record expires.
30293
30294 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30295 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30296 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30297 For example:
30298 .code
30299 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30300 .endd
30301 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30302 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30303 .code
30304 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30305 .endd
30306 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30307 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30308 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30309 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30310
30311
30312 .vitem &*random*&
30313 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30314 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30315 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30316 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30317 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30318 .code
30319 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30320 .endd
30321 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30322 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30323 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30324 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30325 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30326
30327 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30328 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30329 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30330 .code
30331 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30332 .endd
30333 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30334 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30335 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30336 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30337 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30338
30339 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30340 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30341 .code
30342 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30343 .endd
30344 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30345 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30346 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30347 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30348 usefulness of callout caching.
30349 .endlist
30350
30351 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30352 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30353 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30354 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30355 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30356 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30357 these circumstances.
30358
30359 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30360 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30361 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30362 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30363 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30364 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30365 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30366
30367 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30368 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30369 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30370 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30371
30372
30373
30374
30375 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30376 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30377 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30378 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30379 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30380 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30381 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30382 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30383 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30384 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30385
30386 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30387 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30388 is not available.
30389
30390 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30391 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30392 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30393
30394 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30395 commands up to and including
30396 .code
30397 MAIL FROM:<>
30398 .endd
30399 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30400 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30401 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30402 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30403 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30404 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30405 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30406
30407 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30408 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30409 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30410 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30411 will eventually be noticed.
30412
30413 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30414 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30415 behaviour will be the same.
30416
30417
30418
30419 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30420 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30421 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30422 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30423 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30424 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30425 you might see:
30426 .code
30427 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30428 250 OK
30429 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30430 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30431 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30432 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30433 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30434 550 Sender verification failed
30435 .endd
30436 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30437 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30438 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30439 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30440 example:
30441 .code
30442 verify = sender/no_details
30443 .endd
30444
30445 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30446 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30447 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30448 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30449 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30450 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30451 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30452
30453 .ilist
30454 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30455 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30456 verification also fails.
30457 .next
30458 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30459 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30460 .endlist
30461
30462 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30463 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30464 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30465 .code
30466 A.Wol: aw123
30467 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30468 .endd
30469 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30470 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30471 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30472 verification to succeed.
30473
30474 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30475 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30476 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30477 option. For example:
30478 .code
30479 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30480 .endd
30481 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30482 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30483
30484 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30485 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30486 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30487 address and a report is output for each of them.
30488
30489
30490
30491 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30492 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30493 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30494 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30495 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30496 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30497 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30498 .code
30499 verify = csa
30500 .endd
30501 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30502 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30503 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30504 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30505 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30506 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30507
30508 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30509 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30510 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30511 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30512
30513 .ilist
30514 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30515 .next
30516 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30517 .next
30518 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30519 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30520 .next
30521 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30522 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30523 .endlist
30524
30525 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30526 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30527 .code
30528 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30529 .endd
30530 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30531 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30532 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30533 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30534 meaningful to say:
30535 .code
30536 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30537 .endd
30538 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30539 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30540 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30541
30542 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30543 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30544 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30545 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30546 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30547 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30548 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30549 of legitimate HELO domains.
30550
30551 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30552 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30553 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30554 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30555 lookup such as:
30556 .code
30557 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30558 .endd
30559 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30560 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30561 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30562
30563
30564
30565
30566 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30567 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30568 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30569 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30570 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30571 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30572 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30573 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30574
30575 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30576 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30577 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30578 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30579 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30580 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30581 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30582
30583 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30584 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30585 like this:
30586 .code
30587 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30588 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30589 }{$value}}
30590 .endd
30591 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30592 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30593 use this:
30594 .code
30595 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30596 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30597 senders = :
30598 recipients = +batv_senders
30599
30600 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30601 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30602 senders = :
30603 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30604 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30605 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30606 .endd
30607 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30608 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30609 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30610 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30611 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30612
30613 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30614 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30615 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30616 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30617 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30618 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30619 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30620
30621 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30622 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30623 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30624 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30625 .code
30626 batv_redirect:
30627 driver = redirect
30628 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30629 .endd
30630 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30631 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30632 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30633 local addresses.
30634
30635 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30636 can be used:
30637 .code
30638 external_smtp_batv:
30639 driver = smtp
30640 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30641 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30642 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30643 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30644 {$value}fail}}}
30645 .endd
30646 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30647
30648
30649
30650 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30651 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30652 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30653 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30654 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30655 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30656 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30657 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30658 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30659 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30660
30661 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30662 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30663 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30664 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30665 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30666 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30667 . ///
30668 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30669 . ///
30670 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30671 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30672 system to arbitrary domains.
30673
30674
30675 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30676 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30677 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30678 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30679
30680 .ilist
30681 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30682 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30683 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30684 .next
30685 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30686 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30687 .next
30688 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30689 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30690 .endlist
30691
30692
30693 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30694 .code
30695 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30696 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30697 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30698 .endd
30699 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30700 command:
30701 .code
30702 acl_check_rcpt:
30703 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30704 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30705 .endd
30706 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30707 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30708 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30709 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30710 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30711 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30712 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30713
30714
30715
30716 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30717 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30718 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30719 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30720 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30721
30722 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30723 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30724 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30725 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30726 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30727 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30728 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30729 .ecindex IIDacl
30730
30731
30732
30733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30735
30736 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30737 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30738 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30739 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30740 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30741 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30742 specification.
30743
30744 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30745 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30746 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30747 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30748 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30749
30750 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30751 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30752 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30753
30754 .ilist
30755 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30756 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30757 .next
30758 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30759 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30760 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30761 .next
30762 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30763 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30764 .next
30765 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30766 conditions.
30767 .next
30768 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30769 .endlist
30770
30771 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30772 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30773 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30774
30775 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30776 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30777 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30778 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30779 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30780 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30781
30782 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30783 temporarily created in a file called:
30784 .display
30785 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30786 .endd
30787 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30788 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30789 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30790 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30791 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30792 .code
30793 control = no_mbox_unspool
30794 .endd
30795 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30796 same directory by default.
30797
30798
30799
30800 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30801 .cindex "virus scanning"
30802 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30803 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30804 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30805 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30806 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30807 in memory and thus are much faster.
30808
30809 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30810 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30811
30812 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30813 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30814 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30815 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30816 .display
30817 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30818 .endd
30819 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30820 .code
30821 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30822 .endd
30823 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30824 before use.
30825 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30826 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30827
30828 .vlist
30829 .vitem &%avast%&
30830 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30831 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30832 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
30833 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30834 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30835 This scanner type takes one option,
30836 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30837 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30838 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30839 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30840 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30841 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30842 For example:
30843 .code
30844 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30845 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30846 .endd
30847 If you omit the argument, the default path
30848 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30849 is used.
30850 If you use a remote host,
30851 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30852 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30853 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30854 .code
30855 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30856 FLAGS
30857 SENSITIVITY
30858 PACK
30859 .endd
30860
30861
30862 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30863 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30864 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30865 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30866 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30867 example:
30868 .code
30869 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30870 .endd
30871
30872
30873 .vitem &%clamd%&
30874 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30875 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30876 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30877 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30878 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30879
30880 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30881 a UNIX socket specification,
30882 a TCP socket specification,
30883 or a (global) option.
30884
30885 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30886 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30887 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30888 and the second a port number,
30889 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30890 These per-server options are supported:
30891 .code
30892 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30893 .endd
30894
30895 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30896 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30897
30898 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30899
30900 Examples:
30901 .code
30902 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30903 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30904 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30905 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30906 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30907 .endd
30908 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30909 &`local`&
30910 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30911 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30912 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30913 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30914 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30915 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30916
30917 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30918 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30919 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30920 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30921 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30922 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30923 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30924 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30925 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30926 .code
30927 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30928 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30929 (Connection refused)
30930 .endd
30931
30932 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30933 contributing the code for this scanner.
30934
30935 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30936 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30937 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30938 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30939 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30940
30941 .olist
30942 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30943 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30944
30945 .next
30946 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30947 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30948 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30949 the &"trigger"& expression.
30950
30951 .next
30952 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30953 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30954 &"name"& expression.
30955 .endlist olist
30956
30957 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30958 .code
30959 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30960 .endd
30961 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30962 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30963 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30964 configuration setting:
30965 .code
30966 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30967 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30968 found in file:'(.+)'
30969 .endd
30970 .vitem &%drweb%&
30971 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30972 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30973 takes one option,
30974 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30975 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30976 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30977 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30978 For example:
30979 .code
30980 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30981 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30982 .endd
30983 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30984 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30985
30986 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30987 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30988 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30989 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30990 (or port-range).
30991 For example:
30992 .code
30993 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30994 .endd
30995 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30996
30997 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30998 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30999 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31000 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31001 .code
31002 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31003 .endd
31004 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31005 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31006
31007 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31008 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31009 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31010 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31011 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31012 For example:
31013 .code
31014 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31015 .endd
31016 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31017
31018 .vitem &%mksd%&
31019 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31020 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31021 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31022 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31023 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31024 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
31025 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31026 .code
31027 av_scanner = mksd:2
31028 .endd
31029 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31030
31031 .vitem &%sock%&
31032 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31033 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31034 running on the local machine.
31035 There are four options:
31036 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31037 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31038 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31039 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31040 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31041 For example:
31042 .code
31043 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31044 .endd
31045 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31046 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31047 Both regular-expressions are required.
31048
31049 .vitem &%sophie%&
31050 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31051 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31052 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31053 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31054 client communication. For example:
31055 .code
31056 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31057 .endd
31058 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31059 the option.
31060 .endlist
31061
31062 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31063 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31064 ACL.
31065
31066 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31067 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31068 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31069 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31070 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31071 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31072 message.
31073
31074 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31075 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31076 The first element can then be one of
31077
31078 .ilist
31079 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31080 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31081 recommended usage.
31082 .next
31083 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31084 the condition fails immediately.
31085 .next
31086 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31087 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31088 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31089 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31090 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31091 .endlist
31092
31093 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31094 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31095 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31096
31097 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31098 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31099 For example:
31100 .code
31101 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31102 .endd
31103 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31104
31105 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31106 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31107 is set to record the actual address used.
31108
31109 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31110 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31111 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31112 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31113 logging data.
31114
31115 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31116 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31117 &%malware%& condition.
31118
31119 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31120 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31121
31122 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31123 .code
31124 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31125 demime = *
31126 malware = *
31127 .endd
31128 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31129 .code
31130 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31131 demime = *
31132 malware = */defer_ok
31133 .endd
31134 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31135 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31136 .code
31137 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31138 .endd
31139 in the main Exim configuration.
31140 .code
31141 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31142 set acl_m0 = sophie
31143 malware = *
31144
31145 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31146 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31147 malware = *
31148 .endd
31149
31150
31151 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31152 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31153 .cindex "spam scanning"
31154 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31155 .cindex "Rspamd"
31156 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31157 score and a report for the message.
31158 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31159
31160 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31161 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31162 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31163
31164 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31165 .code
31166 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31167 .endd
31168 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31169 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31170 nicely, however.
31171
31172 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31173 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31174 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31175 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31176 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31177 configuration as follows (example):
31178 .code
31179 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31180 .endd
31181
31182 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31183 on TCP port 11333)
31184 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31185 .code
31186 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31187 .endd
31188
31189 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31190 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31191 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31192 .code
31193 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31194 .endd
31195 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31196 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31197 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31198 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31199 .code
31200 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31201 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31202 192.168.2.12 783
31203 .endd
31204 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31205 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31206 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31207 condition defers.
31208
31209 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31210 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31211 and changeable in the usual way.
31212
31213 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31214 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31215 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31216 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31217
31218 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31219 are options.
31220 The supported options are:
31221 .code
31222 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31223 weight=<value> Selection bias
31224 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31225 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31226 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31227 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31228 .endd
31229
31230 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31231 higher values being tried first.
31232 The default priority is 1.
31233
31234 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31235 Within a priority set
31236 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31237 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31238
31239 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31240 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31241 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31242 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31243
31244 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31245 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31246
31247 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31248 The default value is two minutes.
31249
31250 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31251 a failed connect is made.
31252 The default is to not retry.
31253
31254 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31255 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31256 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31257 expansion.
31258
31259 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31260 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31261 is set to record the actual address used.
31262
31263 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31264 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31265 .code
31266 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31267 spam = joe
31268 .endd
31269 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31270 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31271 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31272 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31273 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31274 right-hand side.
31275
31276 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31277 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31278 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31279 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31280 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31281 are not set.
31282 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31283 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31284 after the first),
31285 or the use of PRDR,
31286 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31287 are needed to use this feature.
31288
31289 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31290 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31291 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31292
31293
31294 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31295 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31296 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31297 example:
31298 .code
31299 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31300 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31301 spam = nobody
31302 .endd
31303
31304 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31305 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31306 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31307 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31308
31309 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31310 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31311 variables.
31312 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31313 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31314 available for use at delivery time.
31315
31316 .vlist
31317 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31318 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31319 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31320
31321 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31322 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31323 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31324 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31325 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31326
31327 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31328 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31329 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31330 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31331 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31332 spam bar is 50 characters.
31333
31334 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31335 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31336 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31337 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31338
31339 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31340 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31341 spam score versus threshold.
31342 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31343
31344 .endlist
31345
31346 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31347 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31348 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31349
31350 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31351 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31352 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31353 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31354 spam condition, like this:
31355 .code
31356 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31357 spam = joe/defer_ok
31358 .endd
31359 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31360
31361 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31362 condition:
31363 .code
31364 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31365 warn spam = nobody:true
31366 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31367 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31368
31369 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31370 # is over threshold
31371 warn spam = nobody
31372 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31373
31374 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31375 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31376 spam = nobody:true
31377 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31378 .endd
31379
31380
31381
31382 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31383 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31384 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31385 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31386 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31387 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31388 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31389 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31390 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31391 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31392 cases.
31393
31394 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31395 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31396 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31397 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31398 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31399 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31400 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31401
31402 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31403 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31404 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31405 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31406 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31407
31408 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31409 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31410 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31411 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31412 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31413 syntax is:
31414 .display
31415 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31416 .endd
31417 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31418 the value can be:
31419
31420 .olist
31421 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31422 .next
31423 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31424 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31425 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31426 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31427 .next
31428 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31429 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31430 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31431 the full path and file name.
31432 .next
31433 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31434 filename, and the default path is then used.
31435 .endlist
31436 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31437 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31438 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31439 .code
31440 decode = $mime_filename
31441 .endd
31442 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31443 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31444 automatically unlinked.
31445
31446 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31447 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31448 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31449 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31450 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31451
31452 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31453 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31454 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31455
31456 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31457 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31458 available in the MIME ACL:
31459
31460 .vlist
31461 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31462 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31463 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31464 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31465 contains the empty string.
31466
31467 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31468 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31469 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31470 .code
31471 us-ascii
31472 gb2312 (Chinese)
31473 iso-8859-1
31474 .endd
31475 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31476 case-insensitively.
31477
31478 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31479 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31480 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31481 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31482 only used for display purposes.
31483
31484 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31485 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31486 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31487
31488 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31489 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31490 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31491
31492 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31493 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31494 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31495 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31496 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31497
31498 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31499 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31500 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31501 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31502
31503 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31504 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31505 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31506 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31507 .code
31508 text/plain
31509 text/html
31510 application/octet-stream
31511 image/jpeg
31512 audio/midi
31513 .endd
31514 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31515 empty string.
31516
31517 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31518 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31519 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31520 containing the decoded data.
31521 .endlist
31522
31523 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31524 .vlist
31525 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31526 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31527 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31528 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31529 RFC2047
31530 or RFC2231
31531 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31532 If no filename was
31533 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31534
31535 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31536 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31537 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31538 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31539
31540 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31541 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31542 follows:
31543
31544 .olist
31545 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31546
31547 .next
31548 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31549 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31550
31551 .next
31552 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31553 and the rest are attachments.
31554
31555 .next
31556 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31557 .endlist olist
31558
31559 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31560 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31561 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31562 .code
31563 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31564 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31565 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31566 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31567 .endd
31568 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31569 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31570 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31571 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31572 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31573
31574 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31575 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31576 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31577 decoding is fully recursive.
31578
31579 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31580 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31581 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31582 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31583 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31584 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31585 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31586 .endlist
31587
31588
31589
31590 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31591 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31592 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31593 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31594 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31595
31596 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31597 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31598 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31599 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31600 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31601
31602 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31603 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31604 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31605 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31606 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31607 32K characters are checked.
31608
31609 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31610 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31611 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31612 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31613 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31614 .code
31615 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31616 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31617 .endd
31618 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31619 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31620 matching regular expression.
31621 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31622 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31623
31624 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31625 CPU-intensive.
31626
31627
31628
31629
31630 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31631 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31632 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31633 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31634 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31635 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31636 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31637 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31638 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31639 use the &%demime%& condition.
31640
31641 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31642 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31643 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31644 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31645 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31646 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31647
31648 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31649 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31650 example:
31651 .code
31652 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31653 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31654 .endd
31655 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31656 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31657 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31658 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31659
31660 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31661 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31662 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31663
31664 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31665
31666 .vlist
31667 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31668 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31669 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31670 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31671 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31672 zero, no error occurred.
31673
31674 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31675 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31676 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31677 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31678 .endlist
31679
31680 .vlist
31681 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31682 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31683 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31684 extension it found.
31685 .endlist
31686
31687 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31688 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31689
31690 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31691 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31692 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31693 facility:
31694 .code
31695 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31696 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31697 demime = *
31698 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31699
31700 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31701 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31702 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31703 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31704
31705 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31706 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31707 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31708 demime = exe:doc
31709 control = freeze
31710 .endd
31711 .ecindex IIDcosca
31712
31713
31714
31715
31716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31718
31719 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31720 "Local scan function"
31721 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31722 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31723 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31724 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31725 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31726
31727 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31728 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31729 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31730 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31731 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31732
31733 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31734 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31735 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31736 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31737
31738 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31739 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31740 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31741 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31742
31743 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31744 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31745 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31746 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31747 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31748 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31749 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31750 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31751 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31752
31753
31754
31755 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31756 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31757 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31758 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31759 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31760 directory, so you might set
31761 .code
31762 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31763 .endd
31764 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31765 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31766 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31767 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31768 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31769 _src/local_scan.c_.
31770
31771 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31772 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31773 .code
31774 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31775 .endd
31776 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31777
31778
31779
31780
31781 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31782 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31783 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31784 .code
31785 #include "local_scan.h"
31786 .endd
31787 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31788 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31789 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31790 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31791 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31792 strings and pointers to character strings:
31793 .code
31794 #define CS (char *)
31795 #define CCS (const char *)
31796 #define CSS (char **)
31797 #define US (unsigned char *)
31798 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31799 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31800 .endd
31801 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31802 .code
31803 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31804 .endd
31805 The arguments are as follows:
31806
31807 .ilist
31808 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31809 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31810 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31811
31812 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31813 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31814 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31815 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31816 case this changes in some future version.
31817 .next
31818 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31819 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31820 .endlist
31821
31822 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31823
31824 .vlist
31825 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31826 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31827 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31828 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31829 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31830 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31831
31832 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31833 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31834 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31835
31836 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31837 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31838 queued without immediate delivery.
31839
31840 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31841 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31842 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31843 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31844 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31845 used.
31846
31847 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31848 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31849 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31850 problem"& is used.
31851
31852 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31853 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31854 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31855 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31856 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31857 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31858 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31859
31860 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31861 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31862 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31863 .endlist
31864
31865 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31866 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31867 &%-oe%& command line options.
31868
31869
31870
31871 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31872 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31873 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31874 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31875 want to do this, you must have the line
31876 .code
31877 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31878 .endd
31879 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31880 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31881 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31882 to define them.
31883
31884 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31885 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31886 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31887 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31888 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31889 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31890 .code
31891 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31892 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31893
31894 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31895 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31896 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31897 };
31898
31899 int local_scan_options_count =
31900 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31901 .endd
31902 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31903 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31904 .code
31905 begin local_scan
31906 my_integer = 99
31907 my_string = some string of text...
31908 .endd
31909 The available types of option data are as follows:
31910
31911 .vlist
31912 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31913 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31914 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31915 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31916 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31917 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31918 values.)
31919
31920 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31921 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31922 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31923 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31924
31925 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31926 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31927 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31928 Exim.
31929
31930 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31931 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31932 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31933 printed with the suffix K or M.
31934
31935 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31936 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31937 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31938 always output in octal.
31939
31940 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31941 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31942 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31943
31944 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31945 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31946 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31947 .endlist
31948
31949 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31950 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31951
31952
31953
31954 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31955 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31956 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31957 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31958 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31959 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31960 C variables are as follows:
31961
31962 .vlist
31963 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31964 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31965
31966 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31967 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31968
31969 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31970 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31971 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31972 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31973
31974 .ilist
31975 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31976 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31977 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31978
31979 .next
31980 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31981 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31982 of debugging bits.
31983 .endlist ilist
31984
31985 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31986 selected, you should use code like this:
31987 .code
31988 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31989 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31990 .endd
31991 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31992 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31993 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31994
31995 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31996 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31997 discussed below.
31998
31999 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32000 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32001
32002 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32003 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32004
32005 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32006 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32007 &%-bh%& command line option.
32008
32009 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32010 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32011 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32012
32013 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32014 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32015 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32016 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32017
32018 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32019 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32020 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32021
32022 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32023 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32024
32025 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32026 The number of accepted recipients.
32027
32028 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32029 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32030 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32031 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32032 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32033 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32034 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32035 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32036 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32037 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32038 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32039 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32040
32041 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32042 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32043
32044 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32045 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32046 locally-submitted messages.
32047
32048 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32049 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32050 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32051
32052 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32053 The name of the sending host, if known.
32054
32055 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32056 The port on the sending host.
32057
32058 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32059 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32060
32061 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32062 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32063
32064 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32065 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32066 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32067 .endlist
32068
32069
32070 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32071 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32072 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32073 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32074 their type to *.
32075
32076
32077 .vlist
32078 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32079 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32080
32081 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32082 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32083 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32084 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32085 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32086 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32087 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32088
32089 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32090 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32091 internal newlines.
32092
32093 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32094 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32095 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32096 .endlist
32097
32098
32099
32100 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32101 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32102
32103 .vlist
32104 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32105 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32106
32107 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32108 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32109 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32110 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32111
32112 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32113 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32114 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32115 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32116 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32117 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32118 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32119 is NULL for all recipients.
32120 .endlist
32121
32122
32123
32124 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32125 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32126 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32127 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32128 release:
32129
32130 .vlist
32131 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32132 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32133
32134 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32135 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32136 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32137 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32138
32139 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32140 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32141 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32142 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32143 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32144
32145 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32146
32147 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32148 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32149 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32150 return value is as follows:
32151
32152 .ilist
32153 >= 0
32154
32155 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32156 ending status.
32157
32158 .next
32159 < 0 and > &--256
32160
32161 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32162 signal number.
32163
32164 .next
32165 &--256
32166
32167 The process timed out.
32168 .next
32169 &--257
32170
32171 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32172 .endlist
32173
32174 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32175 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32176 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32177 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32178 forks a subprocess that is running
32179 .code
32180 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32181 .endd
32182 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32183 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32184 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32185 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32186
32187 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32188 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32189 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32190 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32191
32192
32193 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32194 *sender_authentication)*&
32195 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32196 that it runs is:
32197 .display
32198 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32199 .endd
32200 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32201
32202
32203 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32204 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32205 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32206 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32207 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32208 .code
32209 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32210 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32211 .endd
32212
32213 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32214 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32215 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32216 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32217 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32218 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32219 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32220 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32221
32222 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32223 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32224 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32225 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32226 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32227 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32228
32229 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32230 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32231 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32232 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32233
32234 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32235 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32236 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32237 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32238 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32239 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32240 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32241 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32242 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32243 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32244 .code
32245 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32246 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32247 .endd
32248 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32249 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32250
32251
32252 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32253 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32254 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32255 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32256 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32257
32258
32259 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32260 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32261 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32262 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32263 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32264 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32265 .code
32266 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32267 .endd
32268 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32269 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32270 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32271 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32272 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32273 zero-terminated.
32274
32275 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32276 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32277 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32278 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32279 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32280 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32281 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32282 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32283
32284 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32285 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32286 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32287 .display
32288 &`OK `& match succeeded
32289 &`FAIL `& match failed
32290 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32291 .endd
32292 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32293 inability to contact a database.
32294
32295 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32296 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32297 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32298 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32299 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32300
32301 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32302 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32303 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32304 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32305 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32306
32307 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32308 uschar&~*list)*&"
32309 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32310 expected to be
32311 .code
32312 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32313 .endd
32314 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32315 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32316 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32317 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32318 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32319 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32320 failed.
32321
32322 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32323 *format,&~...)*&"
32324 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32325 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32326 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32327 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32328 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32329 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32330
32331
32332 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32333 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32334 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32335 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32336
32337 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32338 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32339 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32340 value afterwards. For example:
32341 .code
32342 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32343 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32344 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32345 .endd
32346
32347 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32348 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32349 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32350 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32351 address.
32352 .endlist
32353
32354
32355 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32356 .vlist
32357 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32358 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32359 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32360 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32361 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32362 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32363 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32364 binary string is returned with an error message.
32365
32366 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32367 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32368 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32369
32370 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32371 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32372 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32373 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32374 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32375
32376 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32377 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32378 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32379
32380 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32381 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32382 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32383 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32384 with translation.
32385
32386
32387 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32388 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32389 below.
32390
32391 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32392 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32393 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32394 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32395 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32396 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32397 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32398 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32399 is involved.
32400
32401 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32402 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32403
32404 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32405 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32406 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32407 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32408 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32409 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32410 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32411 .code
32412 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32413 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32414 .endd
32415 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32416 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32417 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32418 multiple output lines.
32419
32420 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32421 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32422 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32423 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32424 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32425 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32426 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32427 is an error.
32428
32429 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32430 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32431 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32432 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32433
32434 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32435 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32436 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32437
32438 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32439 See below.
32440
32441 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32442 See below.
32443
32444 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32445 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32446 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32447 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32448 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32449 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32450 more discussion.
32451 .endlist
32452
32453
32454
32455 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32456 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32457 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32458 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32459 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32460 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32461 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32462 terminates.
32463
32464 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32465 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32466 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32467 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32468
32469 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32470 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32471 .code
32472 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32473 .endd
32474 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32475 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32476 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32477 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32478
32479 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32480 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32481 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32482 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32483 &%store_pool%&.
32484 .ecindex IIDlosca
32485
32486
32487
32488
32489 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32490 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32491
32492 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32493 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32494 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32495 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32496 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32497 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32498 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32499 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32500
32501 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32502 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32503 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32504 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32505 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32506
32507 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32508 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32509 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32510 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32511 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32512 prevent it happening on retries.
32513
32514 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32515 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32516 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32517 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32518 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32519 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32520 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32521 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32522
32523
32524 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32525 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32526 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32527 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32528 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32529 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32530 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32531 .code
32532 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32533 system_filter_user = exim
32534 .endd
32535 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32536 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32537 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32538 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32539 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32540 by the &%reply%& command.
32541
32542
32543 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32544 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32545 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32546 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32547
32548 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32549 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32550
32551
32552
32553 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32554 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32555 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32556 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32557 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32558 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32559 they cause errors.
32560
32561 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32562 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32563 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32564 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32565 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32566 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32567 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32568
32569 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32570 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32571 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32572 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32573 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32574
32575 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32576 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32577 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32578 to which users' filter files can refer.
32579
32580
32581
32582 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32583 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32584 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32585 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32586 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32587
32588
32589
32590 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32591 .cindex "freezing messages"
32592 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32593 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32594 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32595 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32596 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32597 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32598 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32599 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32600 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32601 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32602 .code
32603 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32604 .endd
32605 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32606
32607 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32608 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32609 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32610 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32611 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32612 run.
32613
32614 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32615 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32616 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32617 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32618
32619 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32620 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32621 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32622 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32623 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32624 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32625 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32626 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32627 message. For example:
32628 .code
32629 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32630 because it contains attachments that we are \
32631 not prepared to receive."
32632 .endd
32633
32634 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32635 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32636 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32637 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32638 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32639 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32640 use, for example
32641 .code
32642 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32643 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32644 .endd
32645 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32646 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32647 generated by the filter.
32648
32649 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32650 &%defer%&,
32651 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32652 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32653 as
32654 .code
32655 mail ...
32656 freeze
32657 .endd
32658 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32659 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32660 take place.
32661
32662
32663
32664 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32665 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32666 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32667 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32668 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32669 .code
32670 headers add <string>
32671 headers remove <string>
32672 .endd
32673 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32674 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32675 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32676 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32677 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32678
32679 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32680 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32681 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32682 example:
32683 .code
32684 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32685 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32686 X-header-2: ...."
32687 .endd
32688 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32689 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32690 space after input continuations is ignored.
32691
32692 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32693 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32694 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32695 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32696 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32697
32698 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32699 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32700 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32701 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32702 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32703 used for all recipients of the message.
32704
32705 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32706 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32707 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32708 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32709 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32710 until the message is actually being written (see section
32711 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32712
32713 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32714 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32715 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32716 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32717 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32718 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32719 modified more than once.
32720
32721 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32722 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32723 For example:
32724 .code
32725 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32726 headers remove "Subject"
32727 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32728 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32729 .endd
32730
32731
32732
32733 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32734 .cindex "envelope sender"
32735 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32736 .code
32737 errors_to <some address>
32738 .endd
32739 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32740 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32741 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32742 might use
32743 .code
32744 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32745 .endd
32746 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32747 address if its delivery failed.
32748
32749
32750
32751 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32752 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32753 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32754 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32755 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32756 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32757 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32758 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32759 which implements such a filter:
32760 .code
32761 central_filter:
32762 check_local_user
32763 driver = redirect
32764 domains = +local_domains
32765 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32766 no_verify
32767 allow_filter
32768 allow_freeze
32769 .endd
32770 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32771 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32772 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32773 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32774
32775 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32776 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32777 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32778 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32779 normal way.
32780 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32781 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32782 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32783
32784
32785
32786
32787
32788
32789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32791
32792 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32793 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32794 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32795 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32796 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32797 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32798 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32799 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32800
32801 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32802 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32803 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32804 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32805 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32806
32807 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32808 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32809 loopback interface specially in any way.
32810
32811 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32812 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32813
32814
32815
32816
32817 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32818 .cindex "message" "submission"
32819 .cindex "submission mode"
32820 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32821 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32822 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32823 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32824 .code
32825 control = submission
32826 .endd
32827 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32828 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32829 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32830 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32831 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32832 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32833 .code
32834 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32835 control = submission
32836 .endd
32837 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32838 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32839 is used to separate options. For example:
32840 .code
32841 control = submission/sender_retain
32842 .endd
32843 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32844 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32845 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32846 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32847 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32848 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32849 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32850
32851 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32852 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32853 example:
32854 .code
32855 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32856 .endd
32857 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32858 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32859 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32860 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32861 .code
32862 accept authenticated = *
32863 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32864 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32865 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32866 .endd
32867 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32868 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32869 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32870 .code
32871 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32872 .endd
32873 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32874 line would be:
32875 .code
32876 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32877 .endd
32878 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32879 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32880 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32881 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32882
32883 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32884 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32885 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32886 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32887 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32888 spoof another's address.
32889
32890 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32891 .cindex "line endings"
32892 .cindex "carriage return"
32893 .cindex "linefeed"
32894 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32895 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32896 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32897 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32898 use CRLF or just CR.
32899
32900 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32901 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32902 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32903 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32904 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32905 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32906 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32907 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32908 follows:
32909
32910 .ilist
32911 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32912 .next
32913 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32914 is ignored.
32915 .next
32916 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32917 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32918 terminator.
32919 .next
32920 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32921 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32922 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32923 people trying to play silly games.
32924 .next
32925 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32926 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32927 line.
32928 .endlist
32929
32930
32931
32932
32933
32934 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32935 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32936 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32937 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32938 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32939 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32940 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32941 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32942
32943 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32944 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32945 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32946 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32947 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32948
32949 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32950 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32951 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32952 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32953 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32954 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32955 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32956 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32957
32958
32959
32960
32961 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32962 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32963 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32964 .cindex "sender" "address"
32965 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32966 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32967 .cindex "envelope sender"
32968 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32969 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32970 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32971 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32972 .code
32973 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32974 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32975 .endd
32976 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32977 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32978 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32979 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32980 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32981 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32982 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32983 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32984 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32985
32986 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32987 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32988 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32989 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32990 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32991 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32992 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32993
32994 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32995 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32996 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32997
32998 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32999 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33000 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33001 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33002
33003
33004
33005 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33006 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33007 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33008 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33009 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33010 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33011 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33012
33013 .blockquote
33014 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33015 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33016 .endblockquote
33017
33018 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33019 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33020 follows:
33021
33022 .ilist
33023 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33024 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33025 .next
33026 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33027 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33028 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33029 .next
33030 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33031 also removed.
33032 .next
33033 For a locally-submitted message,
33034 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33035 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33036 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33037 included in log lines in this case.
33038 .next
33039 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33040 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33041 .endlist
33042
33043
33044
33045
33046 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33047 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33048 includes the header line:
33049 .code
33050 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33051 .endd
33052
33053 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33054 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33055 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33056 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33057 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33058 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33059
33060
33061 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33062 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33063 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33064 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33065 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33066
33067 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33068 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33069 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33070 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33071 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33072 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33073 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33074 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33075 messages.
33076
33077
33078 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33079 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33080 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33081 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33082 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33083 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33084 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33085 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33086 messages.
33087
33088
33089 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33090 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33091 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33092 .cindex "message" "submission"
33093 .cindex "submission mode"
33094 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33095 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33096
33097 .ilist
33098 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33099 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33100 .next
33101 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33102 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33103 .olist
33104 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33105 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33106 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33107 .next
33108 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33109 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33110 .next
33111 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33112 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33113 .endlist
33114 .endlist
33115
33116 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33117
33118 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33119 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33120 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33121 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33122 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33123 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33124 &%qualify_domain%&.
33125
33126 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33127 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33128 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33129 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33130
33131
33132 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33133 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33134 .cindex "message" "submission"
33135 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33136 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33137 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33138 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33139 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33140 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33141 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33142 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33143 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33144 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33145
33146
33147 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33148 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33149 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33150 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33151 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33152
33153 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33154 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33155 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33156 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33157
33158 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33159 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33160 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33161
33162
33163 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33164 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33165 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33166 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33167 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33168 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33169 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33170 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33171 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33172 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33173 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33174
33175
33176
33177 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33178 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33179 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33180 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33181 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33182 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33183 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33184 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33185
33186
33187
33188 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33189 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33190 .cindex "message" "submission"
33191 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33192 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33193 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33194 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33195 control setting.
33196
33197 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33198 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33199 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33200 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33201 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33202 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33203 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33204 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33205 line is added to the message.
33206
33207 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33208 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33209 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33210 options true at the same time.
33211
33212 .cindex "submission mode"
33213 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33214 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33215 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33216 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33217
33218 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33219 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33220 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33221 created as follows:
33222
33223 .ilist
33224 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33225 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33226 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33227 .next
33228 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33229 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33230 .next
33231 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33232 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33233 .endlist
33234
33235 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33236 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33237 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33238 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33239
33240 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33241 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33242 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33243 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33244
33245
33246
33247 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33248 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33249 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33250 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33251 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33252 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33253 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33254 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33255 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33256
33257 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33258 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33259 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33260 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33261 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33262 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33263
33264 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33265 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33266 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33267
33268 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33269 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33270 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33271 .code
33272 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33273 X-added-second: another added header line
33274 .endd
33275 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33276
33277 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33278 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33279 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33280
33281 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33282 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33283 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33284 not part of the names. For example:
33285 .code
33286 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33287 .endd
33288
33289 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33290 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33291 Each item is separately expanded.
33292 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33293 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33294 will act as list separators.
33295
33296 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33297 items are expanded at routing time,
33298 and then associated with all addresses that are
33299 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33300 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33301 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33302
33303 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33304 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33305 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33306 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33307
33308 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33309 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33310 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33311 requirements.
33312
33313 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33314 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33315 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33316 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33317 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33318 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33319 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33320
33321 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33322 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33323 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33324 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33325
33326 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33327 the following consequences:
33328
33329 .ilist
33330 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33331 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33332 to it, at all times.
33333 .next
33334 Header lines that are added by a router's
33335 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33336 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33337 .next
33338 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33339 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33340 .next
33341 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33342 a later router or by a transport.
33343 .next
33344 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33345 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33346 .code
33347 headers_remove = subject
33348 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33349 .endd
33350 .endlist
33351
33352 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33353 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33354
33355
33356
33357
33358
33359 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33360 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33361 .cindex "constructed address"
33362 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33363 the form
33364 .display
33365 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33366 .endd
33367 For example:
33368 .code
33369 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33370 .endd
33371 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33372 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33373 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33374 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33375 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33376 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33377 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33378 there is no password file entry.
33379
33380 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33381 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33382 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33383 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33384 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33385 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33386 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33387 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33388 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33389
33390
33391
33392 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33393 .cindex "case of local parts"
33394 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33395 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33396 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33397 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33398 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33399 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33400 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33401 router option.
33402
33403 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33404 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33405 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33406 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33407 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33408 .code
33409 correct_case:
33410 driver = redirect
33411 domains = +local_domains
33412 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33413 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33414 @$domain
33415 .endd
33416 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33417 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33418 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33419 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33420 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33421
33422
33423
33424 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33425 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33426 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33427 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33428 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33429 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33430 empty components for compatibility.
33431
33432
33433
33434 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33435 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33436 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33437 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33438 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33439 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33440
33441 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33442 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33443 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33444 example, a header such as
33445 .code
33446 To: hare@teaparty
33447 .endd
33448 might get rewritten as
33449 .code
33450 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33451 .endd
33452 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33453 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33454 been routed.
33455
33456 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33457 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33458 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33459 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33460 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33461 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33462 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33463
33464
33465
33466 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33468
33469 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33470 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33471 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33472 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33473 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33474 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33475 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33476
33477 .ilist
33478 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33479 .next
33480 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33481 .next
33482 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33483 .endlist
33484
33485 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33486
33487 .ilist
33488 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33489 .next
33490 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33491 &"lmtp"&);
33492 .next
33493 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33494 transport);
33495 .next
33496 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33497 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33498 .endlist
33499
33500 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33501 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33502 used to contain the envelope information.
33503
33504
33505
33506 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33507 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33508 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33509 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33510 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33511 .cindex "EHLO"
33512 .cindex "HELO"
33513 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33514 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33515 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33516 processing is the same in both cases.
33517
33518 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33519 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33520 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33521 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33522 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33523 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33524 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33525 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33526 suppressed.
33527
33528 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33529 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33530 required for the transaction.
33531
33532 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33533 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33534 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33535 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33536 is called for verification.
33537
33538 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33539 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33540 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33541
33542 .cindex "carriage return"
33543 .cindex "linefeed"
33544 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33545 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33546 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33547 line terminator.
33548
33549 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33550 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33551 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33552 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33553 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33554 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33555 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33556 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33557 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33558
33559 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33560 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33561 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33562 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33563
33564 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33565 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33566 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33567 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33568
33569 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33570 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33571 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33572 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33573 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33574 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33575 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33576 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33577 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33578 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33579
33580 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33581 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33582
33583 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33584 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33585 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33586 square bracket of the IP address.
33587
33588
33589
33590
33591 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33592 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33593 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33594 .cindex "host" "error"
33595 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33596 message errors, and recipient errors.
33597
33598 .vlist
33599 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33600 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33601 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33602
33603 .ilist
33604 Connection refused or timed out,
33605 .next
33606 Any error response code on connection,
33607 .next
33608 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33609 .next
33610 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33611 .next
33612 I/O errors at any time,
33613 .next
33614 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33615 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33616 .endlist ilist
33617
33618 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33619 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33620 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33621 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33622 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33623 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33624 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33625 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33626
33627 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33628 .cindex "message" "error"
33629 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33630 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33631 message errors are:
33632
33633 .ilist
33634 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33635 the data,
33636 .next
33637 Timeout after MAIL,
33638 .next
33639 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33640 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33641 connection at any other time.
33642 .endlist ilist
33643
33644 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33645 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33646 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33647 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33648 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33649 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33650 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33651 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33652 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33653 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33654
33655 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33656 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33657 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33658 response to MAIL.
33659
33660 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33661 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33662 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33663 recipient errors are:
33664
33665 .ilist
33666 Any error response to RCPT,
33667 .next
33668 Timeout after RCPT.
33669 .endlist
33670
33671 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33672 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33673 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33674 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33675 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33676 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33677 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33678 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33679 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33680 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33681 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33682 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33683 the retry clock is reset.
33684
33685 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33686 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33687 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33688 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33689 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33690 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33691 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33692 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33693 recipient's retry time.
33694 .endlist
33695
33696 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33697 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33698 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33699 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33700 until the next delivery attempt.
33701
33702 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33703 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33704 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33705 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33706 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33707 is created.
33708
33709 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33710 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33711 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33712 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33713 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33714 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33715 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33716
33717 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33718 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33719 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33720 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33721 then to be treated as a host error.
33722
33723 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33724 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33725 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33726 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33727 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33728
33729
33730
33731
33732 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33733 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33734 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33735 .cindex "inetd"
33736 .cindex "daemon"
33737 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33738 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33739 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33740 .code
33741 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33742 .endd
33743 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33744 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33745 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33746 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33747 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33748 stream and exits with an error code.
33749
33750 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33751 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33752 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33753 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33754
33755 .cindex "carriage return"
33756 .cindex "linefeed"
33757 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33758 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33759 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33760 line terminator.
33761 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33762 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33763 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33764
33765 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33766 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33767 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33768 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33769 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33770 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33771 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33772 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33773
33774 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33775 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33776 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33777 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33778 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33779 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33780 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33781 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33782 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33783
33784 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33785 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33786 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33787
33788 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33789 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33790 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33791 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33792 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33793
33794 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33795 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33796 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33797 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33798 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33799 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33800 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33801
33802 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33803 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33804 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33805 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33806 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33807
33808 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33809 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33810 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33811 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33812 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33813 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33814 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33815 a delivery process.
33816
33817 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33818 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33819 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33820 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33821 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33822
33823 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33824 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33825 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33826 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33827
33828 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33829 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33830 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33831
33832
33833
33834 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33835 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33836 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33837 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33838 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33839 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33840 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33841 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33842
33843
33844 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33845 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33846 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33847 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33848 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33849 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33850 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33851 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33852 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33853 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33854 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33855
33856
33857
33858 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33859 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33860 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33861 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33862 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33863 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33864 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33865 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33866
33867 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33868 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33869 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33870 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33871 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33872 counted.
33873
33874 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33875 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33876 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33877
33878 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33879 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33880 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33881 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33882 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33883
33884
33885
33886
33887 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33888 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33889 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33890 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33891 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33892
33893 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33894 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33895 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33896
33897 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33898 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33899 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33900 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33901 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33902 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33903 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33904 RCPT failures.
33905
33906
33907
33908 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33909 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33910 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33911 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33912 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33913 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33914 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33915
33916 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33917 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33918 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33919 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33920 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33921 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33922 argument. For example,
33923 .code
33924 ETRN #brigadoon
33925 .endd
33926 runs the command
33927 .code
33928 exim -R brigadoon
33929 .endd
33930 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33931 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33932 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33933 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33934 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33935
33936 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33937 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33938 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33939 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33940 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33941 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33942 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33943 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33944
33945 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33946 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33947 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33948 whatever the form of its argument. For
33949 example:
33950 .code
33951 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33952 $sender_host_address
33953 .endd
33954 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33955 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33956 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33957 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33958 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33959 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33960 for it to change them before running the command.
33961
33962
33963
33964 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33965 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33966 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33967 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33968 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33969 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33970 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33971 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33972 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33973 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33974 runs for RCPT commands:
33975 .code
33976 accept hosts = :
33977 .endd
33978 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33979
33980
33981
33982 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33983 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33984 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33985 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33986 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33987 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33988 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33989 envelope along with the message.
33990
33991 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33992 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33993 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33994 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33995 can be used to specify it.
33996
33997 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33998 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33999 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34000 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34001 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34002
34003 .vindex "&$host$&"
34004 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34005 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34006 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34007 router:
34008 .code
34009 begin routers
34010 route_append:
34011 driver = manualroute
34012 transport = smtp_appendfile
34013 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34014
34015 begin transports
34016 smtp_appendfile:
34017 driver = appendfile
34018 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34019 batch_max = 1000
34020 use_bsmtp
34021 user = exim
34022 .endd
34023 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34024 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34025 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34026
34027
34028
34029 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34030 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34031 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34032 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34033 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34034 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34035 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34036 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34037 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34038 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34039
34040 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34041 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34042
34043 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34044 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34045 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34046 make some use of automatically, for example:
34047 .code
34048 554 Unexpected end of file
34049 Transaction started in line 10
34050 Error detected in line 14
34051 .endd
34052 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34053 file, for example:
34054 .code
34055 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34056 The error message was:
34057
34058 501 '>' missing at end of address
34059
34060 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34061 The error was detected in line 12.
34062 The SMTP command at fault was:
34063
34064 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34065
34066 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34067 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34068 .endd
34069 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34070 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34071 accepted.
34072 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34073 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34074
34075
34076
34077 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34078 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34079
34080 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34081 "Customizing messages"
34082 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34083 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34084 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34085 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34086 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34087
34088 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34089 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34090 option. Exim also adds the line
34091 .code
34092 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34093 .endd
34094 to all warning and bounce messages,
34095
34096
34097 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34098 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34099 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34100 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34101 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34102 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34103 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34104
34105 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34106 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34107 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34108 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34109 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34110 item.
34111
34112 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34113 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34114 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34115 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34116 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34117 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34118 option, rounded to a whole number.
34119
34120 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34121
34122 .ilist
34123 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34124 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34125 .next
34126 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34127 failing addresses with their error messages.
34128 .next
34129 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34130 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34131 .next
34132 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34133 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34134 .endlist
34135
34136 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34137 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34138 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34139 .code
34140 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34141 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34142 {: returning message to sender}}
34143 ****
34144 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34145
34146 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34147 {that you sent }{sent by
34148
34149 <$sender_address>
34150
34151 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34152 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34153 ****
34154 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34155 ****
34156 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34157 ------
34158 ****
34159 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34160 only the first
34161 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34162 ****
34163 .endd
34164 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34165 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34166 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34167 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34168 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34169 text sections:
34170
34171 .ilist
34172 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34173 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34174 .next
34175 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34176 the delayed addresses.
34177 .next
34178 The third item then ends the message.
34179 .endlist
34180
34181 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34182 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34183 .code
34184 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34185 $warn_message_delay
34186 ****
34187 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34188
34189 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34190 {that you sent }{sent by
34191
34192 <$sender_address>
34193
34194 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34195 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34196
34197 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34198 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34199 The date of the message is: $h_date
34200
34201 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34202 ****
34203 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34204 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34205 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34206 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34207 the message will be returned to you.
34208 .endd
34209 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34210 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34211 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34212 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34213 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34214 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34215 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34216 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34217 handled them.
34218
34219
34220
34221
34222 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34223 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34224
34225 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34226 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34227 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34228
34229
34230
34231 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34232 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34233 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34234 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34235 routing explicitly:
34236 .code
34237 send_to_smart_host:
34238 driver = manualroute
34239 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34240 transport = remote_smtp
34241 .endd
34242 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34243 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34244 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34245 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34246 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34247
34248
34249
34250
34251 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34252 .cindex "mailing lists"
34253 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34254 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34255 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34256
34257 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34258 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34259 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34260 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34261 .code
34262 lists:
34263 driver = redirect
34264 domains = lists.example
34265 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34266 forbid_pipe
34267 forbid_file
34268 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34269 no_more
34270 .endd
34271 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34272 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34273 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34274 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34275
34276 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34277 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34278 a mailing list.
34279
34280 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34281 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34282 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34283 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34284 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34285
34286 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34287 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34288 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34289 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34290 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34291 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34292 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34293 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34294 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34295
34296
34297
34298 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34299 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34300 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34301 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34302 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34303 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34304 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34305
34306 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34307 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34308 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34309 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34310 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34311
34312
34313
34314 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34315 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34316 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34317 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34318 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34319 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34320 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34321 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34322 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34323 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34324
34325 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34326 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34327 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34328 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34329 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34330 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34331 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34332 pre-existing messages.
34333
34334 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34335 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34336 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34337 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34338 one level of expansion anyway.
34339
34340
34341
34342 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34343 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34344 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34345 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34346 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34347 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34348
34349 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34350 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34351 .code
34352 lists_request:
34353 driver = redirect
34354 domains = lists.example
34355 local_part_suffix = -request
34356 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34357 no_more
34358
34359 lists_post:
34360 driver = redirect
34361 domains = lists.example
34362 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34363 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34364 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34365 forbid_pipe
34366 forbid_file
34367 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34368 no_more
34369
34370 lists_closed:
34371 driver = redirect
34372 domains = lists.example
34373 allow_fail
34374 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34375 .endd
34376 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34377 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34378 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34379 mailing list.
34380
34381 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34382 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34383 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34384 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34385 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34386 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34387 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34388 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34389 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34390
34391 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34392 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34393 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34394
34395
34396
34397
34398 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34399 .cindex "VERP"
34400 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34401 .cindex "envelope sender"
34402 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34403 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34404 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34405 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34406 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34407 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34408
34409 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34410 .oindex &%return_path%&
34411 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34412 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34413 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34414 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34415 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34416 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34417 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34418 .code
34419 verp_smtp:
34420 driver = smtp
34421 max_rcpt = 1
34422 return_path = \
34423 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34424 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34425 .endd
34426 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34427 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34428 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34429 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34430 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34431 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34432 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34433 rewritten as
34434 .code
34435 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34436 .endd
34437 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34438 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34439 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34440 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34441 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34442 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34443
34444 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34445 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34446 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34447 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34448 .code
34449 dnslookup:
34450 driver = dnslookup
34451 domains = ! +local_domains
34452 transport = \
34453 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34454 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34455 no_more
34456 .endd
34457 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34458 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34459 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34460 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34461 address.
34462
34463 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34464 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34465 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34466 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34467 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34468 .code
34469 verp_dnslookup:
34470 driver = dnslookup
34471 domains = ! +local_domains
34472 transport = remote_smtp
34473 errors_to = \
34474 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34475 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34476 no_more
34477 .endd
34478 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34479 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34480 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34481 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34482 them.
34483
34484 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34485 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34486 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34487 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34488 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34489 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34490 used).
34491
34492
34493
34494
34495
34496
34497 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34498 .cindex "virtual domains"
34499 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34500 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34501 meanings:
34502
34503 .ilist
34504 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34505 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34506 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34507 .next
34508 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34509 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34510 have login accounts on that host.
34511 .endlist
34512
34513 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34514 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34515 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34516 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34517 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34518 to a router of this form:
34519 .code
34520 virtual:
34521 driver = redirect
34522 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34523 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34524 no_more
34525 .endd
34526 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34527 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34528 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34529 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34530 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34531 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34532
34533 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34534 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34535 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34536 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34537
34538 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34539 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34540 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34541 .code
34542 my_domains:
34543 driver = accept
34544 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34545 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34546 transport = my_mailboxes
34547 .endd
34548 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34549 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34550 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34551 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34552 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34553 follows:
34554 .code
34555 my_mailboxes:
34556 driver = appendfile
34557 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34558 user = mail
34559 .endd
34560 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34561 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34562
34563 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34564 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34565 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34566 information about the domains.
34567
34568
34569
34570 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34571 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34572 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34573 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34574 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34575 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34576 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34577 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34578 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34579 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34580 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34581 example, consider this router:
34582 .code
34583 userforward:
34584 driver = redirect
34585 check_local_user
34586 file = $home/.forward
34587 local_part_suffix = -*
34588 local_part_suffix_optional
34589 allow_filter
34590 .endd
34591 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34592 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34593 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34594 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34595 .code
34596 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34597 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34598 endif
34599 .endd
34600 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34601 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34602 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34603 control over which suffixes are valid.
34604
34605 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34606 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34607 another MTA:
34608 .code
34609 userforward:
34610 driver = redirect
34611 check_local_user
34612 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34613 local_part_suffix = -*
34614 local_part_suffix_optional
34615 allow_filter
34616 .endd
34617 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34618 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34619 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34620 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34621 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34622
34623
34624
34625 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34626 .cindex "vacation processing"
34627 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34628 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34629 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34630 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34631 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34632
34633 .ilist
34634 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34635 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34636 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34637 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34638 .code
34639 spqr, vacation-spqr
34640 .endd
34641 .next
34642 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34643 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34644 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34645 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34646 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34647 message.
34648 .endlist
34649
34650 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34651 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34652
34653
34654
34655 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34656 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34657 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34658 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34659 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34660 each day's messages.
34661
34662 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34663 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34664 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34665 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34666
34667
34668
34669 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34670 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34671 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34672 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34673 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34674 permanently connected.
34675
34676 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34677 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34678 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34679
34680
34681 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34682 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34683 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34684 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34685 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34686 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34687 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34688 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34689
34690 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34691 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34692 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34693 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34694 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34695 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34696 if required.
34697
34698 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34699 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34700 intermittent host. For example:
34701 .code
34702 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34703 .endd
34704 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34705 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34706 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34707 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34708 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34709 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34710 immediately.
34711
34712 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34713 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34714 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34715 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34716 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34717 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34718 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34719
34720
34721
34722 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34723 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34724 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34725 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34726 delivered immediately.
34727
34728 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34729 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34730 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34731 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34732 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34733 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34734 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34735 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34736 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34737 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34738 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34739 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34740 single SMTP connection.
34741
34742
34743
34744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34745 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34746
34747 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34748 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34749 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34750 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34751 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34752 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34753 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34754 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34755 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34756 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34757 messages this way.
34758
34759 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34760 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34761 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34762 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34763 email is not desirable.
34764
34765 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34766 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34767 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34768 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34769 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34770 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34771 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34772
34773 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34774 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34775 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34776 before sending a message to the smart host.
34777
34778 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34779 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34780 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34781
34782 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34783 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34784 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34785 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34786 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34787 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34788 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34789
34790 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34791 following ways:
34792
34793 .ilist
34794 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34795 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34796 .next
34797 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34798 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34799 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34800 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34801 successful, a zero return code is given.
34802 .next
34803 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34804 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34805 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34806 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34807 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34808 are.
34809 .next
34810 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34811 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34812 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34813 .next
34814 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34815 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34816 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34817 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34818 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34819 .next
34820 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34821 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34822 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34823 .next
34824 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34825 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34826 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34827 are ever generated.
34828 .next
34829 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34830 .next
34831 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34832 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34833 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34834 .endlist
34835
34836 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34837 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34838 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34839 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34840 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34841 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34842
34843
34844
34845
34846 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34847 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34848
34849 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34850 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34851 .cindex "log" "types of"
34852 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34853 and the panic log:
34854
34855 .ilist
34856 .cindex "main log"
34857 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34858 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34859 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34860 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34861 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34862 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34863 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34864 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34865 .next
34866 .cindex "reject log"
34867 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34868 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34869 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34870 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34871 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34872 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34873 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34874 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34875 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34876 false.
34877 .next
34878 .cindex "panic log"
34879 .cindex "system log"
34880 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34881 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34882 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34883 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34884 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34885 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34886 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34887 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34888 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34889 .endlist
34890
34891 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34892 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34893 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34894 .code
34895 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34896 by QUIT
34897 .endd
34898 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34899 ways of changing this:
34900
34901 .ilist
34902 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34903 you set
34904 .code
34905 timezone = UTC
34906 .endd
34907 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34908 .next
34909 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34910 example:
34911 .code
34912 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34913 .endd
34914 .endlist
34915
34916 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34917 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34918 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34919 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34920 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34921 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34922
34923
34924
34925
34926 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34927 .cindex "log" "destination"
34928 .cindex "log" "to file"
34929 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34930 .cindex "syslog"
34931 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34932 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34933 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34934 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34935 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34936 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34937 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34938
34939 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34940 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34941 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34942 references to the host name:
34943 .code
34944 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34945 .endd
34946 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34947 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34948 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34949 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34950 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34951 log at all.
34952
34953 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34954 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34955 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34956 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34957 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34958 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34959 implying the use of a default path.
34960
34961 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34962 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34963 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34964 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34965 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34966 equivalent to the setting:
34967 .code
34968 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34969 .endd
34970 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34971 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34972 that is where the logs are written.
34973
34974 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34975 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34976
34977 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34978 .display
34979 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34980 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34981 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34982 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34983 .endd
34984 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34985 error is logged.
34986
34987
34988
34989 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34990 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34991 .cindex "cycling logs"
34992 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34993 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34994 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34995 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34996 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34997 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34998 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34999
35000 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35001 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35002 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35003 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35004 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35005 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35006 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35007 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35008 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35009 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35010 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35011 renamed.
35012
35013
35014
35015 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35016 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35017 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35018 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35019 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35020 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35021 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35022 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35023 .code
35024 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35025 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35026 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35027 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35028 .endd
35029 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35030 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35031 .code
35032 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35033 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35034 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35035 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35036 .endd
35037 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35038 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35039 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35040 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35041
35042 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35043 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35044 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35045 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35046 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35047 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35048 log names:
35049 .code
35050 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35051 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35052 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35053 /var/log/exim/panic
35054 .endd
35055
35056
35057 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35058 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35059 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35060 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35061 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35062 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35063 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35064 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35065 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35066 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35067 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35068 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35069 the time and host name to each line.
35070 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35071
35072 .ilist
35073 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35074 .next
35075 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35076 .next
35077 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35078 .endlist
35079
35080 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35081 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35082 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35083 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35084
35085 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35086 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35087 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35088 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35089 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35090 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35091 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35092 RFC 3164, you should set
35093 .code
35094 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35095 .endd
35096 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35097 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35098
35099 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35100 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35101 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35102 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35103 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35104 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35105 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35106 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35107 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35108 .code
35109 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35110 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35111 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35112 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35113 [5/5] mple>)
35114 .endd
35115 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35116 (LOG_NOTICE):
35117 .code
35118 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35119 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35120 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35121 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35122 [5\18] .example>)
35123 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35124 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35125 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35126 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35127 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35128 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35129 [12\18] F From: <>
35130 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35131 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35132 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35133 [16\18] le>
35134 [17\18] B Bcc:
35135 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35136 .endd
35137 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35138 without modification.
35139
35140 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35141 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35142 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35143 where it is.
35144
35145
35146
35147 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35148 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35149 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35150 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35151 timestamp. The flags are:
35152 .display
35153 &`<=`& message arrival
35154 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35155 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35156 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35157 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35158 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35159 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35160 .endd
35161
35162
35163 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35164 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35165 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35166 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35167 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35168 .code
35169 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35170 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35171 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35172 .endd
35173 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35174 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35175 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35176 .code
35177 R=<message id>
35178 .endd
35179 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35180
35181 .cindex "HELO"
35182 .cindex "EHLO"
35183 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35184 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35185 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35186 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35187 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35188 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35189 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35190 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35191 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35192 name in parentheses.
35193
35194 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35195 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35196 the log containing text like these examples:
35197 .code
35198 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35199 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35200 .endd
35201 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35202 on.
35203
35204 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35205 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35206 of Exim.
35207
35208 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35209 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35210 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35211 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35212 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35213 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35214 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35215 suite that was used.
35216
35217 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35218 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35219 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35220 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35221 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35222 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35223 authenticator name.
35224
35225 .cindex "size" "of message"
35226 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35227 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35228 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35229 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35230 other).
35231
35232 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35233 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35234
35235
35236
35237 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35238 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35239 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35240 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35241 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35242 to fit it on the page:
35243 .code
35244 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35245 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35246 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35247 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35248 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35249 .endd
35250 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35251 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35252 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35253 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35254 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35255
35256 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35257 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35258 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35259 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35260
35261 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35262 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35263 .display
35264 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35265 .endd
35266 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35267 parentheses afterwards.
35268
35269 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35270 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35271 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35272 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35273 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35274 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35275
35276 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35277 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35278 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35279 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35280 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35281
35282 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35283 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35284
35285 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35286 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35287
35288
35289 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35290 .cindex "discarded messages"
35291 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35292 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35293 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35294 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35295 .code
35296 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35297 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35298 .endd
35299 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35300 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35301 .code
35302 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35303 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35304 .endd
35305
35306
35307 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35308 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35309 .code
35310 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35311 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35312 .endd
35313 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35314 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35315 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35316 .code
35317 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35318 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35319 .endd
35320 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35321 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35322 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35323
35324
35325
35326 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35327 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35328 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35329 following form is logged:
35330 .code
35331 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35332 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35333 .endd
35334 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35335 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35336 .code
35337 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35338 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35339 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35340 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35341 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35342 .endd
35343 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35344 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35345 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35346 flagged with &`**`&.
35347
35348
35349
35350 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35351 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35352 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35353 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35354 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35355
35356
35357
35358 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35359 A line of the form
35360 .code
35361 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35362 .endd
35363 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35364 at the end of its processing.
35365
35366
35367
35368
35369 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35370 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35371 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35372 the following table:
35373 .display
35374 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35375 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35376 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35377 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35378 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35379 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35380 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35381 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35382 &`H `& host name and IP address
35383 &`I `& local interface used
35384 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35385 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35386 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35387 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35388 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35389 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35390 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35391 &`S `& size of message
35392 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35393 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35394 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35395 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35396 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35397 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35398 .endd
35399
35400
35401 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35402 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35403 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35404
35405 .ilist
35406 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35407 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35408 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35409 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35410 during the first delivery attempt.
35411 .next
35412 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35413 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35414 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35415 .next
35416 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35417 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35418 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35419 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35420 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35421 doing.
35422 .next
35423 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35424 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35425 message:
35426 .olist
35427 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35428 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35429 .next
35430 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35431 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35432 .next
35433 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35434 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35435 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35436 .code
35437 errors_to = <>
35438 .endd
35439 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35440 .endlist olist
35441 .endlist ilist
35442
35443
35444
35445
35446
35447 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35448 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35449 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35450 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35451 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35452 example:
35453 .code
35454 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35455 .endd
35456 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35457 selection marked by asterisks:
35458 .display
35459 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35460 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35461 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35462 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35463 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35464 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35465 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35466 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35467 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35468 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35469 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35470 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35471 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35472 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35473 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35474 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35475 .new
35476 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35477 .wen
35478 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35479 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35480 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35481 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35482 &` pid `& Exim process id
35483 .new
35484 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= lines
35485 .wen
35486 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35487 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35488 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35489 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35490 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35491 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35492 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35493 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35494 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35495 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35496 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35497 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35498 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35499 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35500 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35501 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35502 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35503 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35504 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35505 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35506 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35507 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35508
35509 &` all `& all of the above
35510 .endd
35511 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35512 section &<<SECID99>>&
35513
35514 More details on each of these items follows:
35515
35516 .ilist
35517 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35518 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35519 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35520 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35521 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35522 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35523 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35524 .next
35525 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35526 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35527 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35528 this log selector is set.
35529 .next
35530 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35531 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35532 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35533 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35534 such users cannot access the log).
35535 .next
35536 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35537 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35538 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35539 parentheses between them.
35540 .next
35541 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35542 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35543 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35544 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35545 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35546 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35547 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35548 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35549 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35550 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35551 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35552 between the caller and Exim.
35553 .next
35554 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35555 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35556 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35557 .next
35558 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35559 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35560 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35561 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35562 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35563 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35564 .next
35565 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35566 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35567 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35568 .next
35569 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35570 .cindex "size" "of message"
35571 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35572 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35573 .next
35574 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35575 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35576 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35577 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35578 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35579 .next
35580 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35581 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35582 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35583 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35584 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35585 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35586 .next
35587 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35588 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35589 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35590 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35591 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35592 .next
35593 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35594 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35595 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35596 client's ident port times out.
35597 .next
35598 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35599 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35600 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35601 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35602 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35603 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35604 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35605 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35606 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35607 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35608 .new
35609 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35610 .wen
35611 .next
35612 .new
35613 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
35614 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
35615 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
35616 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
35617 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
35618 on a proxied connection.
35619 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
35620 .wen
35621 .next
35622 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35623 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35624 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35625 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35626 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35627 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35628 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35629 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35630 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35631 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35632 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35633 .next
35634 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35635 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35636 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35637 .next
35638 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35639 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35640 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35641 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35642 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35643 .new
35644 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35645 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35646 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35647 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35648 .wen
35649 .next
35650 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35651 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35652 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35653 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35654 containing => tags) following the IP address.
35655 .new
35656 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35657 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35658 .wen
35659 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35660 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35661 local port is a random ephemeral port.
35662 .next
35663 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35664 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35665 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35666 immediately after the time and date.
35667 .next
35668 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35669 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35670 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35671 .next
35672 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35673 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35674 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35675 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35676 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35677 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35678 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35679 message has been successfully received.
35680 .next
35681 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35682 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35683 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35684 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35685 .next
35686 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35687 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35688 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35689 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35690 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35691 has taken place.
35692 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35693 in the list.
35694 .next
35695 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35696 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35697 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35698 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35699 .next
35700 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35701 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35702 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35703 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35704 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35705 .next
35706 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35707 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35708 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35709 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35710 attempt.
35711 .next
35712 .cindex "log" "return path"
35713 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35714 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35715 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35716 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35717 .next
35718 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35719 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35720 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35721 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35722 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35723 .next
35724 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35725 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35726 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35727 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35728 detail is lost.
35729 .next
35730 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35731 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35732 it is too big.
35733 .next
35734 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35735 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35736 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35737 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35738 it.
35739 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35740 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35741 .next
35742 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35743 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35744 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35745 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35746 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35747 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35748 response.
35749 .next
35750 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35751 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35752 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35753 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35754 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35755 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35756 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35757 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35758 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35759 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35760
35761 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35762 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35763 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35764 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35765 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35766 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35767 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35768 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35769 .next
35770 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35771 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35772 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35773 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35774 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35775 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35776 .next
35777 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35778 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35779 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35780 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35781 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35782 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35783 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35784 already have their own log lines.
35785
35786 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35787 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35788 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35789 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35790 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35791 the same logging options.
35792
35793 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35794 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35795 .code
35796 C=EHLO,QUIT
35797 .endd
35798 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35799 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35800 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35801 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35802 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35803 .next
35804 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35805 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35806 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35807 was accepted or used.
35808 .next
35809 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35810 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35811 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35812 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35813 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35814 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35815 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35816 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35817 .next
35818 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35819 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35820 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35821 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35822 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35823 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35824 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35825 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35826 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35827 .next
35828 .cindex "log" "subject"
35829 .cindex "subject, logging"
35830 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35831 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35832 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35833 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35834 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35835 .next
35836 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35837 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35838 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35839 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35840 .next
35841 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35842 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35843 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35844 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35845 .next
35846 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35847 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35848 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35849 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35850 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35851 .next
35852 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35853 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35854 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35855 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35856 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35857 .next
35858 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35859 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35860 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35861 .endlist
35862
35863
35864 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35865 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35866 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35867 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35868 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35869 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35870 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35871 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35872 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35873 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35874 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35875 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35876 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35877
35878 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35879 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35880 &%message_logs%& option false.
35881 .ecindex IIDloggen
35882
35883
35884
35885
35886 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35888
35889 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35890 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35891 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35892 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35893 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35894
35895 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35896 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35897 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35898 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35899 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35900 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35901 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35902 various criteria"
35903 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35904 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35905 "extract statistics from the log"
35906 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35907 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35908 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35909 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35910 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35911 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35912 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35913 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35914 .endtable
35915
35916 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35917 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35918 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35919
35920
35921
35922
35923 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35924 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35925 .cindex "process, querying"
35926 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35927 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35928 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35929 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35930 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35931 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35932 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35933 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35934 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35935
35936 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35937 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35938 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35939
35940
35941 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35942 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35943 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35944 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35945 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35946 options:
35947 .display
35948 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35949 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35950 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35951 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35952 .endd
35953 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35954 .code
35955 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35956 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35957 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35958 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35959 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35960 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35961 .endd
35962 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35963 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35964
35965
35966
35967 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35968 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35969 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35970 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35971 .code
35972 exim -bpu
35973 .endd
35974 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35975 .code
35976 exim -bp
35977 .endd
35978 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35979 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35980
35981 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35982 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35983
35984 .vlist
35985 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35986 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35987 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35988 .code
35989 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35990 .endd
35991 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35992 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35993 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35994
35995 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35996 Match against the size field.
35997
35998 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35999 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36000
36001 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36002 Match messages that are older than the given time.
36003
36004 .vitem &*-z*&
36005 Match only frozen messages.
36006
36007 .vitem &*-x*&
36008 Match only non-frozen messages.
36009 .endlist
36010
36011 The following options control the format of the output:
36012
36013 .vlist
36014 .vitem &*-c*&
36015 Display only the count of matching messages.
36016
36017 .vitem &*-l*&
36018 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36019 the default.
36020
36021 .vitem &*-i*&
36022 Display message ids only.
36023
36024 .vitem &*-b*&
36025 Brief format &-- one line per message.
36026
36027 .vitem &*-R*&
36028 Display messages in reverse order.
36029
36030 .vitem &*-a*&
36031 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36032 .endlist
36033
36034 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36035
36036
36037
36038 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36039 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36040 .cindex "queue" "summary"
36041 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36042 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36043 running a command such as
36044 .code
36045 exim -bp | exiqsumm
36046 .endd
36047 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36048 it, as in the following example:
36049 .code
36050 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36051 .endd
36052 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36053 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36054 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36055 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36056
36057 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36058 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36059 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36060 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36061 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36062 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36063 sender.
36064
36065 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36066 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36067 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36068 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36069 level"& addresses).
36070
36071
36072
36073
36074 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36075 "SECTextspeinf"
36076 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36077 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36078 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36079 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36080 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36081 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36082 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36083 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36084 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36085 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36086 .display
36087 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36088 .endd
36089 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36090
36091 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36092 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36093 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36094
36095 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36096 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36097 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36098 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36099 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36100
36101 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36102 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36103 regular expression.
36104
36105 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36106 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36107
36108 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36109 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36110 normally.
36111
36112 Example of &%-M%&:
36113 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36114 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36115 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36116 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36117 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36118 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36119 search term.
36120
36121 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36122 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36123 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36124 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36125 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36126
36127
36128 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36129 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36130 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36131 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36132 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36133 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36134 the &%--help%& option.
36135
36136
36137 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36138 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36139 .cindex "cycling logs"
36140 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36141 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36142 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36143 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36144 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36145 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36146 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36147 .ilist
36148 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36149 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36150 .next
36151 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36152 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36153 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36154 configuration.
36155 .endlist
36156
36157 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36158 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36159 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36160 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36161 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36162 logs are handled similarly.
36163
36164 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36165 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36166 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36167 any existing log files.
36168
36169 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36170 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36171 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36172 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36173 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36174 .code
36175 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36176 .endd
36177 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36178 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36179
36180
36181
36182 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36183 .cindex "statistics"
36184 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36185 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36186 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36187 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36188 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36189
36190 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36191 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36192 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36193 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36194 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36195 .code
36196 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36197 .endd
36198 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36199 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36200 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36201 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36202 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36203 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36204 also produced per user.
36205
36206 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36207 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36208 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36209 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36210 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36211
36212 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36213 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36214 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36215 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36216 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36217 an entirely separate message.
36218
36219 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36220 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36221 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36222 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36223 least one address that failed.
36224
36225 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36226 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36227 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36228 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36229 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36230 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36231 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36232
36233 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36234 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36235 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36236
36237 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36238 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36239 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36240 .code
36241 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36242 .endd
36243
36244 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36245 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36246 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36247 .cindex "checking access"
36248 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36249 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36250 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36251 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36252 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36253 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36254
36255 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36256 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36257 .code
36258 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36259 .endd
36260 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36261 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36262 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36263 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36264 .code
36265 Rejected:
36266 550 Relay not permitted
36267 .endd
36268 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36269 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36270 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36271 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36272 you can use:
36273 .code
36274 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36275 -f himself@there.example
36276 .endd
36277 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36278 mandatory arguments.
36279
36280 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36281 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36282 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36283
36284
36285
36286 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36287 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36288 .cindex "building DBM files"
36289 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36290 .cindex "lower casing"
36291 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36292 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36293 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36294 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36295 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36296 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36297
36298 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36299 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36300 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36301 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36302 files.
36303
36304 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36305 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36306 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36307 well.
36308
36309 .cindex "USE_DB"
36310 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36311 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36312 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36313 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36314 .code
36315 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36316 .endd
36317 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36318 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36319
36320 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36321 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36322 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36323 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36324 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36325 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36326
36327 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36328 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36329 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36330 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36331 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36332 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36333 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36334 return code is 2.
36335
36336
36337
36338
36339 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36340 .cindex "retry" "times"
36341 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36342 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36343 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36344 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36345 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36346 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36347 output. For example:
36348 .code
36349 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36350 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36351 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36352 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36353 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36354 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36355 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36356 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36357 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36358 past final cutoff time
36359 .endd
36360 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36361 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36362 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36363 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36364 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36365 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36366 run very often.
36367
36368 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36369 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36370 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36371 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36372 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36373 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36374
36375
36376
36377 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36378 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36379 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36380 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36381 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36382 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36383 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36384
36385 .ilist
36386 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36387 .next
36388 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36389 for remote hosts
36390 .next
36391 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36392 .next
36393 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36394 .next
36395 &'misc'&: other hints data
36396 .endlist
36397
36398 The &'misc'& database is used for
36399
36400 .ilist
36401 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36402 .next
36403 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36404 &(smtp)& transport)
36405 .next
36406 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36407 in a transport)
36408 .endlist
36409
36410
36411
36412 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36413 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36414 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36415 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36416 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36417 .code
36418 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36419 .endd
36420 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36421 .code
36422 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36423 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36424 .endd
36425 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36426 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36427 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36428 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36429 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36430 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36431 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36432 and a textual description of the error.
36433
36434 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36435 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36436 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36437 exceeded.
36438
36439 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36440 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36441 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36442 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36443 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36444 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36445 cross-references.
36446
36447
36448
36449 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36450 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36451 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36452 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36453 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36454 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36455 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36456 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36457 updated sufficiently often.
36458
36459 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36460 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36461 the retry database:
36462 .code
36463 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36464 .endd
36465 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36466 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36467 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36468 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36469 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36470 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36471 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36472 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36473 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36474 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36475 whenever it removes information from the database.
36476
36477 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36478 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36479 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36480 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36481 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36482
36483 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36484 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36485 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36486 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36487 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36488 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36489 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36490 tidied.
36491
36492 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36493 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36494
36495
36496
36497
36498 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36499 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36500 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36501 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36502 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36503 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36504 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36505 displayed.
36506
36507 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36508 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36509 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36510 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36511 by new data, for example:
36512 .code
36513 > 4 951102:1000
36514 .endd
36515 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36516 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36517 used as optional separators.
36518
36519
36520
36521
36522 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36523 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36524 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36525 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36526 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36527 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36528 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36529 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36530 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36531 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36532 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36533 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36534 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36535
36536 .vlist
36537 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36538 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36539
36540 .vitem &%-flock%&
36541 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36542 supports it.
36543
36544 .vitem &%-interval%&
36545 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36546 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36547
36548 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36549 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36550
36551 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36552 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36553
36554 .vitem &%-q%&
36555 Suppress verification output.
36556
36557 .vitem &%-retries%&
36558 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36559 the lock (default 10).
36560
36561 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36562 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36563 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36564 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36565 subsequently sees.
36566
36567 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36568 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36569 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36570 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36571
36572 .vitem &%-v%&
36573 Generate verbose output.
36574 .endlist
36575
36576 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36577 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36578 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36579 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36580 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36581 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36582 more than 30 minutes old.
36583
36584 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36585 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36586 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36587 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36588 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36589 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36590
36591 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36592 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36593 suppresses all output except error messages.
36594
36595 A command such as
36596 .code
36597 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36598 .endd
36599 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36600 .display
36601 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36602 <&'some commands'&>
36603 &`End`&
36604 .endd
36605 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36606 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36607 such as
36608 .code
36609 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36610 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36611 .endd
36612 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36613 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36614 .ecindex IIDutils
36615
36616
36617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36619
36620 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36621 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36622 .cindex "X-windows"
36623 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36624 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36625 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36626 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36627 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36628 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36629 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36630 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36631
36632
36633
36634 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36635 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36636 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36637 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36638 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36639 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36640 parameters are for.
36641
36642 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36643 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36644 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36645 .code
36646 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36647 .endd
36648 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36649 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36650 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36651 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36652 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36653
36654 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36655 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36656 .code
36657 Eximon*background: gray94
36658 .endd
36659 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36660 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36661 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36662 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36663 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36664 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36665 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36666 .code
36667 xrdb -merge <<End
36668 Eximon*highlight: gray
36669 End
36670 .endd
36671 .cindex "admin user"
36672 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36673 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36674
36675 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36676 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36677 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36678 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36679 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36680
36681 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36682 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36683 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36684 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36685 different parts of the display.
36686
36687
36688
36689
36690 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36691 .cindex "stripchart"
36692 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36693 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36694 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36695 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36696 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36697 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36698 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36699 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36700 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36701
36702 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36703 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36704 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36705 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36706
36707 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36708 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36709 to a single partition.
36710
36711 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36712 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36713 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36714 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36715 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36716 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36717 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36718
36719
36720
36721
36722 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36723 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36724 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36725 .cindex "window size"
36726 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36727 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36728 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36729 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36730 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36731 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36732
36733 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36734 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36735 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36736 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36737
36738 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36739 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36740 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36741 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36742 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36743 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36744
36745 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36746 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36747 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36748
36749
36750
36751 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36752 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36753 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36754 the main log is maintained.
36755 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36756 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36757 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36758 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36759 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36760
36761 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36762 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36763 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36764 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36765 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36766 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36767 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36768 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36769 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36770 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36771 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36772
36773 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36774 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36775 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36776 It cannot go further back up the log.
36777
36778 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36779 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36780 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36781 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36782 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36783 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36784
36785 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36786 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36787 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36788 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36789 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36790 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36791
36792 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36793 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36794 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36795 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36796 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36797 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36798 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36799 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36800 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36801 window.
36802
36803
36804
36805 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36806 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36807 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36808 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36809 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36810 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36811 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36812 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36813 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36814 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36815
36816 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36817 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36818 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36819 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36820 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36821 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36822 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36823
36824 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36825 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36826 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36827 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36828 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36829 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36830 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36831
36832 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36833 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36834 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36835 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36836
36837 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36838 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36839 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36840 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36841 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36842 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36843 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36844 not shown.
36845
36846 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36847 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36848
36849 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36850 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36851 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36852 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36853 display is updated.
36854
36855
36856
36857 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36858 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36859 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36860 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36861 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36862 any selected text.
36863
36864 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36865 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36866 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36867 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36868 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36869 .code
36870 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36871 .endd
36872 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36873 follows:
36874
36875 .ilist
36876 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36877 in a new text window.
36878 .next
36879 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36880 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36881 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36882 .next
36883 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36884 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36885 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36886 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36887 .next
36888 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36889 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36890 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36891 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36892 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36893 .next
36894 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36895 that the message be frozen.
36896 .next
36897 .cindex "thawing messages"
36898 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36899 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36900 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36901 that the message be thawed.
36902 .next
36903 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36904 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36905 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36906 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36907 .next
36908 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36909 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36910 message.
36911 .next
36912 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36913 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36914 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36915 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36916 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36917 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36918 which case no action is taken.
36919 .next
36920 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36921 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36922 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36923 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36924 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36925 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36926 case no action is taken.
36927 .next
36928 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36929 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36930 .next
36931 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36932 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36933 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36934 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36935 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36936 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36937 the address is qualified with that domain.
36938 .endlist
36939
36940 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36941 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36942 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36943 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36944 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36945 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36946 if no output is generated.
36947
36948 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36949 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36950 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36951 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36952
36953 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36954 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36955 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36956 .ecindex IIDeximon
36957
36958
36959
36960
36961
36962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36963 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36964
36965 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36966 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36967 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36968 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36969
36970 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36971 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36972 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36973 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36974 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36975 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36976
36977 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36978 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36979 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36980 as soon as possible.
36981
36982
36983 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36984 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36985 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36986 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36987 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36988 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36989
36990 .ilist
36991 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36992 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36993 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36994 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36995 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36996 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36997
36998 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36999 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37000 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37001 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37002 .next
37003
37004 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37005 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37006 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37007 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37008 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37009 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37010 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37011 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37012 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37013 separate commands.
37014
37015 .next
37016 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37017 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37018 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37019 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37020 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37021 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37022 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37023 .next
37024 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37025 is disabled.
37026 .next
37027 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37028 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37029 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37030 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37031 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37032 .endlist
37033
37034
37035
37036 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37037 .cindex "setuid"
37038 .cindex "root privilege"
37039 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37040 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37041 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37042 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37043 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37044 is required for two things:
37045
37046 .ilist
37047 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37048 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37049 not required.
37050 .next
37051 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37052 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37053 configuration.
37054 .endlist
37055
37056 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37057 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37058 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37059 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37060 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37061 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37062 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37063 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37064
37065 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37066 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37067 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37068
37069 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37070 uid and gid in the following cases:
37071
37072 .ilist
37073 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37074 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37075 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37076 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37077 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37078 the calling process.
37079 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37080 option may not be used at all.
37081 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37082 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37083 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37084 .next
37085 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37086 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37087 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37088 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37089 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37090 calling process.
37091 .next
37092 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37093 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37094 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37095 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37096 testing address verification
37097 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37098 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37099 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37100 option).
37101 .next
37102 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37103 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37104 .endlist
37105
37106 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37107
37108 .ilist
37109 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37110 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37111 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37112 will be used during message reception.
37113 .next
37114 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37115 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37116 .next
37117 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37118 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37119 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37120 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37121 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37122 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37123 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37124 generating bounce and warning messages.
37125
37126 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37127 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37128 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37129 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37130 .next
37131 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37132 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37133 .endlist
37134
37135
37136
37137
37138 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37139 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37140 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37141 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37142 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37143 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37144 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37145 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37146 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37147 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37148 to any other uid.
37149
37150 .cindex SIGHUP
37151 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37152 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37153 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37154 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37155
37156 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37157 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37158 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37159 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37160 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37161
37162 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37163 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37164 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37165 effect.
37166
37167 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37168 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37169 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37170
37171 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37172 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37173 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37174 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37175 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37176 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37177 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37178 address this problem at this time.
37179
37180 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37181 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37182 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37183 be used in the most straightforward way.
37184
37185 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37186 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37187
37188 .ilist
37189 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37190 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37191 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37192 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37193 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37194 .next
37195 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37196 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37197 .next
37198 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37199 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37200 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37201 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37202 .next
37203 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37204 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37205
37206 .olist
37207 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37208 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37209 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37210 .next
37211 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37212 owned by the Exim user.
37213 .next
37214 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37215 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37216 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37217 .endlist olist
37218 .endlist ilist
37219
37220
37221 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37222 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37223 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37224 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37225
37226 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37227 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37228
37229
37230
37231
37232 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37233 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37234 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37235
37236
37237
37238 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37239 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37240 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37241 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37242 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37243 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37244 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37245
37246 .ilist
37247 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37248 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37249 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37250 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37251 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37252 .next
37253 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37254 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37255 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37256 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37257 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37258 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37259 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37260 .next
37261 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37262 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37263 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37264 .next
37265 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37266 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37267 .next
37268 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37269 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37270 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37271 .next
37272 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37273 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37274 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37275 of opaque strings.
37276 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37277 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37278 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37279 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37280 .endlist
37281
37282
37283
37284
37285 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37286 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37287 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37288 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37289 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37290 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37291 are some issues to be aware of:
37292
37293 .ilist
37294 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37295 .next
37296 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37297 .next
37298 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37299 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37300 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37301 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37302 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37303 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37304 data.
37305 .next
37306 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37307 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37308 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37309 .next
37310 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37311 expected to yield one result.
37312 .endlist
37313
37314
37315
37316
37317 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37318 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37319 .cindex "IP source routing"
37320 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37321 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37322 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37323 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37324
37325
37326
37327 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37328 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37329 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37330
37331
37332
37333
37334 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37335 .cindex "trusted users"
37336 .cindex "admin user"
37337 .cindex "privileged user"
37338 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37339 .cindex "user" "admin"
37340 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37341 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37342 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37343 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37344 permit a remote host to be specified.
37345
37346 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37347 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37348 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37349 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37350 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37351 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37352 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37353
37354 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37355 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37356 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37357 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37358 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37359
37360 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37361 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37362 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37363 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37364 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37365
37366 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37367 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37368 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37369 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37370 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37371 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37372 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37373 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37374
37375 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37376 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37377 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37378 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37379 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37380 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37381 files.
37382
37383
37384
37385 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37386 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37387 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37388 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37389 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37390 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37391
37392
37393
37394 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37395 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37396 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37397 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37398 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37399 this.
37400
37401
37402
37403 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37404 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37405 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37406 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37407 converted output.
37408
37409
37410
37411 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37412 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37413 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37414 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37415 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37416
37417
37418
37419 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37420 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37421 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37422 loading it.
37423
37424
37425 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37426 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37427 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37428 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37429 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37430 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37431 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37432
37433 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37434 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37435 string.
37436
37437
37438
37439 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37440 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37441 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37442 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37443
37444
37445
37446 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37447 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37448 enough to hold the result.
37449 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37450
37451
37452
37453
37454 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37455 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37456
37457 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37458 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37459 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37460 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37461 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37462 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37463 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37464 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37465 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37466 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37467 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37468 themselves are recoverable.
37469
37470 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37471 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37472 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37473
37474 .ilist
37475 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37476 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37477 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37478 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37479 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37480 .next
37481 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37482 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37483 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37484 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37485 will always be the case.
37486 .next
37487 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37488 .next
37489 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37490 signature.
37491 .endlist
37492 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37493
37494 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37495 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37496 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37497 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37498 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37499 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37500 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37501 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37502 attempt.
37503
37504 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37505 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37506 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37507 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37508 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37509 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37510 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37511 normally the Exim user.
37512
37513 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37514 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37515 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37516 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37517 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37518 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37519 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37520 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37521
37522 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37523 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37524 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37525 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37526
37527 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37528 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37529
37530 .vlist
37531 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37532 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37533 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37534 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37535 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37536 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37537 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37538 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37539 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37540 newlines.
37541
37542 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37543 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37544 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37545 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37546 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37547 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37548
37549 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37550 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37551 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37552 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37553 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37554 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37555
37556 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37557 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37558 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37559
37560 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37561 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37562 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37563 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37564 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37565
37566 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37567 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37568 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37569 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37570 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37571
37572 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37573 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37574 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37575
37576 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37577 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37578 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37579
37580 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37581 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37582 present.
37583
37584 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37585 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37586 present if the number is greater than zero.
37587
37588 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37589 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37590 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37591
37592 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37593 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37594 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37595
37596 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37597 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37598 command.
37599
37600 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37601 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37602 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37603 messages.
37604
37605 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37606 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37607 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37608 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37609
37610 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37611 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37612 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37613
37614 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37615 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37616 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37617 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37618 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37619 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37620
37621 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37622 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37623 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37624 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37625 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37626
37627 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37628 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37629 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37630 generated messages.
37631
37632 .vitem &%-local%&
37633 The message is from a local sender.
37634
37635 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37636 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37637
37638 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37639 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37640 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37641 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37642
37643 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37644 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37645 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37646
37647 .vitem &%-N%&
37648 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37649 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37650 &%-N%& is assumed.
37651
37652 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37653 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37654 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37655
37656 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37657 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37658 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37659
37660 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37661 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37662 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37663
37664 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37665 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37666 certificate was verified by the server.
37667
37668 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37669 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37670 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37671
37672 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37673 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37674 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37675 certificate.
37676 .endlist
37677
37678 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37679 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37680 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37681 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37682 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37683 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37684 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37685 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37686 addresses are complete.
37687
37688 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37689 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37690 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37691 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37692 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37693 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37694 .code
37695 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37696 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37697 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37698 .endd
37699 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37700 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37701 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37702 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37703 example:
37704 .code
37705 4
37706 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37707 darcy@austen.fict.example
37708 rdo@foundation
37709 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37710 .endd
37711 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37712 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37713 line is of the following form:
37714 .display
37715 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37716 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37717 .endd
37718 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37719 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37720 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37721 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37722 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37723 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37724 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37725 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37726
37727
37728 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37729 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37730 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37731 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37732 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37733 following:
37734
37735 .table2 50pt
37736 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37737 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37738 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37739 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37740 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37741 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37742 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37743 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37744 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37745 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37746 .endtable
37747
37748 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37749 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37750 typical set of headers:
37751 .code
37752 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37753 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37754 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37755 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37756 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37757 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37758 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37759 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37760 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37761 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37762 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37763 .endd
37764 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37765 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37766 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37767 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37768 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37769 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37770
37771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37773
37774 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37775 "DKIM Support"
37776 .cindex "DKIM"
37777
37778 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37779 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37780 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37781 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37782
37783 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37784 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37785
37786 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37787 .olist
37788 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37789 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37790 (including transport filters)
37791 except cutthrough delivery.
37792 .next
37793 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37794 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37795 different signature contexts.
37796 .endlist
37797
37798 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37799 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37800 Exim's standard controls.
37801
37802 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37803 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37804 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37805 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37806 .code
37807 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37808 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37809 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37810 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37811 .endd
37812 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37813 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37814 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37815 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37816 senders).
37817
37818
37819 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37820 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37821
37822 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37823 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37824
37825 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37826 MANDATORY:
37827 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37828 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37829
37830 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37831 MANDATORY:
37832 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37833 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37834 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37835 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37836
37837 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37838 MANDATORY:
37839 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37840 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37841 The result can either
37842 .ilist
37843 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37844 .next
37845 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37846 the private key.
37847 .next
37848 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37849 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37850 is set.
37851 .endlist
37852
37853 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37854 OPTIONAL:
37855 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37856 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37857 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37858 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37859
37860 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37861 OPTIONAL:
37862 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37863 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37864 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37865 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37866 variables here.
37867
37868 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37869 OPTIONAL:
37870 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37871 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37872 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37873 used.
37874
37875
37876 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37877 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37878
37879 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37880 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37881 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37882 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37883 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
37884 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37885 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37886
37887 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37888 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37889 runtime of the ACL.
37890
37891 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37892 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37893 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37894 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37895
37896 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37897 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37898 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37899 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37900 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37901 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37902 it defaults as:
37903 .code
37904 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37905 .endd
37906 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37907 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37908 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37909 .code
37910 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37911 .endd
37912 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37913 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37914 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37915 .code
37916 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37917 .endd
37918
37919 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37920 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37921
37922
37923 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37924 available (from most to least important):
37925
37926
37927 .vlist
37928 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37929 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37930 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37931 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37932 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37933 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37934 .ilist
37935 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37936 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37937 .next
37938 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37939 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37940 .next
37941 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37942 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37943 .next
37944 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37945 .endlist
37946 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37947 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37948 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37949 .ilist
37950 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37951 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37952 .next
37953 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37954 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37955 .next
37956 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37957 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37958 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37959 .next
37960 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37961 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37962 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37963 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37964 .endlist
37965 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37966 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37967 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37968 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37969 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37970 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37971 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37972 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37973 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37974 The key record selector string.
37975 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37976 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37977 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37978 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37979 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37980 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37981 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37982 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37983 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37984 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37985 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37986 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37987 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37988 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37989 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37990 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37991 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37992 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37993 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37994 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37995 integer size comparisons against this value.
37996 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37997 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37998 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37999 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38000 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38001 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38002 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38003 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38004 in the key record.
38005 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38006 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38007 in the key record.
38008 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38009 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38010 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38011 Number of bits in the key.
38012 .endlist
38013
38014 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38015
38016 .vlist
38017 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38018 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38019 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38020 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38021 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38022
38023 .code
38024 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
38025 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
38026 sender_domains = gmail.com
38027 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38028 dkim_status = none
38029 .endd
38030
38031 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
38032 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38033 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38034 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38035
38036 .code
38037 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38038 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38039 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38040 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38041 .endd
38042
38043 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38044 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38045 for more information of what they mean.
38046 .endlist
38047
38048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38049 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38050
38051 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
38052 "Proxy support"
38053 .cindex "proxy support"
38054 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
38055
38056 .new
38057 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
38058 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
38059
38060
38061 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
38062 .cindex proxy inbound
38063 .cindex proxy "server side"
38064 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
38065 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
38066
38067 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
38068 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
38069 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
38070 in Local/Makefile.
38071
38072 It was built on specifications from:
38073 http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt
38074 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
38075 http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e
38076
38077 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
38078 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
38079 to distribute load.
38080 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
38081 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
38082 There is no logging if a host passes or
38083 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
38084 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
38085
38086 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
38087 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
38088 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
38089
38090 To log the IP of the proxy in the incoming logline, add &"+proxy"&
38091 to the &%log_selector%& option.
38092 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
38093
38094 The following expansion variables are usable
38095 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
38096 of the proxy):
38097 .display
38098 &'proxy_host_address '& internal IP address of the proxy
38099 &'proxy_host_port '& internal TCP port of the proxy
38100 &'proxy_target_address '& external IP address of the proxy
38101 &'proxy_target_port '& external TCP port of the proxy
38102 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
38103 .endd
38104 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_host_address$& is empty
38105 there was a protocol error.
38106
38107 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
38108 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
38109 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
38110 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
38111 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
38112 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
38113 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
38114 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
38115 A possible solution is:
38116 .display
38117 # Set max number of connections per host
38118 LIMIT = 5
38119 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
38120 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
38121
38122 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
38123 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
38124 .endd
38125
38126
38127
38128 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
38129 .cindex proxy outbound
38130 .cindex proxy "client side"
38131 .cindex proxy SOCKS
38132 .cindex SOCKS proxy
38133 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
38134 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
38135 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
38136 Local/Makefile.
38137
38138 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
38139 on an smtp transport.
38140 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
38141 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
38142 Each proxy specifier is a list
38143 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
38144 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
38145
38146 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
38147 The list of options is in the following table:
38148 .display
38149 &`auth `& authentication method
38150 &`name `& authentication username
38151 &`pass `& authentication password
38152 &`port `& tcp port
38153 &`tmo `& connection timeout
38154 &`pri `& priority
38155 &`weight `& selection bias
38156 .endd
38157
38158 More details on each of these options follows:
38159
38160 .ilist
38161 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
38162 .cindex proxy authentication
38163 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
38164 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
38165 for access to the proxy.
38166 Default is &"none"&.
38167 .next
38168 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
38169 Default is empty.
38170 .next
38171 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
38172 Default is empty.
38173 .next
38174 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
38175 Default is 1080.
38176 .next
38177 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
38178 Default is 5.
38179 .next
38180 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
38181 higher values being tried first.
38182 The default priority is 1.
38183 .next
38184 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
38185 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
38186 weighted by this value.
38187 The default value for selection bias is 1.
38188 .endlist
38189
38190 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
38191 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
38192 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
38193 .wen
38194
38195 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38196 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38197
38198 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
38199 "Adding drivers or lookups"
38200 .cindex "adding drivers"
38201 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
38202 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
38203 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
38204 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
38205
38206 .olist
38207 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
38208 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38209 .next
38210 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38211 .display
38212 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38213 .endd
38214 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38215 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38216 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38217 .next
38218 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38219 .code
38220 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38221 .endd
38222 .next
38223 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38224 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38225 .next
38226 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38227 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38228 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38229 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38230 simple form that most lookups have.
38231 .next
38232 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38233 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38234 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38235 .next
38236 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38237 &_src_&.
38238 .next
38239 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38240 as for other drivers and lookups.
38241 .endlist
38242
38243 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38244 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38245 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38246 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38247 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38248
38249 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38250 the interface that is expected.
38251
38252
38253
38254
38255 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38256 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38257
38258 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38259 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38260 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38261 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38262 . processors.
38263 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38264
38265 .literal xml
38266 <?sdop
38267 format="newpage"
38268 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38269 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38270 ?>
38271 .literal off
38272
38273 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38274 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38275 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38276
38277
38278 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38279 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////